Loading...
1// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0
2/*
3 * PCI Bus Services, see include/linux/pci.h for further explanation.
4 *
5 * Copyright 1993 -- 1997 Drew Eckhardt, Frederic Potter,
6 * David Mosberger-Tang
7 *
8 * Copyright 1997 -- 2000 Martin Mares <mj@ucw.cz>
9 */
10
11#include <linux/acpi.h>
12#include <linux/kernel.h>
13#include <linux/delay.h>
14#include <linux/dmi.h>
15#include <linux/init.h>
16#include <linux/msi.h>
17#include <linux/of.h>
18#include <linux/of_pci.h>
19#include <linux/pci.h>
20#include <linux/pm.h>
21#include <linux/slab.h>
22#include <linux/module.h>
23#include <linux/spinlock.h>
24#include <linux/string.h>
25#include <linux/log2.h>
26#include <linux/logic_pio.h>
27#include <linux/pm_wakeup.h>
28#include <linux/interrupt.h>
29#include <linux/device.h>
30#include <linux/pm_runtime.h>
31#include <linux/pci_hotplug.h>
32#include <linux/vmalloc.h>
33#include <linux/pci-ats.h>
34#include <asm/setup.h>
35#include <asm/dma.h>
36#include <linux/aer.h>
37#include "pci.h"
38
39DEFINE_MUTEX(pci_slot_mutex);
40
41const char *pci_power_names[] = {
42 "error", "D0", "D1", "D2", "D3hot", "D3cold", "unknown",
43};
44EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_power_names);
45
46int isa_dma_bridge_buggy;
47EXPORT_SYMBOL(isa_dma_bridge_buggy);
48
49int pci_pci_problems;
50EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_pci_problems);
51
52unsigned int pci_pm_d3_delay;
53
54static void pci_pme_list_scan(struct work_struct *work);
55
56static LIST_HEAD(pci_pme_list);
57static DEFINE_MUTEX(pci_pme_list_mutex);
58static DECLARE_DELAYED_WORK(pci_pme_work, pci_pme_list_scan);
59
60struct pci_pme_device {
61 struct list_head list;
62 struct pci_dev *dev;
63};
64
65#define PME_TIMEOUT 1000 /* How long between PME checks */
66
67static void pci_dev_d3_sleep(struct pci_dev *dev)
68{
69 unsigned int delay = dev->d3_delay;
70
71 if (delay < pci_pm_d3_delay)
72 delay = pci_pm_d3_delay;
73
74 if (delay)
75 msleep(delay);
76}
77
78#ifdef CONFIG_PCI_DOMAINS
79int pci_domains_supported = 1;
80#endif
81
82#define DEFAULT_CARDBUS_IO_SIZE (256)
83#define DEFAULT_CARDBUS_MEM_SIZE (64*1024*1024)
84/* pci=cbmemsize=nnM,cbiosize=nn can override this */
85unsigned long pci_cardbus_io_size = DEFAULT_CARDBUS_IO_SIZE;
86unsigned long pci_cardbus_mem_size = DEFAULT_CARDBUS_MEM_SIZE;
87
88#define DEFAULT_HOTPLUG_IO_SIZE (256)
89#define DEFAULT_HOTPLUG_MMIO_SIZE (2*1024*1024)
90#define DEFAULT_HOTPLUG_MMIO_PREF_SIZE (2*1024*1024)
91/* hpiosize=nn can override this */
92unsigned long pci_hotplug_io_size = DEFAULT_HOTPLUG_IO_SIZE;
93/*
94 * pci=hpmmiosize=nnM overrides non-prefetchable MMIO size,
95 * pci=hpmmioprefsize=nnM overrides prefetchable MMIO size;
96 * pci=hpmemsize=nnM overrides both
97 */
98unsigned long pci_hotplug_mmio_size = DEFAULT_HOTPLUG_MMIO_SIZE;
99unsigned long pci_hotplug_mmio_pref_size = DEFAULT_HOTPLUG_MMIO_PREF_SIZE;
100
101#define DEFAULT_HOTPLUG_BUS_SIZE 1
102unsigned long pci_hotplug_bus_size = DEFAULT_HOTPLUG_BUS_SIZE;
103
104enum pcie_bus_config_types pcie_bus_config = PCIE_BUS_DEFAULT;
105
106/*
107 * The default CLS is used if arch didn't set CLS explicitly and not
108 * all pci devices agree on the same value. Arch can override either
109 * the dfl or actual value as it sees fit. Don't forget this is
110 * measured in 32-bit words, not bytes.
111 */
112u8 pci_dfl_cache_line_size = L1_CACHE_BYTES >> 2;
113u8 pci_cache_line_size;
114
115/*
116 * If we set up a device for bus mastering, we need to check the latency
117 * timer as certain BIOSes forget to set it properly.
118 */
119unsigned int pcibios_max_latency = 255;
120
121/* If set, the PCIe ARI capability will not be used. */
122static bool pcie_ari_disabled;
123
124/* If set, the PCIe ATS capability will not be used. */
125static bool pcie_ats_disabled;
126
127/* If set, the PCI config space of each device is printed during boot. */
128bool pci_early_dump;
129
130bool pci_ats_disabled(void)
131{
132 return pcie_ats_disabled;
133}
134EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_ats_disabled);
135
136/* Disable bridge_d3 for all PCIe ports */
137static bool pci_bridge_d3_disable;
138/* Force bridge_d3 for all PCIe ports */
139static bool pci_bridge_d3_force;
140
141static int __init pcie_port_pm_setup(char *str)
142{
143 if (!strcmp(str, "off"))
144 pci_bridge_d3_disable = true;
145 else if (!strcmp(str, "force"))
146 pci_bridge_d3_force = true;
147 return 1;
148}
149__setup("pcie_port_pm=", pcie_port_pm_setup);
150
151/* Time to wait after a reset for device to become responsive */
152#define PCIE_RESET_READY_POLL_MS 60000
153
154/**
155 * pci_bus_max_busnr - returns maximum PCI bus number of given bus' children
156 * @bus: pointer to PCI bus structure to search
157 *
158 * Given a PCI bus, returns the highest PCI bus number present in the set
159 * including the given PCI bus and its list of child PCI buses.
160 */
161unsigned char pci_bus_max_busnr(struct pci_bus *bus)
162{
163 struct pci_bus *tmp;
164 unsigned char max, n;
165
166 max = bus->busn_res.end;
167 list_for_each_entry(tmp, &bus->children, node) {
168 n = pci_bus_max_busnr(tmp);
169 if (n > max)
170 max = n;
171 }
172 return max;
173}
174EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_bus_max_busnr);
175
176/**
177 * pci_status_get_and_clear_errors - return and clear error bits in PCI_STATUS
178 * @pdev: the PCI device
179 *
180 * Returns error bits set in PCI_STATUS and clears them.
181 */
182int pci_status_get_and_clear_errors(struct pci_dev *pdev)
183{
184 u16 status;
185 int ret;
186
187 ret = pci_read_config_word(pdev, PCI_STATUS, &status);
188 if (ret != PCIBIOS_SUCCESSFUL)
189 return -EIO;
190
191 status &= PCI_STATUS_ERROR_BITS;
192 if (status)
193 pci_write_config_word(pdev, PCI_STATUS, status);
194
195 return status;
196}
197EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_status_get_and_clear_errors);
198
199#ifdef CONFIG_HAS_IOMEM
200void __iomem *pci_ioremap_bar(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bar)
201{
202 struct resource *res = &pdev->resource[bar];
203
204 /*
205 * Make sure the BAR is actually a memory resource, not an IO resource
206 */
207 if (res->flags & IORESOURCE_UNSET || !(res->flags & IORESOURCE_MEM)) {
208 pci_warn(pdev, "can't ioremap BAR %d: %pR\n", bar, res);
209 return NULL;
210 }
211 return ioremap(res->start, resource_size(res));
212}
213EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_ioremap_bar);
214
215void __iomem *pci_ioremap_wc_bar(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bar)
216{
217 /*
218 * Make sure the BAR is actually a memory resource, not an IO resource
219 */
220 if (!(pci_resource_flags(pdev, bar) & IORESOURCE_MEM)) {
221 WARN_ON(1);
222 return NULL;
223 }
224 return ioremap_wc(pci_resource_start(pdev, bar),
225 pci_resource_len(pdev, bar));
226}
227EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_ioremap_wc_bar);
228#endif
229
230/**
231 * pci_dev_str_match_path - test if a path string matches a device
232 * @dev: the PCI device to test
233 * @path: string to match the device against
234 * @endptr: pointer to the string after the match
235 *
236 * Test if a string (typically from a kernel parameter) formatted as a
237 * path of device/function addresses matches a PCI device. The string must
238 * be of the form:
239 *
240 * [<domain>:]<bus>:<device>.<func>[/<device>.<func>]*
241 *
242 * A path for a device can be obtained using 'lspci -t'. Using a path
243 * is more robust against bus renumbering than using only a single bus,
244 * device and function address.
245 *
246 * Returns 1 if the string matches the device, 0 if it does not and
247 * a negative error code if it fails to parse the string.
248 */
249static int pci_dev_str_match_path(struct pci_dev *dev, const char *path,
250 const char **endptr)
251{
252 int ret;
253 int seg, bus, slot, func;
254 char *wpath, *p;
255 char end;
256
257 *endptr = strchrnul(path, ';');
258
259 wpath = kmemdup_nul(path, *endptr - path, GFP_KERNEL);
260 if (!wpath)
261 return -ENOMEM;
262
263 while (1) {
264 p = strrchr(wpath, '/');
265 if (!p)
266 break;
267 ret = sscanf(p, "/%x.%x%c", &slot, &func, &end);
268 if (ret != 2) {
269 ret = -EINVAL;
270 goto free_and_exit;
271 }
272
273 if (dev->devfn != PCI_DEVFN(slot, func)) {
274 ret = 0;
275 goto free_and_exit;
276 }
277
278 /*
279 * Note: we don't need to get a reference to the upstream
280 * bridge because we hold a reference to the top level
281 * device which should hold a reference to the bridge,
282 * and so on.
283 */
284 dev = pci_upstream_bridge(dev);
285 if (!dev) {
286 ret = 0;
287 goto free_and_exit;
288 }
289
290 *p = 0;
291 }
292
293 ret = sscanf(wpath, "%x:%x:%x.%x%c", &seg, &bus, &slot,
294 &func, &end);
295 if (ret != 4) {
296 seg = 0;
297 ret = sscanf(wpath, "%x:%x.%x%c", &bus, &slot, &func, &end);
298 if (ret != 3) {
299 ret = -EINVAL;
300 goto free_and_exit;
301 }
302 }
303
304 ret = (seg == pci_domain_nr(dev->bus) &&
305 bus == dev->bus->number &&
306 dev->devfn == PCI_DEVFN(slot, func));
307
308free_and_exit:
309 kfree(wpath);
310 return ret;
311}
312
313/**
314 * pci_dev_str_match - test if a string matches a device
315 * @dev: the PCI device to test
316 * @p: string to match the device against
317 * @endptr: pointer to the string after the match
318 *
319 * Test if a string (typically from a kernel parameter) matches a specified
320 * PCI device. The string may be of one of the following formats:
321 *
322 * [<domain>:]<bus>:<device>.<func>[/<device>.<func>]*
323 * pci:<vendor>:<device>[:<subvendor>:<subdevice>]
324 *
325 * The first format specifies a PCI bus/device/function address which
326 * may change if new hardware is inserted, if motherboard firmware changes,
327 * or due to changes caused in kernel parameters. If the domain is
328 * left unspecified, it is taken to be 0. In order to be robust against
329 * bus renumbering issues, a path of PCI device/function numbers may be used
330 * to address the specific device. The path for a device can be determined
331 * through the use of 'lspci -t'.
332 *
333 * The second format matches devices using IDs in the configuration
334 * space which may match multiple devices in the system. A value of 0
335 * for any field will match all devices. (Note: this differs from
336 * in-kernel code that uses PCI_ANY_ID which is ~0; this is for
337 * legacy reasons and convenience so users don't have to specify
338 * FFFFFFFFs on the command line.)
339 *
340 * Returns 1 if the string matches the device, 0 if it does not and
341 * a negative error code if the string cannot be parsed.
342 */
343static int pci_dev_str_match(struct pci_dev *dev, const char *p,
344 const char **endptr)
345{
346 int ret;
347 int count;
348 unsigned short vendor, device, subsystem_vendor, subsystem_device;
349
350 if (strncmp(p, "pci:", 4) == 0) {
351 /* PCI vendor/device (subvendor/subdevice) IDs are specified */
352 p += 4;
353 ret = sscanf(p, "%hx:%hx:%hx:%hx%n", &vendor, &device,
354 &subsystem_vendor, &subsystem_device, &count);
355 if (ret != 4) {
356 ret = sscanf(p, "%hx:%hx%n", &vendor, &device, &count);
357 if (ret != 2)
358 return -EINVAL;
359
360 subsystem_vendor = 0;
361 subsystem_device = 0;
362 }
363
364 p += count;
365
366 if ((!vendor || vendor == dev->vendor) &&
367 (!device || device == dev->device) &&
368 (!subsystem_vendor ||
369 subsystem_vendor == dev->subsystem_vendor) &&
370 (!subsystem_device ||
371 subsystem_device == dev->subsystem_device))
372 goto found;
373 } else {
374 /*
375 * PCI Bus, Device, Function IDs are specified
376 * (optionally, may include a path of devfns following it)
377 */
378 ret = pci_dev_str_match_path(dev, p, &p);
379 if (ret < 0)
380 return ret;
381 else if (ret)
382 goto found;
383 }
384
385 *endptr = p;
386 return 0;
387
388found:
389 *endptr = p;
390 return 1;
391}
392
393static int __pci_find_next_cap_ttl(struct pci_bus *bus, unsigned int devfn,
394 u8 pos, int cap, int *ttl)
395{
396 u8 id;
397 u16 ent;
398
399 pci_bus_read_config_byte(bus, devfn, pos, &pos);
400
401 while ((*ttl)--) {
402 if (pos < 0x40)
403 break;
404 pos &= ~3;
405 pci_bus_read_config_word(bus, devfn, pos, &ent);
406
407 id = ent & 0xff;
408 if (id == 0xff)
409 break;
410 if (id == cap)
411 return pos;
412 pos = (ent >> 8);
413 }
414 return 0;
415}
416
417static int __pci_find_next_cap(struct pci_bus *bus, unsigned int devfn,
418 u8 pos, int cap)
419{
420 int ttl = PCI_FIND_CAP_TTL;
421
422 return __pci_find_next_cap_ttl(bus, devfn, pos, cap, &ttl);
423}
424
425int pci_find_next_capability(struct pci_dev *dev, u8 pos, int cap)
426{
427 return __pci_find_next_cap(dev->bus, dev->devfn,
428 pos + PCI_CAP_LIST_NEXT, cap);
429}
430EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_find_next_capability);
431
432static int __pci_bus_find_cap_start(struct pci_bus *bus,
433 unsigned int devfn, u8 hdr_type)
434{
435 u16 status;
436
437 pci_bus_read_config_word(bus, devfn, PCI_STATUS, &status);
438 if (!(status & PCI_STATUS_CAP_LIST))
439 return 0;
440
441 switch (hdr_type) {
442 case PCI_HEADER_TYPE_NORMAL:
443 case PCI_HEADER_TYPE_BRIDGE:
444 return PCI_CAPABILITY_LIST;
445 case PCI_HEADER_TYPE_CARDBUS:
446 return PCI_CB_CAPABILITY_LIST;
447 }
448
449 return 0;
450}
451
452/**
453 * pci_find_capability - query for devices' capabilities
454 * @dev: PCI device to query
455 * @cap: capability code
456 *
457 * Tell if a device supports a given PCI capability.
458 * Returns the address of the requested capability structure within the
459 * device's PCI configuration space or 0 in case the device does not
460 * support it. Possible values for @cap include:
461 *
462 * %PCI_CAP_ID_PM Power Management
463 * %PCI_CAP_ID_AGP Accelerated Graphics Port
464 * %PCI_CAP_ID_VPD Vital Product Data
465 * %PCI_CAP_ID_SLOTID Slot Identification
466 * %PCI_CAP_ID_MSI Message Signalled Interrupts
467 * %PCI_CAP_ID_CHSWP CompactPCI HotSwap
468 * %PCI_CAP_ID_PCIX PCI-X
469 * %PCI_CAP_ID_EXP PCI Express
470 */
471int pci_find_capability(struct pci_dev *dev, int cap)
472{
473 int pos;
474
475 pos = __pci_bus_find_cap_start(dev->bus, dev->devfn, dev->hdr_type);
476 if (pos)
477 pos = __pci_find_next_cap(dev->bus, dev->devfn, pos, cap);
478
479 return pos;
480}
481EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_find_capability);
482
483/**
484 * pci_bus_find_capability - query for devices' capabilities
485 * @bus: the PCI bus to query
486 * @devfn: PCI device to query
487 * @cap: capability code
488 *
489 * Like pci_find_capability() but works for PCI devices that do not have a
490 * pci_dev structure set up yet.
491 *
492 * Returns the address of the requested capability structure within the
493 * device's PCI configuration space or 0 in case the device does not
494 * support it.
495 */
496int pci_bus_find_capability(struct pci_bus *bus, unsigned int devfn, int cap)
497{
498 int pos;
499 u8 hdr_type;
500
501 pci_bus_read_config_byte(bus, devfn, PCI_HEADER_TYPE, &hdr_type);
502
503 pos = __pci_bus_find_cap_start(bus, devfn, hdr_type & 0x7f);
504 if (pos)
505 pos = __pci_find_next_cap(bus, devfn, pos, cap);
506
507 return pos;
508}
509EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_bus_find_capability);
510
511/**
512 * pci_find_next_ext_capability - Find an extended capability
513 * @dev: PCI device to query
514 * @start: address at which to start looking (0 to start at beginning of list)
515 * @cap: capability code
516 *
517 * Returns the address of the next matching extended capability structure
518 * within the device's PCI configuration space or 0 if the device does
519 * not support it. Some capabilities can occur several times, e.g., the
520 * vendor-specific capability, and this provides a way to find them all.
521 */
522int pci_find_next_ext_capability(struct pci_dev *dev, int start, int cap)
523{
524 u32 header;
525 int ttl;
526 int pos = PCI_CFG_SPACE_SIZE;
527
528 /* minimum 8 bytes per capability */
529 ttl = (PCI_CFG_SPACE_EXP_SIZE - PCI_CFG_SPACE_SIZE) / 8;
530
531 if (dev->cfg_size <= PCI_CFG_SPACE_SIZE)
532 return 0;
533
534 if (start)
535 pos = start;
536
537 if (pci_read_config_dword(dev, pos, &header) != PCIBIOS_SUCCESSFUL)
538 return 0;
539
540 /*
541 * If we have no capabilities, this is indicated by cap ID,
542 * cap version and next pointer all being 0.
543 */
544 if (header == 0)
545 return 0;
546
547 while (ttl-- > 0) {
548 if (PCI_EXT_CAP_ID(header) == cap && pos != start)
549 return pos;
550
551 pos = PCI_EXT_CAP_NEXT(header);
552 if (pos < PCI_CFG_SPACE_SIZE)
553 break;
554
555 if (pci_read_config_dword(dev, pos, &header) != PCIBIOS_SUCCESSFUL)
556 break;
557 }
558
559 return 0;
560}
561EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_find_next_ext_capability);
562
563/**
564 * pci_find_ext_capability - Find an extended capability
565 * @dev: PCI device to query
566 * @cap: capability code
567 *
568 * Returns the address of the requested extended capability structure
569 * within the device's PCI configuration space or 0 if the device does
570 * not support it. Possible values for @cap include:
571 *
572 * %PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_ERR Advanced Error Reporting
573 * %PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_VC Virtual Channel
574 * %PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_DSN Device Serial Number
575 * %PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_PWR Power Budgeting
576 */
577int pci_find_ext_capability(struct pci_dev *dev, int cap)
578{
579 return pci_find_next_ext_capability(dev, 0, cap);
580}
581EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_find_ext_capability);
582
583/**
584 * pci_get_dsn - Read and return the 8-byte Device Serial Number
585 * @dev: PCI device to query
586 *
587 * Looks up the PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_DSN and reads the 8 bytes of the Device Serial
588 * Number.
589 *
590 * Returns the DSN, or zero if the capability does not exist.
591 */
592u64 pci_get_dsn(struct pci_dev *dev)
593{
594 u32 dword;
595 u64 dsn;
596 int pos;
597
598 pos = pci_find_ext_capability(dev, PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_DSN);
599 if (!pos)
600 return 0;
601
602 /*
603 * The Device Serial Number is two dwords offset 4 bytes from the
604 * capability position. The specification says that the first dword is
605 * the lower half, and the second dword is the upper half.
606 */
607 pos += 4;
608 pci_read_config_dword(dev, pos, &dword);
609 dsn = (u64)dword;
610 pci_read_config_dword(dev, pos + 4, &dword);
611 dsn |= ((u64)dword) << 32;
612
613 return dsn;
614}
615EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_get_dsn);
616
617static int __pci_find_next_ht_cap(struct pci_dev *dev, int pos, int ht_cap)
618{
619 int rc, ttl = PCI_FIND_CAP_TTL;
620 u8 cap, mask;
621
622 if (ht_cap == HT_CAPTYPE_SLAVE || ht_cap == HT_CAPTYPE_HOST)
623 mask = HT_3BIT_CAP_MASK;
624 else
625 mask = HT_5BIT_CAP_MASK;
626
627 pos = __pci_find_next_cap_ttl(dev->bus, dev->devfn, pos,
628 PCI_CAP_ID_HT, &ttl);
629 while (pos) {
630 rc = pci_read_config_byte(dev, pos + 3, &cap);
631 if (rc != PCIBIOS_SUCCESSFUL)
632 return 0;
633
634 if ((cap & mask) == ht_cap)
635 return pos;
636
637 pos = __pci_find_next_cap_ttl(dev->bus, dev->devfn,
638 pos + PCI_CAP_LIST_NEXT,
639 PCI_CAP_ID_HT, &ttl);
640 }
641
642 return 0;
643}
644/**
645 * pci_find_next_ht_capability - query a device's Hypertransport capabilities
646 * @dev: PCI device to query
647 * @pos: Position from which to continue searching
648 * @ht_cap: Hypertransport capability code
649 *
650 * To be used in conjunction with pci_find_ht_capability() to search for
651 * all capabilities matching @ht_cap. @pos should always be a value returned
652 * from pci_find_ht_capability().
653 *
654 * NB. To be 100% safe against broken PCI devices, the caller should take
655 * steps to avoid an infinite loop.
656 */
657int pci_find_next_ht_capability(struct pci_dev *dev, int pos, int ht_cap)
658{
659 return __pci_find_next_ht_cap(dev, pos + PCI_CAP_LIST_NEXT, ht_cap);
660}
661EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_find_next_ht_capability);
662
663/**
664 * pci_find_ht_capability - query a device's Hypertransport capabilities
665 * @dev: PCI device to query
666 * @ht_cap: Hypertransport capability code
667 *
668 * Tell if a device supports a given Hypertransport capability.
669 * Returns an address within the device's PCI configuration space
670 * or 0 in case the device does not support the request capability.
671 * The address points to the PCI capability, of type PCI_CAP_ID_HT,
672 * which has a Hypertransport capability matching @ht_cap.
673 */
674int pci_find_ht_capability(struct pci_dev *dev, int ht_cap)
675{
676 int pos;
677
678 pos = __pci_bus_find_cap_start(dev->bus, dev->devfn, dev->hdr_type);
679 if (pos)
680 pos = __pci_find_next_ht_cap(dev, pos, ht_cap);
681
682 return pos;
683}
684EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_find_ht_capability);
685
686/**
687 * pci_find_parent_resource - return resource region of parent bus of given
688 * region
689 * @dev: PCI device structure contains resources to be searched
690 * @res: child resource record for which parent is sought
691 *
692 * For given resource region of given device, return the resource region of
693 * parent bus the given region is contained in.
694 */
695struct resource *pci_find_parent_resource(const struct pci_dev *dev,
696 struct resource *res)
697{
698 const struct pci_bus *bus = dev->bus;
699 struct resource *r;
700 int i;
701
702 pci_bus_for_each_resource(bus, r, i) {
703 if (!r)
704 continue;
705 if (resource_contains(r, res)) {
706
707 /*
708 * If the window is prefetchable but the BAR is
709 * not, the allocator made a mistake.
710 */
711 if (r->flags & IORESOURCE_PREFETCH &&
712 !(res->flags & IORESOURCE_PREFETCH))
713 return NULL;
714
715 /*
716 * If we're below a transparent bridge, there may
717 * be both a positively-decoded aperture and a
718 * subtractively-decoded region that contain the BAR.
719 * We want the positively-decoded one, so this depends
720 * on pci_bus_for_each_resource() giving us those
721 * first.
722 */
723 return r;
724 }
725 }
726 return NULL;
727}
728EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_find_parent_resource);
729
730/**
731 * pci_find_resource - Return matching PCI device resource
732 * @dev: PCI device to query
733 * @res: Resource to look for
734 *
735 * Goes over standard PCI resources (BARs) and checks if the given resource
736 * is partially or fully contained in any of them. In that case the
737 * matching resource is returned, %NULL otherwise.
738 */
739struct resource *pci_find_resource(struct pci_dev *dev, struct resource *res)
740{
741 int i;
742
743 for (i = 0; i < PCI_STD_NUM_BARS; i++) {
744 struct resource *r = &dev->resource[i];
745
746 if (r->start && resource_contains(r, res))
747 return r;
748 }
749
750 return NULL;
751}
752EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_find_resource);
753
754/**
755 * pci_wait_for_pending - wait for @mask bit(s) to clear in status word @pos
756 * @dev: the PCI device to operate on
757 * @pos: config space offset of status word
758 * @mask: mask of bit(s) to care about in status word
759 *
760 * Return 1 when mask bit(s) in status word clear, 0 otherwise.
761 */
762int pci_wait_for_pending(struct pci_dev *dev, int pos, u16 mask)
763{
764 int i;
765
766 /* Wait for Transaction Pending bit clean */
767 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++) {
768 u16 status;
769 if (i)
770 msleep((1 << (i - 1)) * 100);
771
772 pci_read_config_word(dev, pos, &status);
773 if (!(status & mask))
774 return 1;
775 }
776
777 return 0;
778}
779
780static int pci_acs_enable;
781
782/**
783 * pci_request_acs - ask for ACS to be enabled if supported
784 */
785void pci_request_acs(void)
786{
787 pci_acs_enable = 1;
788}
789
790static const char *disable_acs_redir_param;
791
792/**
793 * pci_disable_acs_redir - disable ACS redirect capabilities
794 * @dev: the PCI device
795 *
796 * For only devices specified in the disable_acs_redir parameter.
797 */
798static void pci_disable_acs_redir(struct pci_dev *dev)
799{
800 int ret = 0;
801 const char *p;
802 int pos;
803 u16 ctrl;
804
805 if (!disable_acs_redir_param)
806 return;
807
808 p = disable_acs_redir_param;
809 while (*p) {
810 ret = pci_dev_str_match(dev, p, &p);
811 if (ret < 0) {
812 pr_info_once("PCI: Can't parse disable_acs_redir parameter: %s\n",
813 disable_acs_redir_param);
814
815 break;
816 } else if (ret == 1) {
817 /* Found a match */
818 break;
819 }
820
821 if (*p != ';' && *p != ',') {
822 /* End of param or invalid format */
823 break;
824 }
825 p++;
826 }
827
828 if (ret != 1)
829 return;
830
831 if (!pci_dev_specific_disable_acs_redir(dev))
832 return;
833
834 pos = dev->acs_cap;
835 if (!pos) {
836 pci_warn(dev, "cannot disable ACS redirect for this hardware as it does not have ACS capabilities\n");
837 return;
838 }
839
840 pci_read_config_word(dev, pos + PCI_ACS_CTRL, &ctrl);
841
842 /* P2P Request & Completion Redirect */
843 ctrl &= ~(PCI_ACS_RR | PCI_ACS_CR | PCI_ACS_EC);
844
845 pci_write_config_word(dev, pos + PCI_ACS_CTRL, ctrl);
846
847 pci_info(dev, "disabled ACS redirect\n");
848}
849
850/**
851 * pci_std_enable_acs - enable ACS on devices using standard ACS capabilities
852 * @dev: the PCI device
853 */
854static void pci_std_enable_acs(struct pci_dev *dev)
855{
856 int pos;
857 u16 cap;
858 u16 ctrl;
859
860 pos = dev->acs_cap;
861 if (!pos)
862 return;
863
864 pci_read_config_word(dev, pos + PCI_ACS_CAP, &cap);
865 pci_read_config_word(dev, pos + PCI_ACS_CTRL, &ctrl);
866
867 /* Source Validation */
868 ctrl |= (cap & PCI_ACS_SV);
869
870 /* P2P Request Redirect */
871 ctrl |= (cap & PCI_ACS_RR);
872
873 /* P2P Completion Redirect */
874 ctrl |= (cap & PCI_ACS_CR);
875
876 /* Upstream Forwarding */
877 ctrl |= (cap & PCI_ACS_UF);
878
879 pci_write_config_word(dev, pos + PCI_ACS_CTRL, ctrl);
880}
881
882/**
883 * pci_enable_acs - enable ACS if hardware support it
884 * @dev: the PCI device
885 */
886static void pci_enable_acs(struct pci_dev *dev)
887{
888 if (!pci_acs_enable)
889 goto disable_acs_redir;
890
891 if (!pci_dev_specific_enable_acs(dev))
892 goto disable_acs_redir;
893
894 pci_std_enable_acs(dev);
895
896disable_acs_redir:
897 /*
898 * Note: pci_disable_acs_redir() must be called even if ACS was not
899 * enabled by the kernel because it may have been enabled by
900 * platform firmware. So if we are told to disable it, we should
901 * always disable it after setting the kernel's default
902 * preferences.
903 */
904 pci_disable_acs_redir(dev);
905}
906
907/**
908 * pci_restore_bars - restore a device's BAR values (e.g. after wake-up)
909 * @dev: PCI device to have its BARs restored
910 *
911 * Restore the BAR values for a given device, so as to make it
912 * accessible by its driver.
913 */
914static void pci_restore_bars(struct pci_dev *dev)
915{
916 int i;
917
918 for (i = 0; i < PCI_BRIDGE_RESOURCES; i++)
919 pci_update_resource(dev, i);
920}
921
922static const struct pci_platform_pm_ops *pci_platform_pm;
923
924int pci_set_platform_pm(const struct pci_platform_pm_ops *ops)
925{
926 if (!ops->is_manageable || !ops->set_state || !ops->get_state ||
927 !ops->choose_state || !ops->set_wakeup || !ops->need_resume)
928 return -EINVAL;
929 pci_platform_pm = ops;
930 return 0;
931}
932
933static inline bool platform_pci_power_manageable(struct pci_dev *dev)
934{
935 return pci_platform_pm ? pci_platform_pm->is_manageable(dev) : false;
936}
937
938static inline int platform_pci_set_power_state(struct pci_dev *dev,
939 pci_power_t t)
940{
941 return pci_platform_pm ? pci_platform_pm->set_state(dev, t) : -ENOSYS;
942}
943
944static inline pci_power_t platform_pci_get_power_state(struct pci_dev *dev)
945{
946 return pci_platform_pm ? pci_platform_pm->get_state(dev) : PCI_UNKNOWN;
947}
948
949static inline void platform_pci_refresh_power_state(struct pci_dev *dev)
950{
951 if (pci_platform_pm && pci_platform_pm->refresh_state)
952 pci_platform_pm->refresh_state(dev);
953}
954
955static inline pci_power_t platform_pci_choose_state(struct pci_dev *dev)
956{
957 return pci_platform_pm ?
958 pci_platform_pm->choose_state(dev) : PCI_POWER_ERROR;
959}
960
961static inline int platform_pci_set_wakeup(struct pci_dev *dev, bool enable)
962{
963 return pci_platform_pm ?
964 pci_platform_pm->set_wakeup(dev, enable) : -ENODEV;
965}
966
967static inline bool platform_pci_need_resume(struct pci_dev *dev)
968{
969 return pci_platform_pm ? pci_platform_pm->need_resume(dev) : false;
970}
971
972static inline bool platform_pci_bridge_d3(struct pci_dev *dev)
973{
974 if (pci_platform_pm && pci_platform_pm->bridge_d3)
975 return pci_platform_pm->bridge_d3(dev);
976 return false;
977}
978
979/**
980 * pci_raw_set_power_state - Use PCI PM registers to set the power state of
981 * given PCI device
982 * @dev: PCI device to handle.
983 * @state: PCI power state (D0, D1, D2, D3hot) to put the device into.
984 *
985 * RETURN VALUE:
986 * -EINVAL if the requested state is invalid.
987 * -EIO if device does not support PCI PM or its PM capabilities register has a
988 * wrong version, or device doesn't support the requested state.
989 * 0 if device already is in the requested state.
990 * 0 if device's power state has been successfully changed.
991 */
992static int pci_raw_set_power_state(struct pci_dev *dev, pci_power_t state)
993{
994 u16 pmcsr;
995 bool need_restore = false;
996
997 /* Check if we're already there */
998 if (dev->current_state == state)
999 return 0;
1000
1001 if (!dev->pm_cap)
1002 return -EIO;
1003
1004 if (state < PCI_D0 || state > PCI_D3hot)
1005 return -EINVAL;
1006
1007 /*
1008 * Validate transition: We can enter D0 from any state, but if
1009 * we're already in a low-power state, we can only go deeper. E.g.,
1010 * we can go from D1 to D3, but we can't go directly from D3 to D1;
1011 * we'd have to go from D3 to D0, then to D1.
1012 */
1013 if (state != PCI_D0 && dev->current_state <= PCI_D3cold
1014 && dev->current_state > state) {
1015 pci_err(dev, "invalid power transition (from %s to %s)\n",
1016 pci_power_name(dev->current_state),
1017 pci_power_name(state));
1018 return -EINVAL;
1019 }
1020
1021 /* Check if this device supports the desired state */
1022 if ((state == PCI_D1 && !dev->d1_support)
1023 || (state == PCI_D2 && !dev->d2_support))
1024 return -EIO;
1025
1026 pci_read_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, &pmcsr);
1027 if (pmcsr == (u16) ~0) {
1028 pci_err(dev, "can't change power state from %s to %s (config space inaccessible)\n",
1029 pci_power_name(dev->current_state),
1030 pci_power_name(state));
1031 return -EIO;
1032 }
1033
1034 /*
1035 * If we're (effectively) in D3, force entire word to 0.
1036 * This doesn't affect PME_Status, disables PME_En, and
1037 * sets PowerState to 0.
1038 */
1039 switch (dev->current_state) {
1040 case PCI_D0:
1041 case PCI_D1:
1042 case PCI_D2:
1043 pmcsr &= ~PCI_PM_CTRL_STATE_MASK;
1044 pmcsr |= state;
1045 break;
1046 case PCI_D3hot:
1047 case PCI_D3cold:
1048 case PCI_UNKNOWN: /* Boot-up */
1049 if ((pmcsr & PCI_PM_CTRL_STATE_MASK) == PCI_D3hot
1050 && !(pmcsr & PCI_PM_CTRL_NO_SOFT_RESET))
1051 need_restore = true;
1052 fallthrough; /* force to D0 */
1053 default:
1054 pmcsr = 0;
1055 break;
1056 }
1057
1058 /* Enter specified state */
1059 pci_write_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, pmcsr);
1060
1061 /*
1062 * Mandatory power management transition delays; see PCI PM 1.1
1063 * 5.6.1 table 18
1064 */
1065 if (state == PCI_D3hot || dev->current_state == PCI_D3hot)
1066 pci_dev_d3_sleep(dev);
1067 else if (state == PCI_D2 || dev->current_state == PCI_D2)
1068 msleep(PCI_PM_D2_DELAY);
1069
1070 pci_read_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, &pmcsr);
1071 dev->current_state = (pmcsr & PCI_PM_CTRL_STATE_MASK);
1072 if (dev->current_state != state)
1073 pci_info_ratelimited(dev, "refused to change power state from %s to %s\n",
1074 pci_power_name(dev->current_state),
1075 pci_power_name(state));
1076
1077 /*
1078 * According to section 5.4.1 of the "PCI BUS POWER MANAGEMENT
1079 * INTERFACE SPECIFICATION, REV. 1.2", a device transitioning
1080 * from D3hot to D0 _may_ perform an internal reset, thereby
1081 * going to "D0 Uninitialized" rather than "D0 Initialized".
1082 * For example, at least some versions of the 3c905B and the
1083 * 3c556B exhibit this behaviour.
1084 *
1085 * At least some laptop BIOSen (e.g. the Thinkpad T21) leave
1086 * devices in a D3hot state at boot. Consequently, we need to
1087 * restore at least the BARs so that the device will be
1088 * accessible to its driver.
1089 */
1090 if (need_restore)
1091 pci_restore_bars(dev);
1092
1093 if (dev->bus->self)
1094 pcie_aspm_pm_state_change(dev->bus->self);
1095
1096 return 0;
1097}
1098
1099/**
1100 * pci_update_current_state - Read power state of given device and cache it
1101 * @dev: PCI device to handle.
1102 * @state: State to cache in case the device doesn't have the PM capability
1103 *
1104 * The power state is read from the PMCSR register, which however is
1105 * inaccessible in D3cold. The platform firmware is therefore queried first
1106 * to detect accessibility of the register. In case the platform firmware
1107 * reports an incorrect state or the device isn't power manageable by the
1108 * platform at all, we try to detect D3cold by testing accessibility of the
1109 * vendor ID in config space.
1110 */
1111void pci_update_current_state(struct pci_dev *dev, pci_power_t state)
1112{
1113 if (platform_pci_get_power_state(dev) == PCI_D3cold ||
1114 !pci_device_is_present(dev)) {
1115 dev->current_state = PCI_D3cold;
1116 } else if (dev->pm_cap) {
1117 u16 pmcsr;
1118
1119 pci_read_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, &pmcsr);
1120 dev->current_state = (pmcsr & PCI_PM_CTRL_STATE_MASK);
1121 } else {
1122 dev->current_state = state;
1123 }
1124}
1125
1126/**
1127 * pci_refresh_power_state - Refresh the given device's power state data
1128 * @dev: Target PCI device.
1129 *
1130 * Ask the platform to refresh the devices power state information and invoke
1131 * pci_update_current_state() to update its current PCI power state.
1132 */
1133void pci_refresh_power_state(struct pci_dev *dev)
1134{
1135 if (platform_pci_power_manageable(dev))
1136 platform_pci_refresh_power_state(dev);
1137
1138 pci_update_current_state(dev, dev->current_state);
1139}
1140
1141/**
1142 * pci_platform_power_transition - Use platform to change device power state
1143 * @dev: PCI device to handle.
1144 * @state: State to put the device into.
1145 */
1146int pci_platform_power_transition(struct pci_dev *dev, pci_power_t state)
1147{
1148 int error;
1149
1150 if (platform_pci_power_manageable(dev)) {
1151 error = platform_pci_set_power_state(dev, state);
1152 if (!error)
1153 pci_update_current_state(dev, state);
1154 } else
1155 error = -ENODEV;
1156
1157 if (error && !dev->pm_cap) /* Fall back to PCI_D0 */
1158 dev->current_state = PCI_D0;
1159
1160 return error;
1161}
1162EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_platform_power_transition);
1163
1164/**
1165 * pci_wakeup - Wake up a PCI device
1166 * @pci_dev: Device to handle.
1167 * @ign: ignored parameter
1168 */
1169static int pci_wakeup(struct pci_dev *pci_dev, void *ign)
1170{
1171 pci_wakeup_event(pci_dev);
1172 pm_request_resume(&pci_dev->dev);
1173 return 0;
1174}
1175
1176/**
1177 * pci_wakeup_bus - Walk given bus and wake up devices on it
1178 * @bus: Top bus of the subtree to walk.
1179 */
1180void pci_wakeup_bus(struct pci_bus *bus)
1181{
1182 if (bus)
1183 pci_walk_bus(bus, pci_wakeup, NULL);
1184}
1185
1186static int pci_dev_wait(struct pci_dev *dev, char *reset_type, int timeout)
1187{
1188 int delay = 1;
1189 u32 id;
1190
1191 /*
1192 * After reset, the device should not silently discard config
1193 * requests, but it may still indicate that it needs more time by
1194 * responding to them with CRS completions. The Root Port will
1195 * generally synthesize ~0 data to complete the read (except when
1196 * CRS SV is enabled and the read was for the Vendor ID; in that
1197 * case it synthesizes 0x0001 data).
1198 *
1199 * Wait for the device to return a non-CRS completion. Read the
1200 * Command register instead of Vendor ID so we don't have to
1201 * contend with the CRS SV value.
1202 */
1203 pci_read_config_dword(dev, PCI_COMMAND, &id);
1204 while (id == ~0) {
1205 if (delay > timeout) {
1206 pci_warn(dev, "not ready %dms after %s; giving up\n",
1207 delay - 1, reset_type);
1208 return -ENOTTY;
1209 }
1210
1211 if (delay > 1000)
1212 pci_info(dev, "not ready %dms after %s; waiting\n",
1213 delay - 1, reset_type);
1214
1215 msleep(delay);
1216 delay *= 2;
1217 pci_read_config_dword(dev, PCI_COMMAND, &id);
1218 }
1219
1220 if (delay > 1000)
1221 pci_info(dev, "ready %dms after %s\n", delay - 1,
1222 reset_type);
1223
1224 return 0;
1225}
1226
1227/**
1228 * pci_power_up - Put the given device into D0
1229 * @dev: PCI device to power up
1230 */
1231int pci_power_up(struct pci_dev *dev)
1232{
1233 pci_platform_power_transition(dev, PCI_D0);
1234
1235 /*
1236 * Mandatory power management transition delays are handled in
1237 * pci_pm_resume_noirq() and pci_pm_runtime_resume() of the
1238 * corresponding bridge.
1239 */
1240 if (dev->runtime_d3cold) {
1241 /*
1242 * When powering on a bridge from D3cold, the whole hierarchy
1243 * may be powered on into D0uninitialized state, resume them to
1244 * give them a chance to suspend again
1245 */
1246 pci_wakeup_bus(dev->subordinate);
1247 }
1248
1249 return pci_raw_set_power_state(dev, PCI_D0);
1250}
1251
1252/**
1253 * __pci_dev_set_current_state - Set current state of a PCI device
1254 * @dev: Device to handle
1255 * @data: pointer to state to be set
1256 */
1257static int __pci_dev_set_current_state(struct pci_dev *dev, void *data)
1258{
1259 pci_power_t state = *(pci_power_t *)data;
1260
1261 dev->current_state = state;
1262 return 0;
1263}
1264
1265/**
1266 * pci_bus_set_current_state - Walk given bus and set current state of devices
1267 * @bus: Top bus of the subtree to walk.
1268 * @state: state to be set
1269 */
1270void pci_bus_set_current_state(struct pci_bus *bus, pci_power_t state)
1271{
1272 if (bus)
1273 pci_walk_bus(bus, __pci_dev_set_current_state, &state);
1274}
1275
1276/**
1277 * pci_set_power_state - Set the power state of a PCI device
1278 * @dev: PCI device to handle.
1279 * @state: PCI power state (D0, D1, D2, D3hot) to put the device into.
1280 *
1281 * Transition a device to a new power state, using the platform firmware and/or
1282 * the device's PCI PM registers.
1283 *
1284 * RETURN VALUE:
1285 * -EINVAL if the requested state is invalid.
1286 * -EIO if device does not support PCI PM or its PM capabilities register has a
1287 * wrong version, or device doesn't support the requested state.
1288 * 0 if the transition is to D1 or D2 but D1 and D2 are not supported.
1289 * 0 if device already is in the requested state.
1290 * 0 if the transition is to D3 but D3 is not supported.
1291 * 0 if device's power state has been successfully changed.
1292 */
1293int pci_set_power_state(struct pci_dev *dev, pci_power_t state)
1294{
1295 int error;
1296
1297 /* Bound the state we're entering */
1298 if (state > PCI_D3cold)
1299 state = PCI_D3cold;
1300 else if (state < PCI_D0)
1301 state = PCI_D0;
1302 else if ((state == PCI_D1 || state == PCI_D2) && pci_no_d1d2(dev))
1303
1304 /*
1305 * If the device or the parent bridge do not support PCI
1306 * PM, ignore the request if we're doing anything other
1307 * than putting it into D0 (which would only happen on
1308 * boot).
1309 */
1310 return 0;
1311
1312 /* Check if we're already there */
1313 if (dev->current_state == state)
1314 return 0;
1315
1316 if (state == PCI_D0)
1317 return pci_power_up(dev);
1318
1319 /*
1320 * This device is quirked not to be put into D3, so don't put it in
1321 * D3
1322 */
1323 if (state >= PCI_D3hot && (dev->dev_flags & PCI_DEV_FLAGS_NO_D3))
1324 return 0;
1325
1326 /*
1327 * To put device in D3cold, we put device into D3hot in native
1328 * way, then put device into D3cold with platform ops
1329 */
1330 error = pci_raw_set_power_state(dev, state > PCI_D3hot ?
1331 PCI_D3hot : state);
1332
1333 if (pci_platform_power_transition(dev, state))
1334 return error;
1335
1336 /* Powering off a bridge may power off the whole hierarchy */
1337 if (state == PCI_D3cold)
1338 pci_bus_set_current_state(dev->subordinate, PCI_D3cold);
1339
1340 return 0;
1341}
1342EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_set_power_state);
1343
1344/**
1345 * pci_choose_state - Choose the power state of a PCI device
1346 * @dev: PCI device to be suspended
1347 * @state: target sleep state for the whole system. This is the value
1348 * that is passed to suspend() function.
1349 *
1350 * Returns PCI power state suitable for given device and given system
1351 * message.
1352 */
1353pci_power_t pci_choose_state(struct pci_dev *dev, pm_message_t state)
1354{
1355 pci_power_t ret;
1356
1357 if (!dev->pm_cap)
1358 return PCI_D0;
1359
1360 ret = platform_pci_choose_state(dev);
1361 if (ret != PCI_POWER_ERROR)
1362 return ret;
1363
1364 switch (state.event) {
1365 case PM_EVENT_ON:
1366 return PCI_D0;
1367 case PM_EVENT_FREEZE:
1368 case PM_EVENT_PRETHAW:
1369 /* REVISIT both freeze and pre-thaw "should" use D0 */
1370 case PM_EVENT_SUSPEND:
1371 case PM_EVENT_HIBERNATE:
1372 return PCI_D3hot;
1373 default:
1374 pci_info(dev, "unrecognized suspend event %d\n",
1375 state.event);
1376 BUG();
1377 }
1378 return PCI_D0;
1379}
1380EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_choose_state);
1381
1382#define PCI_EXP_SAVE_REGS 7
1383
1384static struct pci_cap_saved_state *_pci_find_saved_cap(struct pci_dev *pci_dev,
1385 u16 cap, bool extended)
1386{
1387 struct pci_cap_saved_state *tmp;
1388
1389 hlist_for_each_entry(tmp, &pci_dev->saved_cap_space, next) {
1390 if (tmp->cap.cap_extended == extended && tmp->cap.cap_nr == cap)
1391 return tmp;
1392 }
1393 return NULL;
1394}
1395
1396struct pci_cap_saved_state *pci_find_saved_cap(struct pci_dev *dev, char cap)
1397{
1398 return _pci_find_saved_cap(dev, cap, false);
1399}
1400
1401struct pci_cap_saved_state *pci_find_saved_ext_cap(struct pci_dev *dev, u16 cap)
1402{
1403 return _pci_find_saved_cap(dev, cap, true);
1404}
1405
1406static int pci_save_pcie_state(struct pci_dev *dev)
1407{
1408 int i = 0;
1409 struct pci_cap_saved_state *save_state;
1410 u16 *cap;
1411
1412 if (!pci_is_pcie(dev))
1413 return 0;
1414
1415 save_state = pci_find_saved_cap(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_EXP);
1416 if (!save_state) {
1417 pci_err(dev, "buffer not found in %s\n", __func__);
1418 return -ENOMEM;
1419 }
1420
1421 cap = (u16 *)&save_state->cap.data[0];
1422 pcie_capability_read_word(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL, &cap[i++]);
1423 pcie_capability_read_word(dev, PCI_EXP_LNKCTL, &cap[i++]);
1424 pcie_capability_read_word(dev, PCI_EXP_SLTCTL, &cap[i++]);
1425 pcie_capability_read_word(dev, PCI_EXP_RTCTL, &cap[i++]);
1426 pcie_capability_read_word(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL2, &cap[i++]);
1427 pcie_capability_read_word(dev, PCI_EXP_LNKCTL2, &cap[i++]);
1428 pcie_capability_read_word(dev, PCI_EXP_SLTCTL2, &cap[i++]);
1429
1430 return 0;
1431}
1432
1433static void pci_restore_pcie_state(struct pci_dev *dev)
1434{
1435 int i = 0;
1436 struct pci_cap_saved_state *save_state;
1437 u16 *cap;
1438
1439 save_state = pci_find_saved_cap(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_EXP);
1440 if (!save_state)
1441 return;
1442
1443 cap = (u16 *)&save_state->cap.data[0];
1444 pcie_capability_write_word(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL, cap[i++]);
1445 pcie_capability_write_word(dev, PCI_EXP_LNKCTL, cap[i++]);
1446 pcie_capability_write_word(dev, PCI_EXP_SLTCTL, cap[i++]);
1447 pcie_capability_write_word(dev, PCI_EXP_RTCTL, cap[i++]);
1448 pcie_capability_write_word(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL2, cap[i++]);
1449 pcie_capability_write_word(dev, PCI_EXP_LNKCTL2, cap[i++]);
1450 pcie_capability_write_word(dev, PCI_EXP_SLTCTL2, cap[i++]);
1451}
1452
1453static int pci_save_pcix_state(struct pci_dev *dev)
1454{
1455 int pos;
1456 struct pci_cap_saved_state *save_state;
1457
1458 pos = pci_find_capability(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_PCIX);
1459 if (!pos)
1460 return 0;
1461
1462 save_state = pci_find_saved_cap(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_PCIX);
1463 if (!save_state) {
1464 pci_err(dev, "buffer not found in %s\n", __func__);
1465 return -ENOMEM;
1466 }
1467
1468 pci_read_config_word(dev, pos + PCI_X_CMD,
1469 (u16 *)save_state->cap.data);
1470
1471 return 0;
1472}
1473
1474static void pci_restore_pcix_state(struct pci_dev *dev)
1475{
1476 int i = 0, pos;
1477 struct pci_cap_saved_state *save_state;
1478 u16 *cap;
1479
1480 save_state = pci_find_saved_cap(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_PCIX);
1481 pos = pci_find_capability(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_PCIX);
1482 if (!save_state || !pos)
1483 return;
1484 cap = (u16 *)&save_state->cap.data[0];
1485
1486 pci_write_config_word(dev, pos + PCI_X_CMD, cap[i++]);
1487}
1488
1489static void pci_save_ltr_state(struct pci_dev *dev)
1490{
1491 int ltr;
1492 struct pci_cap_saved_state *save_state;
1493 u16 *cap;
1494
1495 if (!pci_is_pcie(dev))
1496 return;
1497
1498 ltr = pci_find_ext_capability(dev, PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_LTR);
1499 if (!ltr)
1500 return;
1501
1502 save_state = pci_find_saved_ext_cap(dev, PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_LTR);
1503 if (!save_state) {
1504 pci_err(dev, "no suspend buffer for LTR; ASPM issues possible after resume\n");
1505 return;
1506 }
1507
1508 cap = (u16 *)&save_state->cap.data[0];
1509 pci_read_config_word(dev, ltr + PCI_LTR_MAX_SNOOP_LAT, cap++);
1510 pci_read_config_word(dev, ltr + PCI_LTR_MAX_NOSNOOP_LAT, cap++);
1511}
1512
1513static void pci_restore_ltr_state(struct pci_dev *dev)
1514{
1515 struct pci_cap_saved_state *save_state;
1516 int ltr;
1517 u16 *cap;
1518
1519 save_state = pci_find_saved_ext_cap(dev, PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_LTR);
1520 ltr = pci_find_ext_capability(dev, PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_LTR);
1521 if (!save_state || !ltr)
1522 return;
1523
1524 cap = (u16 *)&save_state->cap.data[0];
1525 pci_write_config_word(dev, ltr + PCI_LTR_MAX_SNOOP_LAT, *cap++);
1526 pci_write_config_word(dev, ltr + PCI_LTR_MAX_NOSNOOP_LAT, *cap++);
1527}
1528
1529/**
1530 * pci_save_state - save the PCI configuration space of a device before
1531 * suspending
1532 * @dev: PCI device that we're dealing with
1533 */
1534int pci_save_state(struct pci_dev *dev)
1535{
1536 int i;
1537 /* XXX: 100% dword access ok here? */
1538 for (i = 0; i < 16; i++) {
1539 pci_read_config_dword(dev, i * 4, &dev->saved_config_space[i]);
1540 pci_dbg(dev, "saving config space at offset %#x (reading %#x)\n",
1541 i * 4, dev->saved_config_space[i]);
1542 }
1543 dev->state_saved = true;
1544
1545 i = pci_save_pcie_state(dev);
1546 if (i != 0)
1547 return i;
1548
1549 i = pci_save_pcix_state(dev);
1550 if (i != 0)
1551 return i;
1552
1553 pci_save_ltr_state(dev);
1554 pci_save_dpc_state(dev);
1555 pci_save_aer_state(dev);
1556 return pci_save_vc_state(dev);
1557}
1558EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_save_state);
1559
1560static void pci_restore_config_dword(struct pci_dev *pdev, int offset,
1561 u32 saved_val, int retry, bool force)
1562{
1563 u32 val;
1564
1565 pci_read_config_dword(pdev, offset, &val);
1566 if (!force && val == saved_val)
1567 return;
1568
1569 for (;;) {
1570 pci_dbg(pdev, "restoring config space at offset %#x (was %#x, writing %#x)\n",
1571 offset, val, saved_val);
1572 pci_write_config_dword(pdev, offset, saved_val);
1573 if (retry-- <= 0)
1574 return;
1575
1576 pci_read_config_dword(pdev, offset, &val);
1577 if (val == saved_val)
1578 return;
1579
1580 mdelay(1);
1581 }
1582}
1583
1584static void pci_restore_config_space_range(struct pci_dev *pdev,
1585 int start, int end, int retry,
1586 bool force)
1587{
1588 int index;
1589
1590 for (index = end; index >= start; index--)
1591 pci_restore_config_dword(pdev, 4 * index,
1592 pdev->saved_config_space[index],
1593 retry, force);
1594}
1595
1596static void pci_restore_config_space(struct pci_dev *pdev)
1597{
1598 if (pdev->hdr_type == PCI_HEADER_TYPE_NORMAL) {
1599 pci_restore_config_space_range(pdev, 10, 15, 0, false);
1600 /* Restore BARs before the command register. */
1601 pci_restore_config_space_range(pdev, 4, 9, 10, false);
1602 pci_restore_config_space_range(pdev, 0, 3, 0, false);
1603 } else if (pdev->hdr_type == PCI_HEADER_TYPE_BRIDGE) {
1604 pci_restore_config_space_range(pdev, 12, 15, 0, false);
1605
1606 /*
1607 * Force rewriting of prefetch registers to avoid S3 resume
1608 * issues on Intel PCI bridges that occur when these
1609 * registers are not explicitly written.
1610 */
1611 pci_restore_config_space_range(pdev, 9, 11, 0, true);
1612 pci_restore_config_space_range(pdev, 0, 8, 0, false);
1613 } else {
1614 pci_restore_config_space_range(pdev, 0, 15, 0, false);
1615 }
1616}
1617
1618static void pci_restore_rebar_state(struct pci_dev *pdev)
1619{
1620 unsigned int pos, nbars, i;
1621 u32 ctrl;
1622
1623 pos = pci_find_ext_capability(pdev, PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_REBAR);
1624 if (!pos)
1625 return;
1626
1627 pci_read_config_dword(pdev, pos + PCI_REBAR_CTRL, &ctrl);
1628 nbars = (ctrl & PCI_REBAR_CTRL_NBAR_MASK) >>
1629 PCI_REBAR_CTRL_NBAR_SHIFT;
1630
1631 for (i = 0; i < nbars; i++, pos += 8) {
1632 struct resource *res;
1633 int bar_idx, size;
1634
1635 pci_read_config_dword(pdev, pos + PCI_REBAR_CTRL, &ctrl);
1636 bar_idx = ctrl & PCI_REBAR_CTRL_BAR_IDX;
1637 res = pdev->resource + bar_idx;
1638 size = ilog2(resource_size(res)) - 20;
1639 ctrl &= ~PCI_REBAR_CTRL_BAR_SIZE;
1640 ctrl |= size << PCI_REBAR_CTRL_BAR_SHIFT;
1641 pci_write_config_dword(pdev, pos + PCI_REBAR_CTRL, ctrl);
1642 }
1643}
1644
1645/**
1646 * pci_restore_state - Restore the saved state of a PCI device
1647 * @dev: PCI device that we're dealing with
1648 */
1649void pci_restore_state(struct pci_dev *dev)
1650{
1651 if (!dev->state_saved)
1652 return;
1653
1654 /*
1655 * Restore max latencies (in the LTR capability) before enabling
1656 * LTR itself (in the PCIe capability).
1657 */
1658 pci_restore_ltr_state(dev);
1659
1660 pci_restore_pcie_state(dev);
1661 pci_restore_pasid_state(dev);
1662 pci_restore_pri_state(dev);
1663 pci_restore_ats_state(dev);
1664 pci_restore_vc_state(dev);
1665 pci_restore_rebar_state(dev);
1666 pci_restore_dpc_state(dev);
1667
1668 pci_aer_clear_status(dev);
1669 pci_restore_aer_state(dev);
1670
1671 pci_restore_config_space(dev);
1672
1673 pci_restore_pcix_state(dev);
1674 pci_restore_msi_state(dev);
1675
1676 /* Restore ACS and IOV configuration state */
1677 pci_enable_acs(dev);
1678 pci_restore_iov_state(dev);
1679
1680 dev->state_saved = false;
1681}
1682EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_restore_state);
1683
1684struct pci_saved_state {
1685 u32 config_space[16];
1686 struct pci_cap_saved_data cap[];
1687};
1688
1689/**
1690 * pci_store_saved_state - Allocate and return an opaque struct containing
1691 * the device saved state.
1692 * @dev: PCI device that we're dealing with
1693 *
1694 * Return NULL if no state or error.
1695 */
1696struct pci_saved_state *pci_store_saved_state(struct pci_dev *dev)
1697{
1698 struct pci_saved_state *state;
1699 struct pci_cap_saved_state *tmp;
1700 struct pci_cap_saved_data *cap;
1701 size_t size;
1702
1703 if (!dev->state_saved)
1704 return NULL;
1705
1706 size = sizeof(*state) + sizeof(struct pci_cap_saved_data);
1707
1708 hlist_for_each_entry(tmp, &dev->saved_cap_space, next)
1709 size += sizeof(struct pci_cap_saved_data) + tmp->cap.size;
1710
1711 state = kzalloc(size, GFP_KERNEL);
1712 if (!state)
1713 return NULL;
1714
1715 memcpy(state->config_space, dev->saved_config_space,
1716 sizeof(state->config_space));
1717
1718 cap = state->cap;
1719 hlist_for_each_entry(tmp, &dev->saved_cap_space, next) {
1720 size_t len = sizeof(struct pci_cap_saved_data) + tmp->cap.size;
1721 memcpy(cap, &tmp->cap, len);
1722 cap = (struct pci_cap_saved_data *)((u8 *)cap + len);
1723 }
1724 /* Empty cap_save terminates list */
1725
1726 return state;
1727}
1728EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_store_saved_state);
1729
1730/**
1731 * pci_load_saved_state - Reload the provided save state into struct pci_dev.
1732 * @dev: PCI device that we're dealing with
1733 * @state: Saved state returned from pci_store_saved_state()
1734 */
1735int pci_load_saved_state(struct pci_dev *dev,
1736 struct pci_saved_state *state)
1737{
1738 struct pci_cap_saved_data *cap;
1739
1740 dev->state_saved = false;
1741
1742 if (!state)
1743 return 0;
1744
1745 memcpy(dev->saved_config_space, state->config_space,
1746 sizeof(state->config_space));
1747
1748 cap = state->cap;
1749 while (cap->size) {
1750 struct pci_cap_saved_state *tmp;
1751
1752 tmp = _pci_find_saved_cap(dev, cap->cap_nr, cap->cap_extended);
1753 if (!tmp || tmp->cap.size != cap->size)
1754 return -EINVAL;
1755
1756 memcpy(tmp->cap.data, cap->data, tmp->cap.size);
1757 cap = (struct pci_cap_saved_data *)((u8 *)cap +
1758 sizeof(struct pci_cap_saved_data) + cap->size);
1759 }
1760
1761 dev->state_saved = true;
1762 return 0;
1763}
1764EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_load_saved_state);
1765
1766/**
1767 * pci_load_and_free_saved_state - Reload the save state pointed to by state,
1768 * and free the memory allocated for it.
1769 * @dev: PCI device that we're dealing with
1770 * @state: Pointer to saved state returned from pci_store_saved_state()
1771 */
1772int pci_load_and_free_saved_state(struct pci_dev *dev,
1773 struct pci_saved_state **state)
1774{
1775 int ret = pci_load_saved_state(dev, *state);
1776 kfree(*state);
1777 *state = NULL;
1778 return ret;
1779}
1780EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_load_and_free_saved_state);
1781
1782int __weak pcibios_enable_device(struct pci_dev *dev, int bars)
1783{
1784 return pci_enable_resources(dev, bars);
1785}
1786
1787static int do_pci_enable_device(struct pci_dev *dev, int bars)
1788{
1789 int err;
1790 struct pci_dev *bridge;
1791 u16 cmd;
1792 u8 pin;
1793
1794 err = pci_set_power_state(dev, PCI_D0);
1795 if (err < 0 && err != -EIO)
1796 return err;
1797
1798 bridge = pci_upstream_bridge(dev);
1799 if (bridge)
1800 pcie_aspm_powersave_config_link(bridge);
1801
1802 err = pcibios_enable_device(dev, bars);
1803 if (err < 0)
1804 return err;
1805 pci_fixup_device(pci_fixup_enable, dev);
1806
1807 if (dev->msi_enabled || dev->msix_enabled)
1808 return 0;
1809
1810 pci_read_config_byte(dev, PCI_INTERRUPT_PIN, &pin);
1811 if (pin) {
1812 pci_read_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, &cmd);
1813 if (cmd & PCI_COMMAND_INTX_DISABLE)
1814 pci_write_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND,
1815 cmd & ~PCI_COMMAND_INTX_DISABLE);
1816 }
1817
1818 return 0;
1819}
1820
1821/**
1822 * pci_reenable_device - Resume abandoned device
1823 * @dev: PCI device to be resumed
1824 *
1825 * NOTE: This function is a backend of pci_default_resume() and is not supposed
1826 * to be called by normal code, write proper resume handler and use it instead.
1827 */
1828int pci_reenable_device(struct pci_dev *dev)
1829{
1830 if (pci_is_enabled(dev))
1831 return do_pci_enable_device(dev, (1 << PCI_NUM_RESOURCES) - 1);
1832 return 0;
1833}
1834EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_reenable_device);
1835
1836static void pci_enable_bridge(struct pci_dev *dev)
1837{
1838 struct pci_dev *bridge;
1839 int retval;
1840
1841 bridge = pci_upstream_bridge(dev);
1842 if (bridge)
1843 pci_enable_bridge(bridge);
1844
1845 if (pci_is_enabled(dev)) {
1846 if (!dev->is_busmaster)
1847 pci_set_master(dev);
1848 return;
1849 }
1850
1851 retval = pci_enable_device(dev);
1852 if (retval)
1853 pci_err(dev, "Error enabling bridge (%d), continuing\n",
1854 retval);
1855 pci_set_master(dev);
1856}
1857
1858static int pci_enable_device_flags(struct pci_dev *dev, unsigned long flags)
1859{
1860 struct pci_dev *bridge;
1861 int err;
1862 int i, bars = 0;
1863
1864 /*
1865 * Power state could be unknown at this point, either due to a fresh
1866 * boot or a device removal call. So get the current power state
1867 * so that things like MSI message writing will behave as expected
1868 * (e.g. if the device really is in D0 at enable time).
1869 */
1870 if (dev->pm_cap) {
1871 u16 pmcsr;
1872 pci_read_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, &pmcsr);
1873 dev->current_state = (pmcsr & PCI_PM_CTRL_STATE_MASK);
1874 }
1875
1876 if (atomic_inc_return(&dev->enable_cnt) > 1)
1877 return 0; /* already enabled */
1878
1879 bridge = pci_upstream_bridge(dev);
1880 if (bridge)
1881 pci_enable_bridge(bridge);
1882
1883 /* only skip sriov related */
1884 for (i = 0; i <= PCI_ROM_RESOURCE; i++)
1885 if (dev->resource[i].flags & flags)
1886 bars |= (1 << i);
1887 for (i = PCI_BRIDGE_RESOURCES; i < DEVICE_COUNT_RESOURCE; i++)
1888 if (dev->resource[i].flags & flags)
1889 bars |= (1 << i);
1890
1891 err = do_pci_enable_device(dev, bars);
1892 if (err < 0)
1893 atomic_dec(&dev->enable_cnt);
1894 return err;
1895}
1896
1897/**
1898 * pci_enable_device_io - Initialize a device for use with IO space
1899 * @dev: PCI device to be initialized
1900 *
1901 * Initialize device before it's used by a driver. Ask low-level code
1902 * to enable I/O resources. Wake up the device if it was suspended.
1903 * Beware, this function can fail.
1904 */
1905int pci_enable_device_io(struct pci_dev *dev)
1906{
1907 return pci_enable_device_flags(dev, IORESOURCE_IO);
1908}
1909EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_enable_device_io);
1910
1911/**
1912 * pci_enable_device_mem - Initialize a device for use with Memory space
1913 * @dev: PCI device to be initialized
1914 *
1915 * Initialize device before it's used by a driver. Ask low-level code
1916 * to enable Memory resources. Wake up the device if it was suspended.
1917 * Beware, this function can fail.
1918 */
1919int pci_enable_device_mem(struct pci_dev *dev)
1920{
1921 return pci_enable_device_flags(dev, IORESOURCE_MEM);
1922}
1923EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_enable_device_mem);
1924
1925/**
1926 * pci_enable_device - Initialize device before it's used by a driver.
1927 * @dev: PCI device to be initialized
1928 *
1929 * Initialize device before it's used by a driver. Ask low-level code
1930 * to enable I/O and memory. Wake up the device if it was suspended.
1931 * Beware, this function can fail.
1932 *
1933 * Note we don't actually enable the device many times if we call
1934 * this function repeatedly (we just increment the count).
1935 */
1936int pci_enable_device(struct pci_dev *dev)
1937{
1938 return pci_enable_device_flags(dev, IORESOURCE_MEM | IORESOURCE_IO);
1939}
1940EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_enable_device);
1941
1942/*
1943 * Managed PCI resources. This manages device on/off, INTx/MSI/MSI-X
1944 * on/off and BAR regions. pci_dev itself records MSI/MSI-X status, so
1945 * there's no need to track it separately. pci_devres is initialized
1946 * when a device is enabled using managed PCI device enable interface.
1947 */
1948struct pci_devres {
1949 unsigned int enabled:1;
1950 unsigned int pinned:1;
1951 unsigned int orig_intx:1;
1952 unsigned int restore_intx:1;
1953 unsigned int mwi:1;
1954 u32 region_mask;
1955};
1956
1957static void pcim_release(struct device *gendev, void *res)
1958{
1959 struct pci_dev *dev = to_pci_dev(gendev);
1960 struct pci_devres *this = res;
1961 int i;
1962
1963 if (dev->msi_enabled)
1964 pci_disable_msi(dev);
1965 if (dev->msix_enabled)
1966 pci_disable_msix(dev);
1967
1968 for (i = 0; i < DEVICE_COUNT_RESOURCE; i++)
1969 if (this->region_mask & (1 << i))
1970 pci_release_region(dev, i);
1971
1972 if (this->mwi)
1973 pci_clear_mwi(dev);
1974
1975 if (this->restore_intx)
1976 pci_intx(dev, this->orig_intx);
1977
1978 if (this->enabled && !this->pinned)
1979 pci_disable_device(dev);
1980}
1981
1982static struct pci_devres *get_pci_dr(struct pci_dev *pdev)
1983{
1984 struct pci_devres *dr, *new_dr;
1985
1986 dr = devres_find(&pdev->dev, pcim_release, NULL, NULL);
1987 if (dr)
1988 return dr;
1989
1990 new_dr = devres_alloc(pcim_release, sizeof(*new_dr), GFP_KERNEL);
1991 if (!new_dr)
1992 return NULL;
1993 return devres_get(&pdev->dev, new_dr, NULL, NULL);
1994}
1995
1996static struct pci_devres *find_pci_dr(struct pci_dev *pdev)
1997{
1998 if (pci_is_managed(pdev))
1999 return devres_find(&pdev->dev, pcim_release, NULL, NULL);
2000 return NULL;
2001}
2002
2003/**
2004 * pcim_enable_device - Managed pci_enable_device()
2005 * @pdev: PCI device to be initialized
2006 *
2007 * Managed pci_enable_device().
2008 */
2009int pcim_enable_device(struct pci_dev *pdev)
2010{
2011 struct pci_devres *dr;
2012 int rc;
2013
2014 dr = get_pci_dr(pdev);
2015 if (unlikely(!dr))
2016 return -ENOMEM;
2017 if (dr->enabled)
2018 return 0;
2019
2020 rc = pci_enable_device(pdev);
2021 if (!rc) {
2022 pdev->is_managed = 1;
2023 dr->enabled = 1;
2024 }
2025 return rc;
2026}
2027EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcim_enable_device);
2028
2029/**
2030 * pcim_pin_device - Pin managed PCI device
2031 * @pdev: PCI device to pin
2032 *
2033 * Pin managed PCI device @pdev. Pinned device won't be disabled on
2034 * driver detach. @pdev must have been enabled with
2035 * pcim_enable_device().
2036 */
2037void pcim_pin_device(struct pci_dev *pdev)
2038{
2039 struct pci_devres *dr;
2040
2041 dr = find_pci_dr(pdev);
2042 WARN_ON(!dr || !dr->enabled);
2043 if (dr)
2044 dr->pinned = 1;
2045}
2046EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcim_pin_device);
2047
2048/*
2049 * pcibios_add_device - provide arch specific hooks when adding device dev
2050 * @dev: the PCI device being added
2051 *
2052 * Permits the platform to provide architecture specific functionality when
2053 * devices are added. This is the default implementation. Architecture
2054 * implementations can override this.
2055 */
2056int __weak pcibios_add_device(struct pci_dev *dev)
2057{
2058 return 0;
2059}
2060
2061/**
2062 * pcibios_release_device - provide arch specific hooks when releasing
2063 * device dev
2064 * @dev: the PCI device being released
2065 *
2066 * Permits the platform to provide architecture specific functionality when
2067 * devices are released. This is the default implementation. Architecture
2068 * implementations can override this.
2069 */
2070void __weak pcibios_release_device(struct pci_dev *dev) {}
2071
2072/**
2073 * pcibios_disable_device - disable arch specific PCI resources for device dev
2074 * @dev: the PCI device to disable
2075 *
2076 * Disables architecture specific PCI resources for the device. This
2077 * is the default implementation. Architecture implementations can
2078 * override this.
2079 */
2080void __weak pcibios_disable_device(struct pci_dev *dev) {}
2081
2082/**
2083 * pcibios_penalize_isa_irq - penalize an ISA IRQ
2084 * @irq: ISA IRQ to penalize
2085 * @active: IRQ active or not
2086 *
2087 * Permits the platform to provide architecture-specific functionality when
2088 * penalizing ISA IRQs. This is the default implementation. Architecture
2089 * implementations can override this.
2090 */
2091void __weak pcibios_penalize_isa_irq(int irq, int active) {}
2092
2093static void do_pci_disable_device(struct pci_dev *dev)
2094{
2095 u16 pci_command;
2096
2097 pci_read_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, &pci_command);
2098 if (pci_command & PCI_COMMAND_MASTER) {
2099 pci_command &= ~PCI_COMMAND_MASTER;
2100 pci_write_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, pci_command);
2101 }
2102
2103 pcibios_disable_device(dev);
2104}
2105
2106/**
2107 * pci_disable_enabled_device - Disable device without updating enable_cnt
2108 * @dev: PCI device to disable
2109 *
2110 * NOTE: This function is a backend of PCI power management routines and is
2111 * not supposed to be called drivers.
2112 */
2113void pci_disable_enabled_device(struct pci_dev *dev)
2114{
2115 if (pci_is_enabled(dev))
2116 do_pci_disable_device(dev);
2117}
2118
2119/**
2120 * pci_disable_device - Disable PCI device after use
2121 * @dev: PCI device to be disabled
2122 *
2123 * Signal to the system that the PCI device is not in use by the system
2124 * anymore. This only involves disabling PCI bus-mastering, if active.
2125 *
2126 * Note we don't actually disable the device until all callers of
2127 * pci_enable_device() have called pci_disable_device().
2128 */
2129void pci_disable_device(struct pci_dev *dev)
2130{
2131 struct pci_devres *dr;
2132
2133 dr = find_pci_dr(dev);
2134 if (dr)
2135 dr->enabled = 0;
2136
2137 dev_WARN_ONCE(&dev->dev, atomic_read(&dev->enable_cnt) <= 0,
2138 "disabling already-disabled device");
2139
2140 if (atomic_dec_return(&dev->enable_cnt) != 0)
2141 return;
2142
2143 do_pci_disable_device(dev);
2144
2145 dev->is_busmaster = 0;
2146}
2147EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_disable_device);
2148
2149/**
2150 * pcibios_set_pcie_reset_state - set reset state for device dev
2151 * @dev: the PCIe device reset
2152 * @state: Reset state to enter into
2153 *
2154 * Set the PCIe reset state for the device. This is the default
2155 * implementation. Architecture implementations can override this.
2156 */
2157int __weak pcibios_set_pcie_reset_state(struct pci_dev *dev,
2158 enum pcie_reset_state state)
2159{
2160 return -EINVAL;
2161}
2162
2163/**
2164 * pci_set_pcie_reset_state - set reset state for device dev
2165 * @dev: the PCIe device reset
2166 * @state: Reset state to enter into
2167 *
2168 * Sets the PCI reset state for the device.
2169 */
2170int pci_set_pcie_reset_state(struct pci_dev *dev, enum pcie_reset_state state)
2171{
2172 return pcibios_set_pcie_reset_state(dev, state);
2173}
2174EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_set_pcie_reset_state);
2175
2176void pcie_clear_device_status(struct pci_dev *dev)
2177{
2178 u16 sta;
2179
2180 pcie_capability_read_word(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVSTA, &sta);
2181 pcie_capability_write_word(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVSTA, sta);
2182}
2183
2184/**
2185 * pcie_clear_root_pme_status - Clear root port PME interrupt status.
2186 * @dev: PCIe root port or event collector.
2187 */
2188void pcie_clear_root_pme_status(struct pci_dev *dev)
2189{
2190 pcie_capability_set_dword(dev, PCI_EXP_RTSTA, PCI_EXP_RTSTA_PME);
2191}
2192
2193/**
2194 * pci_check_pme_status - Check if given device has generated PME.
2195 * @dev: Device to check.
2196 *
2197 * Check the PME status of the device and if set, clear it and clear PME enable
2198 * (if set). Return 'true' if PME status and PME enable were both set or
2199 * 'false' otherwise.
2200 */
2201bool pci_check_pme_status(struct pci_dev *dev)
2202{
2203 int pmcsr_pos;
2204 u16 pmcsr;
2205 bool ret = false;
2206
2207 if (!dev->pm_cap)
2208 return false;
2209
2210 pmcsr_pos = dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL;
2211 pci_read_config_word(dev, pmcsr_pos, &pmcsr);
2212 if (!(pmcsr & PCI_PM_CTRL_PME_STATUS))
2213 return false;
2214
2215 /* Clear PME status. */
2216 pmcsr |= PCI_PM_CTRL_PME_STATUS;
2217 if (pmcsr & PCI_PM_CTRL_PME_ENABLE) {
2218 /* Disable PME to avoid interrupt flood. */
2219 pmcsr &= ~PCI_PM_CTRL_PME_ENABLE;
2220 ret = true;
2221 }
2222
2223 pci_write_config_word(dev, pmcsr_pos, pmcsr);
2224
2225 return ret;
2226}
2227
2228/**
2229 * pci_pme_wakeup - Wake up a PCI device if its PME Status bit is set.
2230 * @dev: Device to handle.
2231 * @pme_poll_reset: Whether or not to reset the device's pme_poll flag.
2232 *
2233 * Check if @dev has generated PME and queue a resume request for it in that
2234 * case.
2235 */
2236static int pci_pme_wakeup(struct pci_dev *dev, void *pme_poll_reset)
2237{
2238 if (pme_poll_reset && dev->pme_poll)
2239 dev->pme_poll = false;
2240
2241 if (pci_check_pme_status(dev)) {
2242 pci_wakeup_event(dev);
2243 pm_request_resume(&dev->dev);
2244 }
2245 return 0;
2246}
2247
2248/**
2249 * pci_pme_wakeup_bus - Walk given bus and wake up devices on it, if necessary.
2250 * @bus: Top bus of the subtree to walk.
2251 */
2252void pci_pme_wakeup_bus(struct pci_bus *bus)
2253{
2254 if (bus)
2255 pci_walk_bus(bus, pci_pme_wakeup, (void *)true);
2256}
2257
2258
2259/**
2260 * pci_pme_capable - check the capability of PCI device to generate PME#
2261 * @dev: PCI device to handle.
2262 * @state: PCI state from which device will issue PME#.
2263 */
2264bool pci_pme_capable(struct pci_dev *dev, pci_power_t state)
2265{
2266 if (!dev->pm_cap)
2267 return false;
2268
2269 return !!(dev->pme_support & (1 << state));
2270}
2271EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_pme_capable);
2272
2273static void pci_pme_list_scan(struct work_struct *work)
2274{
2275 struct pci_pme_device *pme_dev, *n;
2276
2277 mutex_lock(&pci_pme_list_mutex);
2278 list_for_each_entry_safe(pme_dev, n, &pci_pme_list, list) {
2279 if (pme_dev->dev->pme_poll) {
2280 struct pci_dev *bridge;
2281
2282 bridge = pme_dev->dev->bus->self;
2283 /*
2284 * If bridge is in low power state, the
2285 * configuration space of subordinate devices
2286 * may be not accessible
2287 */
2288 if (bridge && bridge->current_state != PCI_D0)
2289 continue;
2290 /*
2291 * If the device is in D3cold it should not be
2292 * polled either.
2293 */
2294 if (pme_dev->dev->current_state == PCI_D3cold)
2295 continue;
2296
2297 pci_pme_wakeup(pme_dev->dev, NULL);
2298 } else {
2299 list_del(&pme_dev->list);
2300 kfree(pme_dev);
2301 }
2302 }
2303 if (!list_empty(&pci_pme_list))
2304 queue_delayed_work(system_freezable_wq, &pci_pme_work,
2305 msecs_to_jiffies(PME_TIMEOUT));
2306 mutex_unlock(&pci_pme_list_mutex);
2307}
2308
2309static void __pci_pme_active(struct pci_dev *dev, bool enable)
2310{
2311 u16 pmcsr;
2312
2313 if (!dev->pme_support)
2314 return;
2315
2316 pci_read_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, &pmcsr);
2317 /* Clear PME_Status by writing 1 to it and enable PME# */
2318 pmcsr |= PCI_PM_CTRL_PME_STATUS | PCI_PM_CTRL_PME_ENABLE;
2319 if (!enable)
2320 pmcsr &= ~PCI_PM_CTRL_PME_ENABLE;
2321
2322 pci_write_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, pmcsr);
2323}
2324
2325/**
2326 * pci_pme_restore - Restore PME configuration after config space restore.
2327 * @dev: PCI device to update.
2328 */
2329void pci_pme_restore(struct pci_dev *dev)
2330{
2331 u16 pmcsr;
2332
2333 if (!dev->pme_support)
2334 return;
2335
2336 pci_read_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, &pmcsr);
2337 if (dev->wakeup_prepared) {
2338 pmcsr |= PCI_PM_CTRL_PME_ENABLE;
2339 pmcsr &= ~PCI_PM_CTRL_PME_STATUS;
2340 } else {
2341 pmcsr &= ~PCI_PM_CTRL_PME_ENABLE;
2342 pmcsr |= PCI_PM_CTRL_PME_STATUS;
2343 }
2344 pci_write_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, pmcsr);
2345}
2346
2347/**
2348 * pci_pme_active - enable or disable PCI device's PME# function
2349 * @dev: PCI device to handle.
2350 * @enable: 'true' to enable PME# generation; 'false' to disable it.
2351 *
2352 * The caller must verify that the device is capable of generating PME# before
2353 * calling this function with @enable equal to 'true'.
2354 */
2355void pci_pme_active(struct pci_dev *dev, bool enable)
2356{
2357 __pci_pme_active(dev, enable);
2358
2359 /*
2360 * PCI (as opposed to PCIe) PME requires that the device have
2361 * its PME# line hooked up correctly. Not all hardware vendors
2362 * do this, so the PME never gets delivered and the device
2363 * remains asleep. The easiest way around this is to
2364 * periodically walk the list of suspended devices and check
2365 * whether any have their PME flag set. The assumption is that
2366 * we'll wake up often enough anyway that this won't be a huge
2367 * hit, and the power savings from the devices will still be a
2368 * win.
2369 *
2370 * Although PCIe uses in-band PME message instead of PME# line
2371 * to report PME, PME does not work for some PCIe devices in
2372 * reality. For example, there are devices that set their PME
2373 * status bits, but don't really bother to send a PME message;
2374 * there are PCI Express Root Ports that don't bother to
2375 * trigger interrupts when they receive PME messages from the
2376 * devices below. So PME poll is used for PCIe devices too.
2377 */
2378
2379 if (dev->pme_poll) {
2380 struct pci_pme_device *pme_dev;
2381 if (enable) {
2382 pme_dev = kmalloc(sizeof(struct pci_pme_device),
2383 GFP_KERNEL);
2384 if (!pme_dev) {
2385 pci_warn(dev, "can't enable PME#\n");
2386 return;
2387 }
2388 pme_dev->dev = dev;
2389 mutex_lock(&pci_pme_list_mutex);
2390 list_add(&pme_dev->list, &pci_pme_list);
2391 if (list_is_singular(&pci_pme_list))
2392 queue_delayed_work(system_freezable_wq,
2393 &pci_pme_work,
2394 msecs_to_jiffies(PME_TIMEOUT));
2395 mutex_unlock(&pci_pme_list_mutex);
2396 } else {
2397 mutex_lock(&pci_pme_list_mutex);
2398 list_for_each_entry(pme_dev, &pci_pme_list, list) {
2399 if (pme_dev->dev == dev) {
2400 list_del(&pme_dev->list);
2401 kfree(pme_dev);
2402 break;
2403 }
2404 }
2405 mutex_unlock(&pci_pme_list_mutex);
2406 }
2407 }
2408
2409 pci_dbg(dev, "PME# %s\n", enable ? "enabled" : "disabled");
2410}
2411EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_pme_active);
2412
2413/**
2414 * __pci_enable_wake - enable PCI device as wakeup event source
2415 * @dev: PCI device affected
2416 * @state: PCI state from which device will issue wakeup events
2417 * @enable: True to enable event generation; false to disable
2418 *
2419 * This enables the device as a wakeup event source, or disables it.
2420 * When such events involves platform-specific hooks, those hooks are
2421 * called automatically by this routine.
2422 *
2423 * Devices with legacy power management (no standard PCI PM capabilities)
2424 * always require such platform hooks.
2425 *
2426 * RETURN VALUE:
2427 * 0 is returned on success
2428 * -EINVAL is returned if device is not supposed to wake up the system
2429 * Error code depending on the platform is returned if both the platform and
2430 * the native mechanism fail to enable the generation of wake-up events
2431 */
2432static int __pci_enable_wake(struct pci_dev *dev, pci_power_t state, bool enable)
2433{
2434 int ret = 0;
2435
2436 /*
2437 * Bridges that are not power-manageable directly only signal
2438 * wakeup on behalf of subordinate devices which is set up
2439 * elsewhere, so skip them. However, bridges that are
2440 * power-manageable may signal wakeup for themselves (for example,
2441 * on a hotplug event) and they need to be covered here.
2442 */
2443 if (!pci_power_manageable(dev))
2444 return 0;
2445
2446 /* Don't do the same thing twice in a row for one device. */
2447 if (!!enable == !!dev->wakeup_prepared)
2448 return 0;
2449
2450 /*
2451 * According to "PCI System Architecture" 4th ed. by Tom Shanley & Don
2452 * Anderson we should be doing PME# wake enable followed by ACPI wake
2453 * enable. To disable wake-up we call the platform first, for symmetry.
2454 */
2455
2456 if (enable) {
2457 int error;
2458
2459 if (pci_pme_capable(dev, state))
2460 pci_pme_active(dev, true);
2461 else
2462 ret = 1;
2463 error = platform_pci_set_wakeup(dev, true);
2464 if (ret)
2465 ret = error;
2466 if (!ret)
2467 dev->wakeup_prepared = true;
2468 } else {
2469 platform_pci_set_wakeup(dev, false);
2470 pci_pme_active(dev, false);
2471 dev->wakeup_prepared = false;
2472 }
2473
2474 return ret;
2475}
2476
2477/**
2478 * pci_enable_wake - change wakeup settings for a PCI device
2479 * @pci_dev: Target device
2480 * @state: PCI state from which device will issue wakeup events
2481 * @enable: Whether or not to enable event generation
2482 *
2483 * If @enable is set, check device_may_wakeup() for the device before calling
2484 * __pci_enable_wake() for it.
2485 */
2486int pci_enable_wake(struct pci_dev *pci_dev, pci_power_t state, bool enable)
2487{
2488 if (enable && !device_may_wakeup(&pci_dev->dev))
2489 return -EINVAL;
2490
2491 return __pci_enable_wake(pci_dev, state, enable);
2492}
2493EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_enable_wake);
2494
2495/**
2496 * pci_wake_from_d3 - enable/disable device to wake up from D3_hot or D3_cold
2497 * @dev: PCI device to prepare
2498 * @enable: True to enable wake-up event generation; false to disable
2499 *
2500 * Many drivers want the device to wake up the system from D3_hot or D3_cold
2501 * and this function allows them to set that up cleanly - pci_enable_wake()
2502 * should not be called twice in a row to enable wake-up due to PCI PM vs ACPI
2503 * ordering constraints.
2504 *
2505 * This function only returns error code if the device is not allowed to wake
2506 * up the system from sleep or it is not capable of generating PME# from both
2507 * D3_hot and D3_cold and the platform is unable to enable wake-up power for it.
2508 */
2509int pci_wake_from_d3(struct pci_dev *dev, bool enable)
2510{
2511 return pci_pme_capable(dev, PCI_D3cold) ?
2512 pci_enable_wake(dev, PCI_D3cold, enable) :
2513 pci_enable_wake(dev, PCI_D3hot, enable);
2514}
2515EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_wake_from_d3);
2516
2517/**
2518 * pci_target_state - find an appropriate low power state for a given PCI dev
2519 * @dev: PCI device
2520 * @wakeup: Whether or not wakeup functionality will be enabled for the device.
2521 *
2522 * Use underlying platform code to find a supported low power state for @dev.
2523 * If the platform can't manage @dev, return the deepest state from which it
2524 * can generate wake events, based on any available PME info.
2525 */
2526static pci_power_t pci_target_state(struct pci_dev *dev, bool wakeup)
2527{
2528 pci_power_t target_state = PCI_D3hot;
2529
2530 if (platform_pci_power_manageable(dev)) {
2531 /*
2532 * Call the platform to find the target state for the device.
2533 */
2534 pci_power_t state = platform_pci_choose_state(dev);
2535
2536 switch (state) {
2537 case PCI_POWER_ERROR:
2538 case PCI_UNKNOWN:
2539 break;
2540 case PCI_D1:
2541 case PCI_D2:
2542 if (pci_no_d1d2(dev))
2543 break;
2544 fallthrough;
2545 default:
2546 target_state = state;
2547 }
2548
2549 return target_state;
2550 }
2551
2552 if (!dev->pm_cap)
2553 target_state = PCI_D0;
2554
2555 /*
2556 * If the device is in D3cold even though it's not power-manageable by
2557 * the platform, it may have been powered down by non-standard means.
2558 * Best to let it slumber.
2559 */
2560 if (dev->current_state == PCI_D3cold)
2561 target_state = PCI_D3cold;
2562
2563 if (wakeup) {
2564 /*
2565 * Find the deepest state from which the device can generate
2566 * PME#.
2567 */
2568 if (dev->pme_support) {
2569 while (target_state
2570 && !(dev->pme_support & (1 << target_state)))
2571 target_state--;
2572 }
2573 }
2574
2575 return target_state;
2576}
2577
2578/**
2579 * pci_prepare_to_sleep - prepare PCI device for system-wide transition
2580 * into a sleep state
2581 * @dev: Device to handle.
2582 *
2583 * Choose the power state appropriate for the device depending on whether
2584 * it can wake up the system and/or is power manageable by the platform
2585 * (PCI_D3hot is the default) and put the device into that state.
2586 */
2587int pci_prepare_to_sleep(struct pci_dev *dev)
2588{
2589 bool wakeup = device_may_wakeup(&dev->dev);
2590 pci_power_t target_state = pci_target_state(dev, wakeup);
2591 int error;
2592
2593 if (target_state == PCI_POWER_ERROR)
2594 return -EIO;
2595
2596 pci_enable_wake(dev, target_state, wakeup);
2597
2598 error = pci_set_power_state(dev, target_state);
2599
2600 if (error)
2601 pci_enable_wake(dev, target_state, false);
2602
2603 return error;
2604}
2605EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_prepare_to_sleep);
2606
2607/**
2608 * pci_back_from_sleep - turn PCI device on during system-wide transition
2609 * into working state
2610 * @dev: Device to handle.
2611 *
2612 * Disable device's system wake-up capability and put it into D0.
2613 */
2614int pci_back_from_sleep(struct pci_dev *dev)
2615{
2616 pci_enable_wake(dev, PCI_D0, false);
2617 return pci_set_power_state(dev, PCI_D0);
2618}
2619EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_back_from_sleep);
2620
2621/**
2622 * pci_finish_runtime_suspend - Carry out PCI-specific part of runtime suspend.
2623 * @dev: PCI device being suspended.
2624 *
2625 * Prepare @dev to generate wake-up events at run time and put it into a low
2626 * power state.
2627 */
2628int pci_finish_runtime_suspend(struct pci_dev *dev)
2629{
2630 pci_power_t target_state;
2631 int error;
2632
2633 target_state = pci_target_state(dev, device_can_wakeup(&dev->dev));
2634 if (target_state == PCI_POWER_ERROR)
2635 return -EIO;
2636
2637 dev->runtime_d3cold = target_state == PCI_D3cold;
2638
2639 __pci_enable_wake(dev, target_state, pci_dev_run_wake(dev));
2640
2641 error = pci_set_power_state(dev, target_state);
2642
2643 if (error) {
2644 pci_enable_wake(dev, target_state, false);
2645 dev->runtime_d3cold = false;
2646 }
2647
2648 return error;
2649}
2650
2651/**
2652 * pci_dev_run_wake - Check if device can generate run-time wake-up events.
2653 * @dev: Device to check.
2654 *
2655 * Return true if the device itself is capable of generating wake-up events
2656 * (through the platform or using the native PCIe PME) or if the device supports
2657 * PME and one of its upstream bridges can generate wake-up events.
2658 */
2659bool pci_dev_run_wake(struct pci_dev *dev)
2660{
2661 struct pci_bus *bus = dev->bus;
2662
2663 if (!dev->pme_support)
2664 return false;
2665
2666 /* PME-capable in principle, but not from the target power state */
2667 if (!pci_pme_capable(dev, pci_target_state(dev, true)))
2668 return false;
2669
2670 if (device_can_wakeup(&dev->dev))
2671 return true;
2672
2673 while (bus->parent) {
2674 struct pci_dev *bridge = bus->self;
2675
2676 if (device_can_wakeup(&bridge->dev))
2677 return true;
2678
2679 bus = bus->parent;
2680 }
2681
2682 /* We have reached the root bus. */
2683 if (bus->bridge)
2684 return device_can_wakeup(bus->bridge);
2685
2686 return false;
2687}
2688EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_dev_run_wake);
2689
2690/**
2691 * pci_dev_need_resume - Check if it is necessary to resume the device.
2692 * @pci_dev: Device to check.
2693 *
2694 * Return 'true' if the device is not runtime-suspended or it has to be
2695 * reconfigured due to wakeup settings difference between system and runtime
2696 * suspend, or the current power state of it is not suitable for the upcoming
2697 * (system-wide) transition.
2698 */
2699bool pci_dev_need_resume(struct pci_dev *pci_dev)
2700{
2701 struct device *dev = &pci_dev->dev;
2702 pci_power_t target_state;
2703
2704 if (!pm_runtime_suspended(dev) || platform_pci_need_resume(pci_dev))
2705 return true;
2706
2707 target_state = pci_target_state(pci_dev, device_may_wakeup(dev));
2708
2709 /*
2710 * If the earlier platform check has not triggered, D3cold is just power
2711 * removal on top of D3hot, so no need to resume the device in that
2712 * case.
2713 */
2714 return target_state != pci_dev->current_state &&
2715 target_state != PCI_D3cold &&
2716 pci_dev->current_state != PCI_D3hot;
2717}
2718
2719/**
2720 * pci_dev_adjust_pme - Adjust PME setting for a suspended device.
2721 * @pci_dev: Device to check.
2722 *
2723 * If the device is suspended and it is not configured for system wakeup,
2724 * disable PME for it to prevent it from waking up the system unnecessarily.
2725 *
2726 * Note that if the device's power state is D3cold and the platform check in
2727 * pci_dev_need_resume() has not triggered, the device's configuration need not
2728 * be changed.
2729 */
2730void pci_dev_adjust_pme(struct pci_dev *pci_dev)
2731{
2732 struct device *dev = &pci_dev->dev;
2733
2734 spin_lock_irq(&dev->power.lock);
2735
2736 if (pm_runtime_suspended(dev) && !device_may_wakeup(dev) &&
2737 pci_dev->current_state < PCI_D3cold)
2738 __pci_pme_active(pci_dev, false);
2739
2740 spin_unlock_irq(&dev->power.lock);
2741}
2742
2743/**
2744 * pci_dev_complete_resume - Finalize resume from system sleep for a device.
2745 * @pci_dev: Device to handle.
2746 *
2747 * If the device is runtime suspended and wakeup-capable, enable PME for it as
2748 * it might have been disabled during the prepare phase of system suspend if
2749 * the device was not configured for system wakeup.
2750 */
2751void pci_dev_complete_resume(struct pci_dev *pci_dev)
2752{
2753 struct device *dev = &pci_dev->dev;
2754
2755 if (!pci_dev_run_wake(pci_dev))
2756 return;
2757
2758 spin_lock_irq(&dev->power.lock);
2759
2760 if (pm_runtime_suspended(dev) && pci_dev->current_state < PCI_D3cold)
2761 __pci_pme_active(pci_dev, true);
2762
2763 spin_unlock_irq(&dev->power.lock);
2764}
2765
2766void pci_config_pm_runtime_get(struct pci_dev *pdev)
2767{
2768 struct device *dev = &pdev->dev;
2769 struct device *parent = dev->parent;
2770
2771 if (parent)
2772 pm_runtime_get_sync(parent);
2773 pm_runtime_get_noresume(dev);
2774 /*
2775 * pdev->current_state is set to PCI_D3cold during suspending,
2776 * so wait until suspending completes
2777 */
2778 pm_runtime_barrier(dev);
2779 /*
2780 * Only need to resume devices in D3cold, because config
2781 * registers are still accessible for devices suspended but
2782 * not in D3cold.
2783 */
2784 if (pdev->current_state == PCI_D3cold)
2785 pm_runtime_resume(dev);
2786}
2787
2788void pci_config_pm_runtime_put(struct pci_dev *pdev)
2789{
2790 struct device *dev = &pdev->dev;
2791 struct device *parent = dev->parent;
2792
2793 pm_runtime_put(dev);
2794 if (parent)
2795 pm_runtime_put_sync(parent);
2796}
2797
2798static const struct dmi_system_id bridge_d3_blacklist[] = {
2799#ifdef CONFIG_X86
2800 {
2801 /*
2802 * Gigabyte X299 root port is not marked as hotplug capable
2803 * which allows Linux to power manage it. However, this
2804 * confuses the BIOS SMI handler so don't power manage root
2805 * ports on that system.
2806 */
2807 .ident = "X299 DESIGNARE EX-CF",
2808 .matches = {
2809 DMI_MATCH(DMI_BOARD_VENDOR, "Gigabyte Technology Co., Ltd."),
2810 DMI_MATCH(DMI_BOARD_NAME, "X299 DESIGNARE EX-CF"),
2811 },
2812 },
2813#endif
2814 { }
2815};
2816
2817/**
2818 * pci_bridge_d3_possible - Is it possible to put the bridge into D3
2819 * @bridge: Bridge to check
2820 *
2821 * This function checks if it is possible to move the bridge to D3.
2822 * Currently we only allow D3 for recent enough PCIe ports and Thunderbolt.
2823 */
2824bool pci_bridge_d3_possible(struct pci_dev *bridge)
2825{
2826 if (!pci_is_pcie(bridge))
2827 return false;
2828
2829 switch (pci_pcie_type(bridge)) {
2830 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_ROOT_PORT:
2831 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_UPSTREAM:
2832 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_DOWNSTREAM:
2833 if (pci_bridge_d3_disable)
2834 return false;
2835
2836 /*
2837 * Hotplug ports handled by firmware in System Management Mode
2838 * may not be put into D3 by the OS (Thunderbolt on non-Macs).
2839 */
2840 if (bridge->is_hotplug_bridge && !pciehp_is_native(bridge))
2841 return false;
2842
2843 if (pci_bridge_d3_force)
2844 return true;
2845
2846 /* Even the oldest 2010 Thunderbolt controller supports D3. */
2847 if (bridge->is_thunderbolt)
2848 return true;
2849
2850 /* Platform might know better if the bridge supports D3 */
2851 if (platform_pci_bridge_d3(bridge))
2852 return true;
2853
2854 /*
2855 * Hotplug ports handled natively by the OS were not validated
2856 * by vendors for runtime D3 at least until 2018 because there
2857 * was no OS support.
2858 */
2859 if (bridge->is_hotplug_bridge)
2860 return false;
2861
2862 if (dmi_check_system(bridge_d3_blacklist))
2863 return false;
2864
2865 /*
2866 * It should be safe to put PCIe ports from 2015 or newer
2867 * to D3.
2868 */
2869 if (dmi_get_bios_year() >= 2015)
2870 return true;
2871 break;
2872 }
2873
2874 return false;
2875}
2876
2877static int pci_dev_check_d3cold(struct pci_dev *dev, void *data)
2878{
2879 bool *d3cold_ok = data;
2880
2881 if (/* The device needs to be allowed to go D3cold ... */
2882 dev->no_d3cold || !dev->d3cold_allowed ||
2883
2884 /* ... and if it is wakeup capable to do so from D3cold. */
2885 (device_may_wakeup(&dev->dev) &&
2886 !pci_pme_capable(dev, PCI_D3cold)) ||
2887
2888 /* If it is a bridge it must be allowed to go to D3. */
2889 !pci_power_manageable(dev))
2890
2891 *d3cold_ok = false;
2892
2893 return !*d3cold_ok;
2894}
2895
2896/*
2897 * pci_bridge_d3_update - Update bridge D3 capabilities
2898 * @dev: PCI device which is changed
2899 *
2900 * Update upstream bridge PM capabilities accordingly depending on if the
2901 * device PM configuration was changed or the device is being removed. The
2902 * change is also propagated upstream.
2903 */
2904void pci_bridge_d3_update(struct pci_dev *dev)
2905{
2906 bool remove = !device_is_registered(&dev->dev);
2907 struct pci_dev *bridge;
2908 bool d3cold_ok = true;
2909
2910 bridge = pci_upstream_bridge(dev);
2911 if (!bridge || !pci_bridge_d3_possible(bridge))
2912 return;
2913
2914 /*
2915 * If D3 is currently allowed for the bridge, removing one of its
2916 * children won't change that.
2917 */
2918 if (remove && bridge->bridge_d3)
2919 return;
2920
2921 /*
2922 * If D3 is currently allowed for the bridge and a child is added or
2923 * changed, disallowance of D3 can only be caused by that child, so
2924 * we only need to check that single device, not any of its siblings.
2925 *
2926 * If D3 is currently not allowed for the bridge, checking the device
2927 * first may allow us to skip checking its siblings.
2928 */
2929 if (!remove)
2930 pci_dev_check_d3cold(dev, &d3cold_ok);
2931
2932 /*
2933 * If D3 is currently not allowed for the bridge, this may be caused
2934 * either by the device being changed/removed or any of its siblings,
2935 * so we need to go through all children to find out if one of them
2936 * continues to block D3.
2937 */
2938 if (d3cold_ok && !bridge->bridge_d3)
2939 pci_walk_bus(bridge->subordinate, pci_dev_check_d3cold,
2940 &d3cold_ok);
2941
2942 if (bridge->bridge_d3 != d3cold_ok) {
2943 bridge->bridge_d3 = d3cold_ok;
2944 /* Propagate change to upstream bridges */
2945 pci_bridge_d3_update(bridge);
2946 }
2947}
2948
2949/**
2950 * pci_d3cold_enable - Enable D3cold for device
2951 * @dev: PCI device to handle
2952 *
2953 * This function can be used in drivers to enable D3cold from the device
2954 * they handle. It also updates upstream PCI bridge PM capabilities
2955 * accordingly.
2956 */
2957void pci_d3cold_enable(struct pci_dev *dev)
2958{
2959 if (dev->no_d3cold) {
2960 dev->no_d3cold = false;
2961 pci_bridge_d3_update(dev);
2962 }
2963}
2964EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_d3cold_enable);
2965
2966/**
2967 * pci_d3cold_disable - Disable D3cold for device
2968 * @dev: PCI device to handle
2969 *
2970 * This function can be used in drivers to disable D3cold from the device
2971 * they handle. It also updates upstream PCI bridge PM capabilities
2972 * accordingly.
2973 */
2974void pci_d3cold_disable(struct pci_dev *dev)
2975{
2976 if (!dev->no_d3cold) {
2977 dev->no_d3cold = true;
2978 pci_bridge_d3_update(dev);
2979 }
2980}
2981EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_d3cold_disable);
2982
2983/**
2984 * pci_pm_init - Initialize PM functions of given PCI device
2985 * @dev: PCI device to handle.
2986 */
2987void pci_pm_init(struct pci_dev *dev)
2988{
2989 int pm;
2990 u16 status;
2991 u16 pmc;
2992
2993 pm_runtime_forbid(&dev->dev);
2994 pm_runtime_set_active(&dev->dev);
2995 pm_runtime_enable(&dev->dev);
2996 device_enable_async_suspend(&dev->dev);
2997 dev->wakeup_prepared = false;
2998
2999 dev->pm_cap = 0;
3000 dev->pme_support = 0;
3001
3002 /* find PCI PM capability in list */
3003 pm = pci_find_capability(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_PM);
3004 if (!pm)
3005 return;
3006 /* Check device's ability to generate PME# */
3007 pci_read_config_word(dev, pm + PCI_PM_PMC, &pmc);
3008
3009 if ((pmc & PCI_PM_CAP_VER_MASK) > 3) {
3010 pci_err(dev, "unsupported PM cap regs version (%u)\n",
3011 pmc & PCI_PM_CAP_VER_MASK);
3012 return;
3013 }
3014
3015 dev->pm_cap = pm;
3016 dev->d3_delay = PCI_PM_D3_WAIT;
3017 dev->d3cold_delay = PCI_PM_D3COLD_WAIT;
3018 dev->bridge_d3 = pci_bridge_d3_possible(dev);
3019 dev->d3cold_allowed = true;
3020
3021 dev->d1_support = false;
3022 dev->d2_support = false;
3023 if (!pci_no_d1d2(dev)) {
3024 if (pmc & PCI_PM_CAP_D1)
3025 dev->d1_support = true;
3026 if (pmc & PCI_PM_CAP_D2)
3027 dev->d2_support = true;
3028
3029 if (dev->d1_support || dev->d2_support)
3030 pci_info(dev, "supports%s%s\n",
3031 dev->d1_support ? " D1" : "",
3032 dev->d2_support ? " D2" : "");
3033 }
3034
3035 pmc &= PCI_PM_CAP_PME_MASK;
3036 if (pmc) {
3037 pci_info(dev, "PME# supported from%s%s%s%s%s\n",
3038 (pmc & PCI_PM_CAP_PME_D0) ? " D0" : "",
3039 (pmc & PCI_PM_CAP_PME_D1) ? " D1" : "",
3040 (pmc & PCI_PM_CAP_PME_D2) ? " D2" : "",
3041 (pmc & PCI_PM_CAP_PME_D3) ? " D3hot" : "",
3042 (pmc & PCI_PM_CAP_PME_D3cold) ? " D3cold" : "");
3043 dev->pme_support = pmc >> PCI_PM_CAP_PME_SHIFT;
3044 dev->pme_poll = true;
3045 /*
3046 * Make device's PM flags reflect the wake-up capability, but
3047 * let the user space enable it to wake up the system as needed.
3048 */
3049 device_set_wakeup_capable(&dev->dev, true);
3050 /* Disable the PME# generation functionality */
3051 pci_pme_active(dev, false);
3052 }
3053
3054 pci_read_config_word(dev, PCI_STATUS, &status);
3055 if (status & PCI_STATUS_IMM_READY)
3056 dev->imm_ready = 1;
3057}
3058
3059static unsigned long pci_ea_flags(struct pci_dev *dev, u8 prop)
3060{
3061 unsigned long flags = IORESOURCE_PCI_FIXED | IORESOURCE_PCI_EA_BEI;
3062
3063 switch (prop) {
3064 case PCI_EA_P_MEM:
3065 case PCI_EA_P_VF_MEM:
3066 flags |= IORESOURCE_MEM;
3067 break;
3068 case PCI_EA_P_MEM_PREFETCH:
3069 case PCI_EA_P_VF_MEM_PREFETCH:
3070 flags |= IORESOURCE_MEM | IORESOURCE_PREFETCH;
3071 break;
3072 case PCI_EA_P_IO:
3073 flags |= IORESOURCE_IO;
3074 break;
3075 default:
3076 return 0;
3077 }
3078
3079 return flags;
3080}
3081
3082static struct resource *pci_ea_get_resource(struct pci_dev *dev, u8 bei,
3083 u8 prop)
3084{
3085 if (bei <= PCI_EA_BEI_BAR5 && prop <= PCI_EA_P_IO)
3086 return &dev->resource[bei];
3087#ifdef CONFIG_PCI_IOV
3088 else if (bei >= PCI_EA_BEI_VF_BAR0 && bei <= PCI_EA_BEI_VF_BAR5 &&
3089 (prop == PCI_EA_P_VF_MEM || prop == PCI_EA_P_VF_MEM_PREFETCH))
3090 return &dev->resource[PCI_IOV_RESOURCES +
3091 bei - PCI_EA_BEI_VF_BAR0];
3092#endif
3093 else if (bei == PCI_EA_BEI_ROM)
3094 return &dev->resource[PCI_ROM_RESOURCE];
3095 else
3096 return NULL;
3097}
3098
3099/* Read an Enhanced Allocation (EA) entry */
3100static int pci_ea_read(struct pci_dev *dev, int offset)
3101{
3102 struct resource *res;
3103 int ent_size, ent_offset = offset;
3104 resource_size_t start, end;
3105 unsigned long flags;
3106 u32 dw0, bei, base, max_offset;
3107 u8 prop;
3108 bool support_64 = (sizeof(resource_size_t) >= 8);
3109
3110 pci_read_config_dword(dev, ent_offset, &dw0);
3111 ent_offset += 4;
3112
3113 /* Entry size field indicates DWORDs after 1st */
3114 ent_size = ((dw0 & PCI_EA_ES) + 1) << 2;
3115
3116 if (!(dw0 & PCI_EA_ENABLE)) /* Entry not enabled */
3117 goto out;
3118
3119 bei = (dw0 & PCI_EA_BEI) >> 4;
3120 prop = (dw0 & PCI_EA_PP) >> 8;
3121
3122 /*
3123 * If the Property is in the reserved range, try the Secondary
3124 * Property instead.
3125 */
3126 if (prop > PCI_EA_P_BRIDGE_IO && prop < PCI_EA_P_MEM_RESERVED)
3127 prop = (dw0 & PCI_EA_SP) >> 16;
3128 if (prop > PCI_EA_P_BRIDGE_IO)
3129 goto out;
3130
3131 res = pci_ea_get_resource(dev, bei, prop);
3132 if (!res) {
3133 pci_err(dev, "Unsupported EA entry BEI: %u\n", bei);
3134 goto out;
3135 }
3136
3137 flags = pci_ea_flags(dev, prop);
3138 if (!flags) {
3139 pci_err(dev, "Unsupported EA properties: %#x\n", prop);
3140 goto out;
3141 }
3142
3143 /* Read Base */
3144 pci_read_config_dword(dev, ent_offset, &base);
3145 start = (base & PCI_EA_FIELD_MASK);
3146 ent_offset += 4;
3147
3148 /* Read MaxOffset */
3149 pci_read_config_dword(dev, ent_offset, &max_offset);
3150 ent_offset += 4;
3151
3152 /* Read Base MSBs (if 64-bit entry) */
3153 if (base & PCI_EA_IS_64) {
3154 u32 base_upper;
3155
3156 pci_read_config_dword(dev, ent_offset, &base_upper);
3157 ent_offset += 4;
3158
3159 flags |= IORESOURCE_MEM_64;
3160
3161 /* entry starts above 32-bit boundary, can't use */
3162 if (!support_64 && base_upper)
3163 goto out;
3164
3165 if (support_64)
3166 start |= ((u64)base_upper << 32);
3167 }
3168
3169 end = start + (max_offset | 0x03);
3170
3171 /* Read MaxOffset MSBs (if 64-bit entry) */
3172 if (max_offset & PCI_EA_IS_64) {
3173 u32 max_offset_upper;
3174
3175 pci_read_config_dword(dev, ent_offset, &max_offset_upper);
3176 ent_offset += 4;
3177
3178 flags |= IORESOURCE_MEM_64;
3179
3180 /* entry too big, can't use */
3181 if (!support_64 && max_offset_upper)
3182 goto out;
3183
3184 if (support_64)
3185 end += ((u64)max_offset_upper << 32);
3186 }
3187
3188 if (end < start) {
3189 pci_err(dev, "EA Entry crosses address boundary\n");
3190 goto out;
3191 }
3192
3193 if (ent_size != ent_offset - offset) {
3194 pci_err(dev, "EA Entry Size (%d) does not match length read (%d)\n",
3195 ent_size, ent_offset - offset);
3196 goto out;
3197 }
3198
3199 res->name = pci_name(dev);
3200 res->start = start;
3201 res->end = end;
3202 res->flags = flags;
3203
3204 if (bei <= PCI_EA_BEI_BAR5)
3205 pci_info(dev, "BAR %d: %pR (from Enhanced Allocation, properties %#02x)\n",
3206 bei, res, prop);
3207 else if (bei == PCI_EA_BEI_ROM)
3208 pci_info(dev, "ROM: %pR (from Enhanced Allocation, properties %#02x)\n",
3209 res, prop);
3210 else if (bei >= PCI_EA_BEI_VF_BAR0 && bei <= PCI_EA_BEI_VF_BAR5)
3211 pci_info(dev, "VF BAR %d: %pR (from Enhanced Allocation, properties %#02x)\n",
3212 bei - PCI_EA_BEI_VF_BAR0, res, prop);
3213 else
3214 pci_info(dev, "BEI %d res: %pR (from Enhanced Allocation, properties %#02x)\n",
3215 bei, res, prop);
3216
3217out:
3218 return offset + ent_size;
3219}
3220
3221/* Enhanced Allocation Initialization */
3222void pci_ea_init(struct pci_dev *dev)
3223{
3224 int ea;
3225 u8 num_ent;
3226 int offset;
3227 int i;
3228
3229 /* find PCI EA capability in list */
3230 ea = pci_find_capability(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_EA);
3231 if (!ea)
3232 return;
3233
3234 /* determine the number of entries */
3235 pci_bus_read_config_byte(dev->bus, dev->devfn, ea + PCI_EA_NUM_ENT,
3236 &num_ent);
3237 num_ent &= PCI_EA_NUM_ENT_MASK;
3238
3239 offset = ea + PCI_EA_FIRST_ENT;
3240
3241 /* Skip DWORD 2 for type 1 functions */
3242 if (dev->hdr_type == PCI_HEADER_TYPE_BRIDGE)
3243 offset += 4;
3244
3245 /* parse each EA entry */
3246 for (i = 0; i < num_ent; ++i)
3247 offset = pci_ea_read(dev, offset);
3248}
3249
3250static void pci_add_saved_cap(struct pci_dev *pci_dev,
3251 struct pci_cap_saved_state *new_cap)
3252{
3253 hlist_add_head(&new_cap->next, &pci_dev->saved_cap_space);
3254}
3255
3256/**
3257 * _pci_add_cap_save_buffer - allocate buffer for saving given
3258 * capability registers
3259 * @dev: the PCI device
3260 * @cap: the capability to allocate the buffer for
3261 * @extended: Standard or Extended capability ID
3262 * @size: requested size of the buffer
3263 */
3264static int _pci_add_cap_save_buffer(struct pci_dev *dev, u16 cap,
3265 bool extended, unsigned int size)
3266{
3267 int pos;
3268 struct pci_cap_saved_state *save_state;
3269
3270 if (extended)
3271 pos = pci_find_ext_capability(dev, cap);
3272 else
3273 pos = pci_find_capability(dev, cap);
3274
3275 if (!pos)
3276 return 0;
3277
3278 save_state = kzalloc(sizeof(*save_state) + size, GFP_KERNEL);
3279 if (!save_state)
3280 return -ENOMEM;
3281
3282 save_state->cap.cap_nr = cap;
3283 save_state->cap.cap_extended = extended;
3284 save_state->cap.size = size;
3285 pci_add_saved_cap(dev, save_state);
3286
3287 return 0;
3288}
3289
3290int pci_add_cap_save_buffer(struct pci_dev *dev, char cap, unsigned int size)
3291{
3292 return _pci_add_cap_save_buffer(dev, cap, false, size);
3293}
3294
3295int pci_add_ext_cap_save_buffer(struct pci_dev *dev, u16 cap, unsigned int size)
3296{
3297 return _pci_add_cap_save_buffer(dev, cap, true, size);
3298}
3299
3300/**
3301 * pci_allocate_cap_save_buffers - allocate buffers for saving capabilities
3302 * @dev: the PCI device
3303 */
3304void pci_allocate_cap_save_buffers(struct pci_dev *dev)
3305{
3306 int error;
3307
3308 error = pci_add_cap_save_buffer(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_EXP,
3309 PCI_EXP_SAVE_REGS * sizeof(u16));
3310 if (error)
3311 pci_err(dev, "unable to preallocate PCI Express save buffer\n");
3312
3313 error = pci_add_cap_save_buffer(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_PCIX, sizeof(u16));
3314 if (error)
3315 pci_err(dev, "unable to preallocate PCI-X save buffer\n");
3316
3317 error = pci_add_ext_cap_save_buffer(dev, PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_LTR,
3318 2 * sizeof(u16));
3319 if (error)
3320 pci_err(dev, "unable to allocate suspend buffer for LTR\n");
3321
3322 pci_allocate_vc_save_buffers(dev);
3323}
3324
3325void pci_free_cap_save_buffers(struct pci_dev *dev)
3326{
3327 struct pci_cap_saved_state *tmp;
3328 struct hlist_node *n;
3329
3330 hlist_for_each_entry_safe(tmp, n, &dev->saved_cap_space, next)
3331 kfree(tmp);
3332}
3333
3334/**
3335 * pci_configure_ari - enable or disable ARI forwarding
3336 * @dev: the PCI device
3337 *
3338 * If @dev and its upstream bridge both support ARI, enable ARI in the
3339 * bridge. Otherwise, disable ARI in the bridge.
3340 */
3341void pci_configure_ari(struct pci_dev *dev)
3342{
3343 u32 cap;
3344 struct pci_dev *bridge;
3345
3346 if (pcie_ari_disabled || !pci_is_pcie(dev) || dev->devfn)
3347 return;
3348
3349 bridge = dev->bus->self;
3350 if (!bridge)
3351 return;
3352
3353 pcie_capability_read_dword(bridge, PCI_EXP_DEVCAP2, &cap);
3354 if (!(cap & PCI_EXP_DEVCAP2_ARI))
3355 return;
3356
3357 if (pci_find_ext_capability(dev, PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_ARI)) {
3358 pcie_capability_set_word(bridge, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL2,
3359 PCI_EXP_DEVCTL2_ARI);
3360 bridge->ari_enabled = 1;
3361 } else {
3362 pcie_capability_clear_word(bridge, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL2,
3363 PCI_EXP_DEVCTL2_ARI);
3364 bridge->ari_enabled = 0;
3365 }
3366}
3367
3368static bool pci_acs_flags_enabled(struct pci_dev *pdev, u16 acs_flags)
3369{
3370 int pos;
3371 u16 cap, ctrl;
3372
3373 pos = pdev->acs_cap;
3374 if (!pos)
3375 return false;
3376
3377 /*
3378 * Except for egress control, capabilities are either required
3379 * or only required if controllable. Features missing from the
3380 * capability field can therefore be assumed as hard-wired enabled.
3381 */
3382 pci_read_config_word(pdev, pos + PCI_ACS_CAP, &cap);
3383 acs_flags &= (cap | PCI_ACS_EC);
3384
3385 pci_read_config_word(pdev, pos + PCI_ACS_CTRL, &ctrl);
3386 return (ctrl & acs_flags) == acs_flags;
3387}
3388
3389/**
3390 * pci_acs_enabled - test ACS against required flags for a given device
3391 * @pdev: device to test
3392 * @acs_flags: required PCI ACS flags
3393 *
3394 * Return true if the device supports the provided flags. Automatically
3395 * filters out flags that are not implemented on multifunction devices.
3396 *
3397 * Note that this interface checks the effective ACS capabilities of the
3398 * device rather than the actual capabilities. For instance, most single
3399 * function endpoints are not required to support ACS because they have no
3400 * opportunity for peer-to-peer access. We therefore return 'true'
3401 * regardless of whether the device exposes an ACS capability. This makes
3402 * it much easier for callers of this function to ignore the actual type
3403 * or topology of the device when testing ACS support.
3404 */
3405bool pci_acs_enabled(struct pci_dev *pdev, u16 acs_flags)
3406{
3407 int ret;
3408
3409 ret = pci_dev_specific_acs_enabled(pdev, acs_flags);
3410 if (ret >= 0)
3411 return ret > 0;
3412
3413 /*
3414 * Conventional PCI and PCI-X devices never support ACS, either
3415 * effectively or actually. The shared bus topology implies that
3416 * any device on the bus can receive or snoop DMA.
3417 */
3418 if (!pci_is_pcie(pdev))
3419 return false;
3420
3421 switch (pci_pcie_type(pdev)) {
3422 /*
3423 * PCI/X-to-PCIe bridges are not specifically mentioned by the spec,
3424 * but since their primary interface is PCI/X, we conservatively
3425 * handle them as we would a non-PCIe device.
3426 */
3427 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_PCIE_BRIDGE:
3428 /*
3429 * PCIe 3.0, 6.12.1 excludes ACS on these devices. "ACS is never
3430 * applicable... must never implement an ACS Extended Capability...".
3431 * This seems arbitrary, but we take a conservative interpretation
3432 * of this statement.
3433 */
3434 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_PCI_BRIDGE:
3435 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_RC_EC:
3436 return false;
3437 /*
3438 * PCIe 3.0, 6.12.1.1 specifies that downstream and root ports should
3439 * implement ACS in order to indicate their peer-to-peer capabilities,
3440 * regardless of whether they are single- or multi-function devices.
3441 */
3442 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_DOWNSTREAM:
3443 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_ROOT_PORT:
3444 return pci_acs_flags_enabled(pdev, acs_flags);
3445 /*
3446 * PCIe 3.0, 6.12.1.2 specifies ACS capabilities that should be
3447 * implemented by the remaining PCIe types to indicate peer-to-peer
3448 * capabilities, but only when they are part of a multifunction
3449 * device. The footnote for section 6.12 indicates the specific
3450 * PCIe types included here.
3451 */
3452 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_ENDPOINT:
3453 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_UPSTREAM:
3454 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_LEG_END:
3455 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_RC_END:
3456 if (!pdev->multifunction)
3457 break;
3458
3459 return pci_acs_flags_enabled(pdev, acs_flags);
3460 }
3461
3462 /*
3463 * PCIe 3.0, 6.12.1.3 specifies no ACS capabilities are applicable
3464 * to single function devices with the exception of downstream ports.
3465 */
3466 return true;
3467}
3468
3469/**
3470 * pci_acs_path_enable - test ACS flags from start to end in a hierarchy
3471 * @start: starting downstream device
3472 * @end: ending upstream device or NULL to search to the root bus
3473 * @acs_flags: required flags
3474 *
3475 * Walk up a device tree from start to end testing PCI ACS support. If
3476 * any step along the way does not support the required flags, return false.
3477 */
3478bool pci_acs_path_enabled(struct pci_dev *start,
3479 struct pci_dev *end, u16 acs_flags)
3480{
3481 struct pci_dev *pdev, *parent = start;
3482
3483 do {
3484 pdev = parent;
3485
3486 if (!pci_acs_enabled(pdev, acs_flags))
3487 return false;
3488
3489 if (pci_is_root_bus(pdev->bus))
3490 return (end == NULL);
3491
3492 parent = pdev->bus->self;
3493 } while (pdev != end);
3494
3495 return true;
3496}
3497
3498/**
3499 * pci_acs_init - Initialize ACS if hardware supports it
3500 * @dev: the PCI device
3501 */
3502void pci_acs_init(struct pci_dev *dev)
3503{
3504 dev->acs_cap = pci_find_ext_capability(dev, PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_ACS);
3505
3506 if (dev->acs_cap)
3507 pci_enable_acs(dev);
3508}
3509
3510/**
3511 * pci_rebar_find_pos - find position of resize ctrl reg for BAR
3512 * @pdev: PCI device
3513 * @bar: BAR to find
3514 *
3515 * Helper to find the position of the ctrl register for a BAR.
3516 * Returns -ENOTSUPP if resizable BARs are not supported at all.
3517 * Returns -ENOENT if no ctrl register for the BAR could be found.
3518 */
3519static int pci_rebar_find_pos(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bar)
3520{
3521 unsigned int pos, nbars, i;
3522 u32 ctrl;
3523
3524 pos = pci_find_ext_capability(pdev, PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_REBAR);
3525 if (!pos)
3526 return -ENOTSUPP;
3527
3528 pci_read_config_dword(pdev, pos + PCI_REBAR_CTRL, &ctrl);
3529 nbars = (ctrl & PCI_REBAR_CTRL_NBAR_MASK) >>
3530 PCI_REBAR_CTRL_NBAR_SHIFT;
3531
3532 for (i = 0; i < nbars; i++, pos += 8) {
3533 int bar_idx;
3534
3535 pci_read_config_dword(pdev, pos + PCI_REBAR_CTRL, &ctrl);
3536 bar_idx = ctrl & PCI_REBAR_CTRL_BAR_IDX;
3537 if (bar_idx == bar)
3538 return pos;
3539 }
3540
3541 return -ENOENT;
3542}
3543
3544/**
3545 * pci_rebar_get_possible_sizes - get possible sizes for BAR
3546 * @pdev: PCI device
3547 * @bar: BAR to query
3548 *
3549 * Get the possible sizes of a resizable BAR as bitmask defined in the spec
3550 * (bit 0=1MB, bit 19=512GB). Returns 0 if BAR isn't resizable.
3551 */
3552u32 pci_rebar_get_possible_sizes(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bar)
3553{
3554 int pos;
3555 u32 cap;
3556
3557 pos = pci_rebar_find_pos(pdev, bar);
3558 if (pos < 0)
3559 return 0;
3560
3561 pci_read_config_dword(pdev, pos + PCI_REBAR_CAP, &cap);
3562 return (cap & PCI_REBAR_CAP_SIZES) >> 4;
3563}
3564
3565/**
3566 * pci_rebar_get_current_size - get the current size of a BAR
3567 * @pdev: PCI device
3568 * @bar: BAR to set size to
3569 *
3570 * Read the size of a BAR from the resizable BAR config.
3571 * Returns size if found or negative error code.
3572 */
3573int pci_rebar_get_current_size(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bar)
3574{
3575 int pos;
3576 u32 ctrl;
3577
3578 pos = pci_rebar_find_pos(pdev, bar);
3579 if (pos < 0)
3580 return pos;
3581
3582 pci_read_config_dword(pdev, pos + PCI_REBAR_CTRL, &ctrl);
3583 return (ctrl & PCI_REBAR_CTRL_BAR_SIZE) >> PCI_REBAR_CTRL_BAR_SHIFT;
3584}
3585
3586/**
3587 * pci_rebar_set_size - set a new size for a BAR
3588 * @pdev: PCI device
3589 * @bar: BAR to set size to
3590 * @size: new size as defined in the spec (0=1MB, 19=512GB)
3591 *
3592 * Set the new size of a BAR as defined in the spec.
3593 * Returns zero if resizing was successful, error code otherwise.
3594 */
3595int pci_rebar_set_size(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bar, int size)
3596{
3597 int pos;
3598 u32 ctrl;
3599
3600 pos = pci_rebar_find_pos(pdev, bar);
3601 if (pos < 0)
3602 return pos;
3603
3604 pci_read_config_dword(pdev, pos + PCI_REBAR_CTRL, &ctrl);
3605 ctrl &= ~PCI_REBAR_CTRL_BAR_SIZE;
3606 ctrl |= size << PCI_REBAR_CTRL_BAR_SHIFT;
3607 pci_write_config_dword(pdev, pos + PCI_REBAR_CTRL, ctrl);
3608 return 0;
3609}
3610
3611/**
3612 * pci_enable_atomic_ops_to_root - enable AtomicOp requests to root port
3613 * @dev: the PCI device
3614 * @cap_mask: mask of desired AtomicOp sizes, including one or more of:
3615 * PCI_EXP_DEVCAP2_ATOMIC_COMP32
3616 * PCI_EXP_DEVCAP2_ATOMIC_COMP64
3617 * PCI_EXP_DEVCAP2_ATOMIC_COMP128
3618 *
3619 * Return 0 if all upstream bridges support AtomicOp routing, egress
3620 * blocking is disabled on all upstream ports, and the root port supports
3621 * the requested completion capabilities (32-bit, 64-bit and/or 128-bit
3622 * AtomicOp completion), or negative otherwise.
3623 */
3624int pci_enable_atomic_ops_to_root(struct pci_dev *dev, u32 cap_mask)
3625{
3626 struct pci_bus *bus = dev->bus;
3627 struct pci_dev *bridge;
3628 u32 cap, ctl2;
3629
3630 if (!pci_is_pcie(dev))
3631 return -EINVAL;
3632
3633 /*
3634 * Per PCIe r4.0, sec 6.15, endpoints and root ports may be
3635 * AtomicOp requesters. For now, we only support endpoints as
3636 * requesters and root ports as completers. No endpoints as
3637 * completers, and no peer-to-peer.
3638 */
3639
3640 switch (pci_pcie_type(dev)) {
3641 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_ENDPOINT:
3642 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_LEG_END:
3643 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_RC_END:
3644 break;
3645 default:
3646 return -EINVAL;
3647 }
3648
3649 while (bus->parent) {
3650 bridge = bus->self;
3651
3652 pcie_capability_read_dword(bridge, PCI_EXP_DEVCAP2, &cap);
3653
3654 switch (pci_pcie_type(bridge)) {
3655 /* Ensure switch ports support AtomicOp routing */
3656 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_UPSTREAM:
3657 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_DOWNSTREAM:
3658 if (!(cap & PCI_EXP_DEVCAP2_ATOMIC_ROUTE))
3659 return -EINVAL;
3660 break;
3661
3662 /* Ensure root port supports all the sizes we care about */
3663 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_ROOT_PORT:
3664 if ((cap & cap_mask) != cap_mask)
3665 return -EINVAL;
3666 break;
3667 }
3668
3669 /* Ensure upstream ports don't block AtomicOps on egress */
3670 if (pci_pcie_type(bridge) == PCI_EXP_TYPE_UPSTREAM) {
3671 pcie_capability_read_dword(bridge, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL2,
3672 &ctl2);
3673 if (ctl2 & PCI_EXP_DEVCTL2_ATOMIC_EGRESS_BLOCK)
3674 return -EINVAL;
3675 }
3676
3677 bus = bus->parent;
3678 }
3679
3680 pcie_capability_set_word(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL2,
3681 PCI_EXP_DEVCTL2_ATOMIC_REQ);
3682 return 0;
3683}
3684EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_enable_atomic_ops_to_root);
3685
3686/**
3687 * pci_swizzle_interrupt_pin - swizzle INTx for device behind bridge
3688 * @dev: the PCI device
3689 * @pin: the INTx pin (1=INTA, 2=INTB, 3=INTC, 4=INTD)
3690 *
3691 * Perform INTx swizzling for a device behind one level of bridge. This is
3692 * required by section 9.1 of the PCI-to-PCI bridge specification for devices
3693 * behind bridges on add-in cards. For devices with ARI enabled, the slot
3694 * number is always 0 (see the Implementation Note in section 2.2.8.1 of
3695 * the PCI Express Base Specification, Revision 2.1)
3696 */
3697u8 pci_swizzle_interrupt_pin(const struct pci_dev *dev, u8 pin)
3698{
3699 int slot;
3700
3701 if (pci_ari_enabled(dev->bus))
3702 slot = 0;
3703 else
3704 slot = PCI_SLOT(dev->devfn);
3705
3706 return (((pin - 1) + slot) % 4) + 1;
3707}
3708
3709int pci_get_interrupt_pin(struct pci_dev *dev, struct pci_dev **bridge)
3710{
3711 u8 pin;
3712
3713 pin = dev->pin;
3714 if (!pin)
3715 return -1;
3716
3717 while (!pci_is_root_bus(dev->bus)) {
3718 pin = pci_swizzle_interrupt_pin(dev, pin);
3719 dev = dev->bus->self;
3720 }
3721 *bridge = dev;
3722 return pin;
3723}
3724
3725/**
3726 * pci_common_swizzle - swizzle INTx all the way to root bridge
3727 * @dev: the PCI device
3728 * @pinp: pointer to the INTx pin value (1=INTA, 2=INTB, 3=INTD, 4=INTD)
3729 *
3730 * Perform INTx swizzling for a device. This traverses through all PCI-to-PCI
3731 * bridges all the way up to a PCI root bus.
3732 */
3733u8 pci_common_swizzle(struct pci_dev *dev, u8 *pinp)
3734{
3735 u8 pin = *pinp;
3736
3737 while (!pci_is_root_bus(dev->bus)) {
3738 pin = pci_swizzle_interrupt_pin(dev, pin);
3739 dev = dev->bus->self;
3740 }
3741 *pinp = pin;
3742 return PCI_SLOT(dev->devfn);
3743}
3744EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_common_swizzle);
3745
3746/**
3747 * pci_release_region - Release a PCI bar
3748 * @pdev: PCI device whose resources were previously reserved by
3749 * pci_request_region()
3750 * @bar: BAR to release
3751 *
3752 * Releases the PCI I/O and memory resources previously reserved by a
3753 * successful call to pci_request_region(). Call this function only
3754 * after all use of the PCI regions has ceased.
3755 */
3756void pci_release_region(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bar)
3757{
3758 struct pci_devres *dr;
3759
3760 if (pci_resource_len(pdev, bar) == 0)
3761 return;
3762 if (pci_resource_flags(pdev, bar) & IORESOURCE_IO)
3763 release_region(pci_resource_start(pdev, bar),
3764 pci_resource_len(pdev, bar));
3765 else if (pci_resource_flags(pdev, bar) & IORESOURCE_MEM)
3766 release_mem_region(pci_resource_start(pdev, bar),
3767 pci_resource_len(pdev, bar));
3768
3769 dr = find_pci_dr(pdev);
3770 if (dr)
3771 dr->region_mask &= ~(1 << bar);
3772}
3773EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_release_region);
3774
3775/**
3776 * __pci_request_region - Reserved PCI I/O and memory resource
3777 * @pdev: PCI device whose resources are to be reserved
3778 * @bar: BAR to be reserved
3779 * @res_name: Name to be associated with resource.
3780 * @exclusive: whether the region access is exclusive or not
3781 *
3782 * Mark the PCI region associated with PCI device @pdev BAR @bar as
3783 * being reserved by owner @res_name. Do not access any
3784 * address inside the PCI regions unless this call returns
3785 * successfully.
3786 *
3787 * If @exclusive is set, then the region is marked so that userspace
3788 * is explicitly not allowed to map the resource via /dev/mem or
3789 * sysfs MMIO access.
3790 *
3791 * Returns 0 on success, or %EBUSY on error. A warning
3792 * message is also printed on failure.
3793 */
3794static int __pci_request_region(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bar,
3795 const char *res_name, int exclusive)
3796{
3797 struct pci_devres *dr;
3798
3799 if (pci_resource_len(pdev, bar) == 0)
3800 return 0;
3801
3802 if (pci_resource_flags(pdev, bar) & IORESOURCE_IO) {
3803 if (!request_region(pci_resource_start(pdev, bar),
3804 pci_resource_len(pdev, bar), res_name))
3805 goto err_out;
3806 } else if (pci_resource_flags(pdev, bar) & IORESOURCE_MEM) {
3807 if (!__request_mem_region(pci_resource_start(pdev, bar),
3808 pci_resource_len(pdev, bar), res_name,
3809 exclusive))
3810 goto err_out;
3811 }
3812
3813 dr = find_pci_dr(pdev);
3814 if (dr)
3815 dr->region_mask |= 1 << bar;
3816
3817 return 0;
3818
3819err_out:
3820 pci_warn(pdev, "BAR %d: can't reserve %pR\n", bar,
3821 &pdev->resource[bar]);
3822 return -EBUSY;
3823}
3824
3825/**
3826 * pci_request_region - Reserve PCI I/O and memory resource
3827 * @pdev: PCI device whose resources are to be reserved
3828 * @bar: BAR to be reserved
3829 * @res_name: Name to be associated with resource
3830 *
3831 * Mark the PCI region associated with PCI device @pdev BAR @bar as
3832 * being reserved by owner @res_name. Do not access any
3833 * address inside the PCI regions unless this call returns
3834 * successfully.
3835 *
3836 * Returns 0 on success, or %EBUSY on error. A warning
3837 * message is also printed on failure.
3838 */
3839int pci_request_region(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bar, const char *res_name)
3840{
3841 return __pci_request_region(pdev, bar, res_name, 0);
3842}
3843EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_request_region);
3844
3845/**
3846 * pci_release_selected_regions - Release selected PCI I/O and memory resources
3847 * @pdev: PCI device whose resources were previously reserved
3848 * @bars: Bitmask of BARs to be released
3849 *
3850 * Release selected PCI I/O and memory resources previously reserved.
3851 * Call this function only after all use of the PCI regions has ceased.
3852 */
3853void pci_release_selected_regions(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bars)
3854{
3855 int i;
3856
3857 for (i = 0; i < PCI_STD_NUM_BARS; i++)
3858 if (bars & (1 << i))
3859 pci_release_region(pdev, i);
3860}
3861EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_release_selected_regions);
3862
3863static int __pci_request_selected_regions(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bars,
3864 const char *res_name, int excl)
3865{
3866 int i;
3867
3868 for (i = 0; i < PCI_STD_NUM_BARS; i++)
3869 if (bars & (1 << i))
3870 if (__pci_request_region(pdev, i, res_name, excl))
3871 goto err_out;
3872 return 0;
3873
3874err_out:
3875 while (--i >= 0)
3876 if (bars & (1 << i))
3877 pci_release_region(pdev, i);
3878
3879 return -EBUSY;
3880}
3881
3882
3883/**
3884 * pci_request_selected_regions - Reserve selected PCI I/O and memory resources
3885 * @pdev: PCI device whose resources are to be reserved
3886 * @bars: Bitmask of BARs to be requested
3887 * @res_name: Name to be associated with resource
3888 */
3889int pci_request_selected_regions(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bars,
3890 const char *res_name)
3891{
3892 return __pci_request_selected_regions(pdev, bars, res_name, 0);
3893}
3894EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_request_selected_regions);
3895
3896int pci_request_selected_regions_exclusive(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bars,
3897 const char *res_name)
3898{
3899 return __pci_request_selected_regions(pdev, bars, res_name,
3900 IORESOURCE_EXCLUSIVE);
3901}
3902EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_request_selected_regions_exclusive);
3903
3904/**
3905 * pci_release_regions - Release reserved PCI I/O and memory resources
3906 * @pdev: PCI device whose resources were previously reserved by
3907 * pci_request_regions()
3908 *
3909 * Releases all PCI I/O and memory resources previously reserved by a
3910 * successful call to pci_request_regions(). Call this function only
3911 * after all use of the PCI regions has ceased.
3912 */
3913
3914void pci_release_regions(struct pci_dev *pdev)
3915{
3916 pci_release_selected_regions(pdev, (1 << PCI_STD_NUM_BARS) - 1);
3917}
3918EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_release_regions);
3919
3920/**
3921 * pci_request_regions - Reserve PCI I/O and memory resources
3922 * @pdev: PCI device whose resources are to be reserved
3923 * @res_name: Name to be associated with resource.
3924 *
3925 * Mark all PCI regions associated with PCI device @pdev as
3926 * being reserved by owner @res_name. Do not access any
3927 * address inside the PCI regions unless this call returns
3928 * successfully.
3929 *
3930 * Returns 0 on success, or %EBUSY on error. A warning
3931 * message is also printed on failure.
3932 */
3933int pci_request_regions(struct pci_dev *pdev, const char *res_name)
3934{
3935 return pci_request_selected_regions(pdev,
3936 ((1 << PCI_STD_NUM_BARS) - 1), res_name);
3937}
3938EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_request_regions);
3939
3940/**
3941 * pci_request_regions_exclusive - Reserve PCI I/O and memory resources
3942 * @pdev: PCI device whose resources are to be reserved
3943 * @res_name: Name to be associated with resource.
3944 *
3945 * Mark all PCI regions associated with PCI device @pdev as being reserved
3946 * by owner @res_name. Do not access any address inside the PCI regions
3947 * unless this call returns successfully.
3948 *
3949 * pci_request_regions_exclusive() will mark the region so that /dev/mem
3950 * and the sysfs MMIO access will not be allowed.
3951 *
3952 * Returns 0 on success, or %EBUSY on error. A warning message is also
3953 * printed on failure.
3954 */
3955int pci_request_regions_exclusive(struct pci_dev *pdev, const char *res_name)
3956{
3957 return pci_request_selected_regions_exclusive(pdev,
3958 ((1 << PCI_STD_NUM_BARS) - 1), res_name);
3959}
3960EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_request_regions_exclusive);
3961
3962/*
3963 * Record the PCI IO range (expressed as CPU physical address + size).
3964 * Return a negative value if an error has occurred, zero otherwise
3965 */
3966int pci_register_io_range(struct fwnode_handle *fwnode, phys_addr_t addr,
3967 resource_size_t size)
3968{
3969 int ret = 0;
3970#ifdef PCI_IOBASE
3971 struct logic_pio_hwaddr *range;
3972
3973 if (!size || addr + size < addr)
3974 return -EINVAL;
3975
3976 range = kzalloc(sizeof(*range), GFP_ATOMIC);
3977 if (!range)
3978 return -ENOMEM;
3979
3980 range->fwnode = fwnode;
3981 range->size = size;
3982 range->hw_start = addr;
3983 range->flags = LOGIC_PIO_CPU_MMIO;
3984
3985 ret = logic_pio_register_range(range);
3986 if (ret)
3987 kfree(range);
3988#endif
3989
3990 return ret;
3991}
3992
3993phys_addr_t pci_pio_to_address(unsigned long pio)
3994{
3995 phys_addr_t address = (phys_addr_t)OF_BAD_ADDR;
3996
3997#ifdef PCI_IOBASE
3998 if (pio >= MMIO_UPPER_LIMIT)
3999 return address;
4000
4001 address = logic_pio_to_hwaddr(pio);
4002#endif
4003
4004 return address;
4005}
4006
4007unsigned long __weak pci_address_to_pio(phys_addr_t address)
4008{
4009#ifdef PCI_IOBASE
4010 return logic_pio_trans_cpuaddr(address);
4011#else
4012 if (address > IO_SPACE_LIMIT)
4013 return (unsigned long)-1;
4014
4015 return (unsigned long) address;
4016#endif
4017}
4018
4019/**
4020 * pci_remap_iospace - Remap the memory mapped I/O space
4021 * @res: Resource describing the I/O space
4022 * @phys_addr: physical address of range to be mapped
4023 *
4024 * Remap the memory mapped I/O space described by the @res and the CPU
4025 * physical address @phys_addr into virtual address space. Only
4026 * architectures that have memory mapped IO functions defined (and the
4027 * PCI_IOBASE value defined) should call this function.
4028 */
4029int pci_remap_iospace(const struct resource *res, phys_addr_t phys_addr)
4030{
4031#if defined(PCI_IOBASE) && defined(CONFIG_MMU)
4032 unsigned long vaddr = (unsigned long)PCI_IOBASE + res->start;
4033
4034 if (!(res->flags & IORESOURCE_IO))
4035 return -EINVAL;
4036
4037 if (res->end > IO_SPACE_LIMIT)
4038 return -EINVAL;
4039
4040 return ioremap_page_range(vaddr, vaddr + resource_size(res), phys_addr,
4041 pgprot_device(PAGE_KERNEL));
4042#else
4043 /*
4044 * This architecture does not have memory mapped I/O space,
4045 * so this function should never be called
4046 */
4047 WARN_ONCE(1, "This architecture does not support memory mapped I/O\n");
4048 return -ENODEV;
4049#endif
4050}
4051EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_remap_iospace);
4052
4053/**
4054 * pci_unmap_iospace - Unmap the memory mapped I/O space
4055 * @res: resource to be unmapped
4056 *
4057 * Unmap the CPU virtual address @res from virtual address space. Only
4058 * architectures that have memory mapped IO functions defined (and the
4059 * PCI_IOBASE value defined) should call this function.
4060 */
4061void pci_unmap_iospace(struct resource *res)
4062{
4063#if defined(PCI_IOBASE) && defined(CONFIG_MMU)
4064 unsigned long vaddr = (unsigned long)PCI_IOBASE + res->start;
4065
4066 unmap_kernel_range(vaddr, resource_size(res));
4067#endif
4068}
4069EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_unmap_iospace);
4070
4071static void devm_pci_unmap_iospace(struct device *dev, void *ptr)
4072{
4073 struct resource **res = ptr;
4074
4075 pci_unmap_iospace(*res);
4076}
4077
4078/**
4079 * devm_pci_remap_iospace - Managed pci_remap_iospace()
4080 * @dev: Generic device to remap IO address for
4081 * @res: Resource describing the I/O space
4082 * @phys_addr: physical address of range to be mapped
4083 *
4084 * Managed pci_remap_iospace(). Map is automatically unmapped on driver
4085 * detach.
4086 */
4087int devm_pci_remap_iospace(struct device *dev, const struct resource *res,
4088 phys_addr_t phys_addr)
4089{
4090 const struct resource **ptr;
4091 int error;
4092
4093 ptr = devres_alloc(devm_pci_unmap_iospace, sizeof(*ptr), GFP_KERNEL);
4094 if (!ptr)
4095 return -ENOMEM;
4096
4097 error = pci_remap_iospace(res, phys_addr);
4098 if (error) {
4099 devres_free(ptr);
4100 } else {
4101 *ptr = res;
4102 devres_add(dev, ptr);
4103 }
4104
4105 return error;
4106}
4107EXPORT_SYMBOL(devm_pci_remap_iospace);
4108
4109/**
4110 * devm_pci_remap_cfgspace - Managed pci_remap_cfgspace()
4111 * @dev: Generic device to remap IO address for
4112 * @offset: Resource address to map
4113 * @size: Size of map
4114 *
4115 * Managed pci_remap_cfgspace(). Map is automatically unmapped on driver
4116 * detach.
4117 */
4118void __iomem *devm_pci_remap_cfgspace(struct device *dev,
4119 resource_size_t offset,
4120 resource_size_t size)
4121{
4122 void __iomem **ptr, *addr;
4123
4124 ptr = devres_alloc(devm_ioremap_release, sizeof(*ptr), GFP_KERNEL);
4125 if (!ptr)
4126 return NULL;
4127
4128 addr = pci_remap_cfgspace(offset, size);
4129 if (addr) {
4130 *ptr = addr;
4131 devres_add(dev, ptr);
4132 } else
4133 devres_free(ptr);
4134
4135 return addr;
4136}
4137EXPORT_SYMBOL(devm_pci_remap_cfgspace);
4138
4139/**
4140 * devm_pci_remap_cfg_resource - check, request region and ioremap cfg resource
4141 * @dev: generic device to handle the resource for
4142 * @res: configuration space resource to be handled
4143 *
4144 * Checks that a resource is a valid memory region, requests the memory
4145 * region and ioremaps with pci_remap_cfgspace() API that ensures the
4146 * proper PCI configuration space memory attributes are guaranteed.
4147 *
4148 * All operations are managed and will be undone on driver detach.
4149 *
4150 * Returns a pointer to the remapped memory or an ERR_PTR() encoded error code
4151 * on failure. Usage example::
4152 *
4153 * res = platform_get_resource(pdev, IORESOURCE_MEM, 0);
4154 * base = devm_pci_remap_cfg_resource(&pdev->dev, res);
4155 * if (IS_ERR(base))
4156 * return PTR_ERR(base);
4157 */
4158void __iomem *devm_pci_remap_cfg_resource(struct device *dev,
4159 struct resource *res)
4160{
4161 resource_size_t size;
4162 const char *name;
4163 void __iomem *dest_ptr;
4164
4165 BUG_ON(!dev);
4166
4167 if (!res || resource_type(res) != IORESOURCE_MEM) {
4168 dev_err(dev, "invalid resource\n");
4169 return IOMEM_ERR_PTR(-EINVAL);
4170 }
4171
4172 size = resource_size(res);
4173 name = res->name ?: dev_name(dev);
4174
4175 if (!devm_request_mem_region(dev, res->start, size, name)) {
4176 dev_err(dev, "can't request region for resource %pR\n", res);
4177 return IOMEM_ERR_PTR(-EBUSY);
4178 }
4179
4180 dest_ptr = devm_pci_remap_cfgspace(dev, res->start, size);
4181 if (!dest_ptr) {
4182 dev_err(dev, "ioremap failed for resource %pR\n", res);
4183 devm_release_mem_region(dev, res->start, size);
4184 dest_ptr = IOMEM_ERR_PTR(-ENOMEM);
4185 }
4186
4187 return dest_ptr;
4188}
4189EXPORT_SYMBOL(devm_pci_remap_cfg_resource);
4190
4191static void __pci_set_master(struct pci_dev *dev, bool enable)
4192{
4193 u16 old_cmd, cmd;
4194
4195 pci_read_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, &old_cmd);
4196 if (enable)
4197 cmd = old_cmd | PCI_COMMAND_MASTER;
4198 else
4199 cmd = old_cmd & ~PCI_COMMAND_MASTER;
4200 if (cmd != old_cmd) {
4201 pci_dbg(dev, "%s bus mastering\n",
4202 enable ? "enabling" : "disabling");
4203 pci_write_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, cmd);
4204 }
4205 dev->is_busmaster = enable;
4206}
4207
4208/**
4209 * pcibios_setup - process "pci=" kernel boot arguments
4210 * @str: string used to pass in "pci=" kernel boot arguments
4211 *
4212 * Process kernel boot arguments. This is the default implementation.
4213 * Architecture specific implementations can override this as necessary.
4214 */
4215char * __weak __init pcibios_setup(char *str)
4216{
4217 return str;
4218}
4219
4220/**
4221 * pcibios_set_master - enable PCI bus-mastering for device dev
4222 * @dev: the PCI device to enable
4223 *
4224 * Enables PCI bus-mastering for the device. This is the default
4225 * implementation. Architecture specific implementations can override
4226 * this if necessary.
4227 */
4228void __weak pcibios_set_master(struct pci_dev *dev)
4229{
4230 u8 lat;
4231
4232 /* The latency timer doesn't apply to PCIe (either Type 0 or Type 1) */
4233 if (pci_is_pcie(dev))
4234 return;
4235
4236 pci_read_config_byte(dev, PCI_LATENCY_TIMER, &lat);
4237 if (lat < 16)
4238 lat = (64 <= pcibios_max_latency) ? 64 : pcibios_max_latency;
4239 else if (lat > pcibios_max_latency)
4240 lat = pcibios_max_latency;
4241 else
4242 return;
4243
4244 pci_write_config_byte(dev, PCI_LATENCY_TIMER, lat);
4245}
4246
4247/**
4248 * pci_set_master - enables bus-mastering for device dev
4249 * @dev: the PCI device to enable
4250 *
4251 * Enables bus-mastering on the device and calls pcibios_set_master()
4252 * to do the needed arch specific settings.
4253 */
4254void pci_set_master(struct pci_dev *dev)
4255{
4256 __pci_set_master(dev, true);
4257 pcibios_set_master(dev);
4258}
4259EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_set_master);
4260
4261/**
4262 * pci_clear_master - disables bus-mastering for device dev
4263 * @dev: the PCI device to disable
4264 */
4265void pci_clear_master(struct pci_dev *dev)
4266{
4267 __pci_set_master(dev, false);
4268}
4269EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_clear_master);
4270
4271/**
4272 * pci_set_cacheline_size - ensure the CACHE_LINE_SIZE register is programmed
4273 * @dev: the PCI device for which MWI is to be enabled
4274 *
4275 * Helper function for pci_set_mwi.
4276 * Originally copied from drivers/net/acenic.c.
4277 * Copyright 1998-2001 by Jes Sorensen, <jes@trained-monkey.org>.
4278 *
4279 * RETURNS: An appropriate -ERRNO error value on error, or zero for success.
4280 */
4281int pci_set_cacheline_size(struct pci_dev *dev)
4282{
4283 u8 cacheline_size;
4284
4285 if (!pci_cache_line_size)
4286 return -EINVAL;
4287
4288 /* Validate current setting: the PCI_CACHE_LINE_SIZE must be
4289 equal to or multiple of the right value. */
4290 pci_read_config_byte(dev, PCI_CACHE_LINE_SIZE, &cacheline_size);
4291 if (cacheline_size >= pci_cache_line_size &&
4292 (cacheline_size % pci_cache_line_size) == 0)
4293 return 0;
4294
4295 /* Write the correct value. */
4296 pci_write_config_byte(dev, PCI_CACHE_LINE_SIZE, pci_cache_line_size);
4297 /* Read it back. */
4298 pci_read_config_byte(dev, PCI_CACHE_LINE_SIZE, &cacheline_size);
4299 if (cacheline_size == pci_cache_line_size)
4300 return 0;
4301
4302 pci_info(dev, "cache line size of %d is not supported\n",
4303 pci_cache_line_size << 2);
4304
4305 return -EINVAL;
4306}
4307EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_set_cacheline_size);
4308
4309/**
4310 * pci_set_mwi - enables memory-write-invalidate PCI transaction
4311 * @dev: the PCI device for which MWI is enabled
4312 *
4313 * Enables the Memory-Write-Invalidate transaction in %PCI_COMMAND.
4314 *
4315 * RETURNS: An appropriate -ERRNO error value on error, or zero for success.
4316 */
4317int pci_set_mwi(struct pci_dev *dev)
4318{
4319#ifdef PCI_DISABLE_MWI
4320 return 0;
4321#else
4322 int rc;
4323 u16 cmd;
4324
4325 rc = pci_set_cacheline_size(dev);
4326 if (rc)
4327 return rc;
4328
4329 pci_read_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, &cmd);
4330 if (!(cmd & PCI_COMMAND_INVALIDATE)) {
4331 pci_dbg(dev, "enabling Mem-Wr-Inval\n");
4332 cmd |= PCI_COMMAND_INVALIDATE;
4333 pci_write_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, cmd);
4334 }
4335 return 0;
4336#endif
4337}
4338EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_set_mwi);
4339
4340/**
4341 * pcim_set_mwi - a device-managed pci_set_mwi()
4342 * @dev: the PCI device for which MWI is enabled
4343 *
4344 * Managed pci_set_mwi().
4345 *
4346 * RETURNS: An appropriate -ERRNO error value on error, or zero for success.
4347 */
4348int pcim_set_mwi(struct pci_dev *dev)
4349{
4350 struct pci_devres *dr;
4351
4352 dr = find_pci_dr(dev);
4353 if (!dr)
4354 return -ENOMEM;
4355
4356 dr->mwi = 1;
4357 return pci_set_mwi(dev);
4358}
4359EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcim_set_mwi);
4360
4361/**
4362 * pci_try_set_mwi - enables memory-write-invalidate PCI transaction
4363 * @dev: the PCI device for which MWI is enabled
4364 *
4365 * Enables the Memory-Write-Invalidate transaction in %PCI_COMMAND.
4366 * Callers are not required to check the return value.
4367 *
4368 * RETURNS: An appropriate -ERRNO error value on error, or zero for success.
4369 */
4370int pci_try_set_mwi(struct pci_dev *dev)
4371{
4372#ifdef PCI_DISABLE_MWI
4373 return 0;
4374#else
4375 return pci_set_mwi(dev);
4376#endif
4377}
4378EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_try_set_mwi);
4379
4380/**
4381 * pci_clear_mwi - disables Memory-Write-Invalidate for device dev
4382 * @dev: the PCI device to disable
4383 *
4384 * Disables PCI Memory-Write-Invalidate transaction on the device
4385 */
4386void pci_clear_mwi(struct pci_dev *dev)
4387{
4388#ifndef PCI_DISABLE_MWI
4389 u16 cmd;
4390
4391 pci_read_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, &cmd);
4392 if (cmd & PCI_COMMAND_INVALIDATE) {
4393 cmd &= ~PCI_COMMAND_INVALIDATE;
4394 pci_write_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, cmd);
4395 }
4396#endif
4397}
4398EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_clear_mwi);
4399
4400/**
4401 * pci_intx - enables/disables PCI INTx for device dev
4402 * @pdev: the PCI device to operate on
4403 * @enable: boolean: whether to enable or disable PCI INTx
4404 *
4405 * Enables/disables PCI INTx for device @pdev
4406 */
4407void pci_intx(struct pci_dev *pdev, int enable)
4408{
4409 u16 pci_command, new;
4410
4411 pci_read_config_word(pdev, PCI_COMMAND, &pci_command);
4412
4413 if (enable)
4414 new = pci_command & ~PCI_COMMAND_INTX_DISABLE;
4415 else
4416 new = pci_command | PCI_COMMAND_INTX_DISABLE;
4417
4418 if (new != pci_command) {
4419 struct pci_devres *dr;
4420
4421 pci_write_config_word(pdev, PCI_COMMAND, new);
4422
4423 dr = find_pci_dr(pdev);
4424 if (dr && !dr->restore_intx) {
4425 dr->restore_intx = 1;
4426 dr->orig_intx = !enable;
4427 }
4428 }
4429}
4430EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_intx);
4431
4432static bool pci_check_and_set_intx_mask(struct pci_dev *dev, bool mask)
4433{
4434 struct pci_bus *bus = dev->bus;
4435 bool mask_updated = true;
4436 u32 cmd_status_dword;
4437 u16 origcmd, newcmd;
4438 unsigned long flags;
4439 bool irq_pending;
4440
4441 /*
4442 * We do a single dword read to retrieve both command and status.
4443 * Document assumptions that make this possible.
4444 */
4445 BUILD_BUG_ON(PCI_COMMAND % 4);
4446 BUILD_BUG_ON(PCI_COMMAND + 2 != PCI_STATUS);
4447
4448 raw_spin_lock_irqsave(&pci_lock, flags);
4449
4450 bus->ops->read(bus, dev->devfn, PCI_COMMAND, 4, &cmd_status_dword);
4451
4452 irq_pending = (cmd_status_dword >> 16) & PCI_STATUS_INTERRUPT;
4453
4454 /*
4455 * Check interrupt status register to see whether our device
4456 * triggered the interrupt (when masking) or the next IRQ is
4457 * already pending (when unmasking).
4458 */
4459 if (mask != irq_pending) {
4460 mask_updated = false;
4461 goto done;
4462 }
4463
4464 origcmd = cmd_status_dword;
4465 newcmd = origcmd & ~PCI_COMMAND_INTX_DISABLE;
4466 if (mask)
4467 newcmd |= PCI_COMMAND_INTX_DISABLE;
4468 if (newcmd != origcmd)
4469 bus->ops->write(bus, dev->devfn, PCI_COMMAND, 2, newcmd);
4470
4471done:
4472 raw_spin_unlock_irqrestore(&pci_lock, flags);
4473
4474 return mask_updated;
4475}
4476
4477/**
4478 * pci_check_and_mask_intx - mask INTx on pending interrupt
4479 * @dev: the PCI device to operate on
4480 *
4481 * Check if the device dev has its INTx line asserted, mask it and return
4482 * true in that case. False is returned if no interrupt was pending.
4483 */
4484bool pci_check_and_mask_intx(struct pci_dev *dev)
4485{
4486 return pci_check_and_set_intx_mask(dev, true);
4487}
4488EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_check_and_mask_intx);
4489
4490/**
4491 * pci_check_and_unmask_intx - unmask INTx if no interrupt is pending
4492 * @dev: the PCI device to operate on
4493 *
4494 * Check if the device dev has its INTx line asserted, unmask it if not and
4495 * return true. False is returned and the mask remains active if there was
4496 * still an interrupt pending.
4497 */
4498bool pci_check_and_unmask_intx(struct pci_dev *dev)
4499{
4500 return pci_check_and_set_intx_mask(dev, false);
4501}
4502EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_check_and_unmask_intx);
4503
4504/**
4505 * pci_wait_for_pending_transaction - wait for pending transaction
4506 * @dev: the PCI device to operate on
4507 *
4508 * Return 0 if transaction is pending 1 otherwise.
4509 */
4510int pci_wait_for_pending_transaction(struct pci_dev *dev)
4511{
4512 if (!pci_is_pcie(dev))
4513 return 1;
4514
4515 return pci_wait_for_pending(dev, pci_pcie_cap(dev) + PCI_EXP_DEVSTA,
4516 PCI_EXP_DEVSTA_TRPND);
4517}
4518EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_wait_for_pending_transaction);
4519
4520/**
4521 * pcie_has_flr - check if a device supports function level resets
4522 * @dev: device to check
4523 *
4524 * Returns true if the device advertises support for PCIe function level
4525 * resets.
4526 */
4527bool pcie_has_flr(struct pci_dev *dev)
4528{
4529 u32 cap;
4530
4531 if (dev->dev_flags & PCI_DEV_FLAGS_NO_FLR_RESET)
4532 return false;
4533
4534 pcie_capability_read_dword(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVCAP, &cap);
4535 return cap & PCI_EXP_DEVCAP_FLR;
4536}
4537EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pcie_has_flr);
4538
4539/**
4540 * pcie_flr - initiate a PCIe function level reset
4541 * @dev: device to reset
4542 *
4543 * Initiate a function level reset on @dev. The caller should ensure the
4544 * device supports FLR before calling this function, e.g. by using the
4545 * pcie_has_flr() helper.
4546 */
4547int pcie_flr(struct pci_dev *dev)
4548{
4549 if (!pci_wait_for_pending_transaction(dev))
4550 pci_err(dev, "timed out waiting for pending transaction; performing function level reset anyway\n");
4551
4552 pcie_capability_set_word(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL_BCR_FLR);
4553
4554 if (dev->imm_ready)
4555 return 0;
4556
4557 /*
4558 * Per PCIe r4.0, sec 6.6.2, a device must complete an FLR within
4559 * 100ms, but may silently discard requests while the FLR is in
4560 * progress. Wait 100ms before trying to access the device.
4561 */
4562 msleep(100);
4563
4564 return pci_dev_wait(dev, "FLR", PCIE_RESET_READY_POLL_MS);
4565}
4566EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pcie_flr);
4567
4568static int pci_af_flr(struct pci_dev *dev, int probe)
4569{
4570 int pos;
4571 u8 cap;
4572
4573 pos = pci_find_capability(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_AF);
4574 if (!pos)
4575 return -ENOTTY;
4576
4577 if (dev->dev_flags & PCI_DEV_FLAGS_NO_FLR_RESET)
4578 return -ENOTTY;
4579
4580 pci_read_config_byte(dev, pos + PCI_AF_CAP, &cap);
4581 if (!(cap & PCI_AF_CAP_TP) || !(cap & PCI_AF_CAP_FLR))
4582 return -ENOTTY;
4583
4584 if (probe)
4585 return 0;
4586
4587 /*
4588 * Wait for Transaction Pending bit to clear. A word-aligned test
4589 * is used, so we use the control offset rather than status and shift
4590 * the test bit to match.
4591 */
4592 if (!pci_wait_for_pending(dev, pos + PCI_AF_CTRL,
4593 PCI_AF_STATUS_TP << 8))
4594 pci_err(dev, "timed out waiting for pending transaction; performing AF function level reset anyway\n");
4595
4596 pci_write_config_byte(dev, pos + PCI_AF_CTRL, PCI_AF_CTRL_FLR);
4597
4598 if (dev->imm_ready)
4599 return 0;
4600
4601 /*
4602 * Per Advanced Capabilities for Conventional PCI ECN, 13 April 2006,
4603 * updated 27 July 2006; a device must complete an FLR within
4604 * 100ms, but may silently discard requests while the FLR is in
4605 * progress. Wait 100ms before trying to access the device.
4606 */
4607 msleep(100);
4608
4609 return pci_dev_wait(dev, "AF_FLR", PCIE_RESET_READY_POLL_MS);
4610}
4611
4612/**
4613 * pci_pm_reset - Put device into PCI_D3 and back into PCI_D0.
4614 * @dev: Device to reset.
4615 * @probe: If set, only check if the device can be reset this way.
4616 *
4617 * If @dev supports native PCI PM and its PCI_PM_CTRL_NO_SOFT_RESET flag is
4618 * unset, it will be reinitialized internally when going from PCI_D3hot to
4619 * PCI_D0. If that's the case and the device is not in a low-power state
4620 * already, force it into PCI_D3hot and back to PCI_D0, causing it to be reset.
4621 *
4622 * NOTE: This causes the caller to sleep for twice the device power transition
4623 * cooldown period, which for the D0->D3hot and D3hot->D0 transitions is 10 ms
4624 * by default (i.e. unless the @dev's d3_delay field has a different value).
4625 * Moreover, only devices in D0 can be reset by this function.
4626 */
4627static int pci_pm_reset(struct pci_dev *dev, int probe)
4628{
4629 u16 csr;
4630
4631 if (!dev->pm_cap || dev->dev_flags & PCI_DEV_FLAGS_NO_PM_RESET)
4632 return -ENOTTY;
4633
4634 pci_read_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, &csr);
4635 if (csr & PCI_PM_CTRL_NO_SOFT_RESET)
4636 return -ENOTTY;
4637
4638 if (probe)
4639 return 0;
4640
4641 if (dev->current_state != PCI_D0)
4642 return -EINVAL;
4643
4644 csr &= ~PCI_PM_CTRL_STATE_MASK;
4645 csr |= PCI_D3hot;
4646 pci_write_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, csr);
4647 pci_dev_d3_sleep(dev);
4648
4649 csr &= ~PCI_PM_CTRL_STATE_MASK;
4650 csr |= PCI_D0;
4651 pci_write_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, csr);
4652 pci_dev_d3_sleep(dev);
4653
4654 return pci_dev_wait(dev, "PM D3hot->D0", PCIE_RESET_READY_POLL_MS);
4655}
4656
4657/**
4658 * pcie_wait_for_link_delay - Wait until link is active or inactive
4659 * @pdev: Bridge device
4660 * @active: waiting for active or inactive?
4661 * @delay: Delay to wait after link has become active (in ms)
4662 *
4663 * Use this to wait till link becomes active or inactive.
4664 */
4665static bool pcie_wait_for_link_delay(struct pci_dev *pdev, bool active,
4666 int delay)
4667{
4668 int timeout = 1000;
4669 bool ret;
4670 u16 lnk_status;
4671
4672 /*
4673 * Some controllers might not implement link active reporting. In this
4674 * case, we wait for 1000 ms + any delay requested by the caller.
4675 */
4676 if (!pdev->link_active_reporting) {
4677 msleep(timeout + delay);
4678 return true;
4679 }
4680
4681 /*
4682 * PCIe r4.0 sec 6.6.1, a component must enter LTSSM Detect within 20ms,
4683 * after which we should expect an link active if the reset was
4684 * successful. If so, software must wait a minimum 100ms before sending
4685 * configuration requests to devices downstream this port.
4686 *
4687 * If the link fails to activate, either the device was physically
4688 * removed or the link is permanently failed.
4689 */
4690 if (active)
4691 msleep(20);
4692 for (;;) {
4693 pcie_capability_read_word(pdev, PCI_EXP_LNKSTA, &lnk_status);
4694 ret = !!(lnk_status & PCI_EXP_LNKSTA_DLLLA);
4695 if (ret == active)
4696 break;
4697 if (timeout <= 0)
4698 break;
4699 msleep(10);
4700 timeout -= 10;
4701 }
4702 if (active && ret)
4703 msleep(delay);
4704 else if (ret != active)
4705 pci_info(pdev, "Data Link Layer Link Active not %s in 1000 msec\n",
4706 active ? "set" : "cleared");
4707 return ret == active;
4708}
4709
4710/**
4711 * pcie_wait_for_link - Wait until link is active or inactive
4712 * @pdev: Bridge device
4713 * @active: waiting for active or inactive?
4714 *
4715 * Use this to wait till link becomes active or inactive.
4716 */
4717bool pcie_wait_for_link(struct pci_dev *pdev, bool active)
4718{
4719 return pcie_wait_for_link_delay(pdev, active, 100);
4720}
4721
4722/*
4723 * Find maximum D3cold delay required by all the devices on the bus. The
4724 * spec says 100 ms, but firmware can lower it and we allow drivers to
4725 * increase it as well.
4726 *
4727 * Called with @pci_bus_sem locked for reading.
4728 */
4729static int pci_bus_max_d3cold_delay(const struct pci_bus *bus)
4730{
4731 const struct pci_dev *pdev;
4732 int min_delay = 100;
4733 int max_delay = 0;
4734
4735 list_for_each_entry(pdev, &bus->devices, bus_list) {
4736 if (pdev->d3cold_delay < min_delay)
4737 min_delay = pdev->d3cold_delay;
4738 if (pdev->d3cold_delay > max_delay)
4739 max_delay = pdev->d3cold_delay;
4740 }
4741
4742 return max(min_delay, max_delay);
4743}
4744
4745/**
4746 * pci_bridge_wait_for_secondary_bus - Wait for secondary bus to be accessible
4747 * @dev: PCI bridge
4748 *
4749 * Handle necessary delays before access to the devices on the secondary
4750 * side of the bridge are permitted after D3cold to D0 transition.
4751 *
4752 * For PCIe this means the delays in PCIe 5.0 section 6.6.1. For
4753 * conventional PCI it means Tpvrh + Trhfa specified in PCI 3.0 section
4754 * 4.3.2.
4755 */
4756void pci_bridge_wait_for_secondary_bus(struct pci_dev *dev)
4757{
4758 struct pci_dev *child;
4759 int delay;
4760
4761 if (pci_dev_is_disconnected(dev))
4762 return;
4763
4764 if (!pci_is_bridge(dev) || !dev->bridge_d3)
4765 return;
4766
4767 down_read(&pci_bus_sem);
4768
4769 /*
4770 * We only deal with devices that are present currently on the bus.
4771 * For any hot-added devices the access delay is handled in pciehp
4772 * board_added(). In case of ACPI hotplug the firmware is expected
4773 * to configure the devices before OS is notified.
4774 */
4775 if (!dev->subordinate || list_empty(&dev->subordinate->devices)) {
4776 up_read(&pci_bus_sem);
4777 return;
4778 }
4779
4780 /* Take d3cold_delay requirements into account */
4781 delay = pci_bus_max_d3cold_delay(dev->subordinate);
4782 if (!delay) {
4783 up_read(&pci_bus_sem);
4784 return;
4785 }
4786
4787 child = list_first_entry(&dev->subordinate->devices, struct pci_dev,
4788 bus_list);
4789 up_read(&pci_bus_sem);
4790
4791 /*
4792 * Conventional PCI and PCI-X we need to wait Tpvrh + Trhfa before
4793 * accessing the device after reset (that is 1000 ms + 100 ms). In
4794 * practice this should not be needed because we don't do power
4795 * management for them (see pci_bridge_d3_possible()).
4796 */
4797 if (!pci_is_pcie(dev)) {
4798 pci_dbg(dev, "waiting %d ms for secondary bus\n", 1000 + delay);
4799 msleep(1000 + delay);
4800 return;
4801 }
4802
4803 /*
4804 * For PCIe downstream and root ports that do not support speeds
4805 * greater than 5 GT/s need to wait minimum 100 ms. For higher
4806 * speeds (gen3) we need to wait first for the data link layer to
4807 * become active.
4808 *
4809 * However, 100 ms is the minimum and the PCIe spec says the
4810 * software must allow at least 1s before it can determine that the
4811 * device that did not respond is a broken device. There is
4812 * evidence that 100 ms is not always enough, for example certain
4813 * Titan Ridge xHCI controller does not always respond to
4814 * configuration requests if we only wait for 100 ms (see
4815 * https://bugzilla.kernel.org/show_bug.cgi?id=203885).
4816 *
4817 * Therefore we wait for 100 ms and check for the device presence.
4818 * If it is still not present give it an additional 100 ms.
4819 */
4820 if (!pcie_downstream_port(dev))
4821 return;
4822
4823 if (pcie_get_speed_cap(dev) <= PCIE_SPEED_5_0GT) {
4824 pci_dbg(dev, "waiting %d ms for downstream link\n", delay);
4825 msleep(delay);
4826 } else {
4827 pci_dbg(dev, "waiting %d ms for downstream link, after activation\n",
4828 delay);
4829 if (!pcie_wait_for_link_delay(dev, true, delay)) {
4830 /* Did not train, no need to wait any further */
4831 return;
4832 }
4833 }
4834
4835 if (!pci_device_is_present(child)) {
4836 pci_dbg(child, "waiting additional %d ms to become accessible\n", delay);
4837 msleep(delay);
4838 }
4839}
4840
4841void pci_reset_secondary_bus(struct pci_dev *dev)
4842{
4843 u16 ctrl;
4844
4845 pci_read_config_word(dev, PCI_BRIDGE_CONTROL, &ctrl);
4846 ctrl |= PCI_BRIDGE_CTL_BUS_RESET;
4847 pci_write_config_word(dev, PCI_BRIDGE_CONTROL, ctrl);
4848
4849 /*
4850 * PCI spec v3.0 7.6.4.2 requires minimum Trst of 1ms. Double
4851 * this to 2ms to ensure that we meet the minimum requirement.
4852 */
4853 msleep(2);
4854
4855 ctrl &= ~PCI_BRIDGE_CTL_BUS_RESET;
4856 pci_write_config_word(dev, PCI_BRIDGE_CONTROL, ctrl);
4857
4858 /*
4859 * Trhfa for conventional PCI is 2^25 clock cycles.
4860 * Assuming a minimum 33MHz clock this results in a 1s
4861 * delay before we can consider subordinate devices to
4862 * be re-initialized. PCIe has some ways to shorten this,
4863 * but we don't make use of them yet.
4864 */
4865 ssleep(1);
4866}
4867
4868void __weak pcibios_reset_secondary_bus(struct pci_dev *dev)
4869{
4870 pci_reset_secondary_bus(dev);
4871}
4872
4873/**
4874 * pci_bridge_secondary_bus_reset - Reset the secondary bus on a PCI bridge.
4875 * @dev: Bridge device
4876 *
4877 * Use the bridge control register to assert reset on the secondary bus.
4878 * Devices on the secondary bus are left in power-on state.
4879 */
4880int pci_bridge_secondary_bus_reset(struct pci_dev *dev)
4881{
4882 pcibios_reset_secondary_bus(dev);
4883
4884 return pci_dev_wait(dev, "bus reset", PCIE_RESET_READY_POLL_MS);
4885}
4886EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_bridge_secondary_bus_reset);
4887
4888static int pci_parent_bus_reset(struct pci_dev *dev, int probe)
4889{
4890 struct pci_dev *pdev;
4891
4892 if (pci_is_root_bus(dev->bus) || dev->subordinate ||
4893 !dev->bus->self || dev->dev_flags & PCI_DEV_FLAGS_NO_BUS_RESET)
4894 return -ENOTTY;
4895
4896 list_for_each_entry(pdev, &dev->bus->devices, bus_list)
4897 if (pdev != dev)
4898 return -ENOTTY;
4899
4900 if (probe)
4901 return 0;
4902
4903 return pci_bridge_secondary_bus_reset(dev->bus->self);
4904}
4905
4906static int pci_reset_hotplug_slot(struct hotplug_slot *hotplug, int probe)
4907{
4908 int rc = -ENOTTY;
4909
4910 if (!hotplug || !try_module_get(hotplug->owner))
4911 return rc;
4912
4913 if (hotplug->ops->reset_slot)
4914 rc = hotplug->ops->reset_slot(hotplug, probe);
4915
4916 module_put(hotplug->owner);
4917
4918 return rc;
4919}
4920
4921static int pci_dev_reset_slot_function(struct pci_dev *dev, int probe)
4922{
4923 struct pci_dev *pdev;
4924
4925 if (dev->subordinate || !dev->slot ||
4926 dev->dev_flags & PCI_DEV_FLAGS_NO_BUS_RESET)
4927 return -ENOTTY;
4928
4929 list_for_each_entry(pdev, &dev->bus->devices, bus_list)
4930 if (pdev != dev && pdev->slot == dev->slot)
4931 return -ENOTTY;
4932
4933 return pci_reset_hotplug_slot(dev->slot->hotplug, probe);
4934}
4935
4936static void pci_dev_lock(struct pci_dev *dev)
4937{
4938 pci_cfg_access_lock(dev);
4939 /* block PM suspend, driver probe, etc. */
4940 device_lock(&dev->dev);
4941}
4942
4943/* Return 1 on successful lock, 0 on contention */
4944static int pci_dev_trylock(struct pci_dev *dev)
4945{
4946 if (pci_cfg_access_trylock(dev)) {
4947 if (device_trylock(&dev->dev))
4948 return 1;
4949 pci_cfg_access_unlock(dev);
4950 }
4951
4952 return 0;
4953}
4954
4955static void pci_dev_unlock(struct pci_dev *dev)
4956{
4957 device_unlock(&dev->dev);
4958 pci_cfg_access_unlock(dev);
4959}
4960
4961static void pci_dev_save_and_disable(struct pci_dev *dev)
4962{
4963 const struct pci_error_handlers *err_handler =
4964 dev->driver ? dev->driver->err_handler : NULL;
4965
4966 /*
4967 * dev->driver->err_handler->reset_prepare() is protected against
4968 * races with ->remove() by the device lock, which must be held by
4969 * the caller.
4970 */
4971 if (err_handler && err_handler->reset_prepare)
4972 err_handler->reset_prepare(dev);
4973
4974 /*
4975 * Wake-up device prior to save. PM registers default to D0 after
4976 * reset and a simple register restore doesn't reliably return
4977 * to a non-D0 state anyway.
4978 */
4979 pci_set_power_state(dev, PCI_D0);
4980
4981 pci_save_state(dev);
4982 /*
4983 * Disable the device by clearing the Command register, except for
4984 * INTx-disable which is set. This not only disables MMIO and I/O port
4985 * BARs, but also prevents the device from being Bus Master, preventing
4986 * DMA from the device including MSI/MSI-X interrupts. For PCI 2.3
4987 * compliant devices, INTx-disable prevents legacy interrupts.
4988 */
4989 pci_write_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, PCI_COMMAND_INTX_DISABLE);
4990}
4991
4992static void pci_dev_restore(struct pci_dev *dev)
4993{
4994 const struct pci_error_handlers *err_handler =
4995 dev->driver ? dev->driver->err_handler : NULL;
4996
4997 pci_restore_state(dev);
4998
4999 /*
5000 * dev->driver->err_handler->reset_done() is protected against
5001 * races with ->remove() by the device lock, which must be held by
5002 * the caller.
5003 */
5004 if (err_handler && err_handler->reset_done)
5005 err_handler->reset_done(dev);
5006}
5007
5008/**
5009 * __pci_reset_function_locked - reset a PCI device function while holding
5010 * the @dev mutex lock.
5011 * @dev: PCI device to reset
5012 *
5013 * Some devices allow an individual function to be reset without affecting
5014 * other functions in the same device. The PCI device must be responsive
5015 * to PCI config space in order to use this function.
5016 *
5017 * The device function is presumed to be unused and the caller is holding
5018 * the device mutex lock when this function is called.
5019 *
5020 * Resetting the device will make the contents of PCI configuration space
5021 * random, so any caller of this must be prepared to reinitialise the
5022 * device including MSI, bus mastering, BARs, decoding IO and memory spaces,
5023 * etc.
5024 *
5025 * Returns 0 if the device function was successfully reset or negative if the
5026 * device doesn't support resetting a single function.
5027 */
5028int __pci_reset_function_locked(struct pci_dev *dev)
5029{
5030 int rc;
5031
5032 might_sleep();
5033
5034 /*
5035 * A reset method returns -ENOTTY if it doesn't support this device
5036 * and we should try the next method.
5037 *
5038 * If it returns 0 (success), we're finished. If it returns any
5039 * other error, we're also finished: this indicates that further
5040 * reset mechanisms might be broken on the device.
5041 */
5042 rc = pci_dev_specific_reset(dev, 0);
5043 if (rc != -ENOTTY)
5044 return rc;
5045 if (pcie_has_flr(dev)) {
5046 rc = pcie_flr(dev);
5047 if (rc != -ENOTTY)
5048 return rc;
5049 }
5050 rc = pci_af_flr(dev, 0);
5051 if (rc != -ENOTTY)
5052 return rc;
5053 rc = pci_pm_reset(dev, 0);
5054 if (rc != -ENOTTY)
5055 return rc;
5056 rc = pci_dev_reset_slot_function(dev, 0);
5057 if (rc != -ENOTTY)
5058 return rc;
5059 return pci_parent_bus_reset(dev, 0);
5060}
5061EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(__pci_reset_function_locked);
5062
5063/**
5064 * pci_probe_reset_function - check whether the device can be safely reset
5065 * @dev: PCI device to reset
5066 *
5067 * Some devices allow an individual function to be reset without affecting
5068 * other functions in the same device. The PCI device must be responsive
5069 * to PCI config space in order to use this function.
5070 *
5071 * Returns 0 if the device function can be reset or negative if the
5072 * device doesn't support resetting a single function.
5073 */
5074int pci_probe_reset_function(struct pci_dev *dev)
5075{
5076 int rc;
5077
5078 might_sleep();
5079
5080 rc = pci_dev_specific_reset(dev, 1);
5081 if (rc != -ENOTTY)
5082 return rc;
5083 if (pcie_has_flr(dev))
5084 return 0;
5085 rc = pci_af_flr(dev, 1);
5086 if (rc != -ENOTTY)
5087 return rc;
5088 rc = pci_pm_reset(dev, 1);
5089 if (rc != -ENOTTY)
5090 return rc;
5091 rc = pci_dev_reset_slot_function(dev, 1);
5092 if (rc != -ENOTTY)
5093 return rc;
5094
5095 return pci_parent_bus_reset(dev, 1);
5096}
5097
5098/**
5099 * pci_reset_function - quiesce and reset a PCI device function
5100 * @dev: PCI device to reset
5101 *
5102 * Some devices allow an individual function to be reset without affecting
5103 * other functions in the same device. The PCI device must be responsive
5104 * to PCI config space in order to use this function.
5105 *
5106 * This function does not just reset the PCI portion of a device, but
5107 * clears all the state associated with the device. This function differs
5108 * from __pci_reset_function_locked() in that it saves and restores device state
5109 * over the reset and takes the PCI device lock.
5110 *
5111 * Returns 0 if the device function was successfully reset or negative if the
5112 * device doesn't support resetting a single function.
5113 */
5114int pci_reset_function(struct pci_dev *dev)
5115{
5116 int rc;
5117
5118 if (!dev->reset_fn)
5119 return -ENOTTY;
5120
5121 pci_dev_lock(dev);
5122 pci_dev_save_and_disable(dev);
5123
5124 rc = __pci_reset_function_locked(dev);
5125
5126 pci_dev_restore(dev);
5127 pci_dev_unlock(dev);
5128
5129 return rc;
5130}
5131EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_reset_function);
5132
5133/**
5134 * pci_reset_function_locked - quiesce and reset a PCI device function
5135 * @dev: PCI device to reset
5136 *
5137 * Some devices allow an individual function to be reset without affecting
5138 * other functions in the same device. The PCI device must be responsive
5139 * to PCI config space in order to use this function.
5140 *
5141 * This function does not just reset the PCI portion of a device, but
5142 * clears all the state associated with the device. This function differs
5143 * from __pci_reset_function_locked() in that it saves and restores device state
5144 * over the reset. It also differs from pci_reset_function() in that it
5145 * requires the PCI device lock to be held.
5146 *
5147 * Returns 0 if the device function was successfully reset or negative if the
5148 * device doesn't support resetting a single function.
5149 */
5150int pci_reset_function_locked(struct pci_dev *dev)
5151{
5152 int rc;
5153
5154 if (!dev->reset_fn)
5155 return -ENOTTY;
5156
5157 pci_dev_save_and_disable(dev);
5158
5159 rc = __pci_reset_function_locked(dev);
5160
5161 pci_dev_restore(dev);
5162
5163 return rc;
5164}
5165EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_reset_function_locked);
5166
5167/**
5168 * pci_try_reset_function - quiesce and reset a PCI device function
5169 * @dev: PCI device to reset
5170 *
5171 * Same as above, except return -EAGAIN if unable to lock device.
5172 */
5173int pci_try_reset_function(struct pci_dev *dev)
5174{
5175 int rc;
5176
5177 if (!dev->reset_fn)
5178 return -ENOTTY;
5179
5180 if (!pci_dev_trylock(dev))
5181 return -EAGAIN;
5182
5183 pci_dev_save_and_disable(dev);
5184 rc = __pci_reset_function_locked(dev);
5185 pci_dev_restore(dev);
5186 pci_dev_unlock(dev);
5187
5188 return rc;
5189}
5190EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_try_reset_function);
5191
5192/* Do any devices on or below this bus prevent a bus reset? */
5193static bool pci_bus_resetable(struct pci_bus *bus)
5194{
5195 struct pci_dev *dev;
5196
5197
5198 if (bus->self && (bus->self->dev_flags & PCI_DEV_FLAGS_NO_BUS_RESET))
5199 return false;
5200
5201 list_for_each_entry(dev, &bus->devices, bus_list) {
5202 if (dev->dev_flags & PCI_DEV_FLAGS_NO_BUS_RESET ||
5203 (dev->subordinate && !pci_bus_resetable(dev->subordinate)))
5204 return false;
5205 }
5206
5207 return true;
5208}
5209
5210/* Lock devices from the top of the tree down */
5211static void pci_bus_lock(struct pci_bus *bus)
5212{
5213 struct pci_dev *dev;
5214
5215 list_for_each_entry(dev, &bus->devices, bus_list) {
5216 pci_dev_lock(dev);
5217 if (dev->subordinate)
5218 pci_bus_lock(dev->subordinate);
5219 }
5220}
5221
5222/* Unlock devices from the bottom of the tree up */
5223static void pci_bus_unlock(struct pci_bus *bus)
5224{
5225 struct pci_dev *dev;
5226
5227 list_for_each_entry(dev, &bus->devices, bus_list) {
5228 if (dev->subordinate)
5229 pci_bus_unlock(dev->subordinate);
5230 pci_dev_unlock(dev);
5231 }
5232}
5233
5234/* Return 1 on successful lock, 0 on contention */
5235static int pci_bus_trylock(struct pci_bus *bus)
5236{
5237 struct pci_dev *dev;
5238
5239 list_for_each_entry(dev, &bus->devices, bus_list) {
5240 if (!pci_dev_trylock(dev))
5241 goto unlock;
5242 if (dev->subordinate) {
5243 if (!pci_bus_trylock(dev->subordinate)) {
5244 pci_dev_unlock(dev);
5245 goto unlock;
5246 }
5247 }
5248 }
5249 return 1;
5250
5251unlock:
5252 list_for_each_entry_continue_reverse(dev, &bus->devices, bus_list) {
5253 if (dev->subordinate)
5254 pci_bus_unlock(dev->subordinate);
5255 pci_dev_unlock(dev);
5256 }
5257 return 0;
5258}
5259
5260/* Do any devices on or below this slot prevent a bus reset? */
5261static bool pci_slot_resetable(struct pci_slot *slot)
5262{
5263 struct pci_dev *dev;
5264
5265 if (slot->bus->self &&
5266 (slot->bus->self->dev_flags & PCI_DEV_FLAGS_NO_BUS_RESET))
5267 return false;
5268
5269 list_for_each_entry(dev, &slot->bus->devices, bus_list) {
5270 if (!dev->slot || dev->slot != slot)
5271 continue;
5272 if (dev->dev_flags & PCI_DEV_FLAGS_NO_BUS_RESET ||
5273 (dev->subordinate && !pci_bus_resetable(dev->subordinate)))
5274 return false;
5275 }
5276
5277 return true;
5278}
5279
5280/* Lock devices from the top of the tree down */
5281static void pci_slot_lock(struct pci_slot *slot)
5282{
5283 struct pci_dev *dev;
5284
5285 list_for_each_entry(dev, &slot->bus->devices, bus_list) {
5286 if (!dev->slot || dev->slot != slot)
5287 continue;
5288 pci_dev_lock(dev);
5289 if (dev->subordinate)
5290 pci_bus_lock(dev->subordinate);
5291 }
5292}
5293
5294/* Unlock devices from the bottom of the tree up */
5295static void pci_slot_unlock(struct pci_slot *slot)
5296{
5297 struct pci_dev *dev;
5298
5299 list_for_each_entry(dev, &slot->bus->devices, bus_list) {
5300 if (!dev->slot || dev->slot != slot)
5301 continue;
5302 if (dev->subordinate)
5303 pci_bus_unlock(dev->subordinate);
5304 pci_dev_unlock(dev);
5305 }
5306}
5307
5308/* Return 1 on successful lock, 0 on contention */
5309static int pci_slot_trylock(struct pci_slot *slot)
5310{
5311 struct pci_dev *dev;
5312
5313 list_for_each_entry(dev, &slot->bus->devices, bus_list) {
5314 if (!dev->slot || dev->slot != slot)
5315 continue;
5316 if (!pci_dev_trylock(dev))
5317 goto unlock;
5318 if (dev->subordinate) {
5319 if (!pci_bus_trylock(dev->subordinate)) {
5320 pci_dev_unlock(dev);
5321 goto unlock;
5322 }
5323 }
5324 }
5325 return 1;
5326
5327unlock:
5328 list_for_each_entry_continue_reverse(dev,
5329 &slot->bus->devices, bus_list) {
5330 if (!dev->slot || dev->slot != slot)
5331 continue;
5332 if (dev->subordinate)
5333 pci_bus_unlock(dev->subordinate);
5334 pci_dev_unlock(dev);
5335 }
5336 return 0;
5337}
5338
5339/*
5340 * Save and disable devices from the top of the tree down while holding
5341 * the @dev mutex lock for the entire tree.
5342 */
5343static void pci_bus_save_and_disable_locked(struct pci_bus *bus)
5344{
5345 struct pci_dev *dev;
5346
5347 list_for_each_entry(dev, &bus->devices, bus_list) {
5348 pci_dev_save_and_disable(dev);
5349 if (dev->subordinate)
5350 pci_bus_save_and_disable_locked(dev->subordinate);
5351 }
5352}
5353
5354/*
5355 * Restore devices from top of the tree down while holding @dev mutex lock
5356 * for the entire tree. Parent bridges need to be restored before we can
5357 * get to subordinate devices.
5358 */
5359static void pci_bus_restore_locked(struct pci_bus *bus)
5360{
5361 struct pci_dev *dev;
5362
5363 list_for_each_entry(dev, &bus->devices, bus_list) {
5364 pci_dev_restore(dev);
5365 if (dev->subordinate)
5366 pci_bus_restore_locked(dev->subordinate);
5367 }
5368}
5369
5370/*
5371 * Save and disable devices from the top of the tree down while holding
5372 * the @dev mutex lock for the entire tree.
5373 */
5374static void pci_slot_save_and_disable_locked(struct pci_slot *slot)
5375{
5376 struct pci_dev *dev;
5377
5378 list_for_each_entry(dev, &slot->bus->devices, bus_list) {
5379 if (!dev->slot || dev->slot != slot)
5380 continue;
5381 pci_dev_save_and_disable(dev);
5382 if (dev->subordinate)
5383 pci_bus_save_and_disable_locked(dev->subordinate);
5384 }
5385}
5386
5387/*
5388 * Restore devices from top of the tree down while holding @dev mutex lock
5389 * for the entire tree. Parent bridges need to be restored before we can
5390 * get to subordinate devices.
5391 */
5392static void pci_slot_restore_locked(struct pci_slot *slot)
5393{
5394 struct pci_dev *dev;
5395
5396 list_for_each_entry(dev, &slot->bus->devices, bus_list) {
5397 if (!dev->slot || dev->slot != slot)
5398 continue;
5399 pci_dev_restore(dev);
5400 if (dev->subordinate)
5401 pci_bus_restore_locked(dev->subordinate);
5402 }
5403}
5404
5405static int pci_slot_reset(struct pci_slot *slot, int probe)
5406{
5407 int rc;
5408
5409 if (!slot || !pci_slot_resetable(slot))
5410 return -ENOTTY;
5411
5412 if (!probe)
5413 pci_slot_lock(slot);
5414
5415 might_sleep();
5416
5417 rc = pci_reset_hotplug_slot(slot->hotplug, probe);
5418
5419 if (!probe)
5420 pci_slot_unlock(slot);
5421
5422 return rc;
5423}
5424
5425/**
5426 * pci_probe_reset_slot - probe whether a PCI slot can be reset
5427 * @slot: PCI slot to probe
5428 *
5429 * Return 0 if slot can be reset, negative if a slot reset is not supported.
5430 */
5431int pci_probe_reset_slot(struct pci_slot *slot)
5432{
5433 return pci_slot_reset(slot, 1);
5434}
5435EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_probe_reset_slot);
5436
5437/**
5438 * __pci_reset_slot - Try to reset a PCI slot
5439 * @slot: PCI slot to reset
5440 *
5441 * A PCI bus may host multiple slots, each slot may support a reset mechanism
5442 * independent of other slots. For instance, some slots may support slot power
5443 * control. In the case of a 1:1 bus to slot architecture, this function may
5444 * wrap the bus reset to avoid spurious slot related events such as hotplug.
5445 * Generally a slot reset should be attempted before a bus reset. All of the
5446 * function of the slot and any subordinate buses behind the slot are reset
5447 * through this function. PCI config space of all devices in the slot and
5448 * behind the slot is saved before and restored after reset.
5449 *
5450 * Same as above except return -EAGAIN if the slot cannot be locked
5451 */
5452static int __pci_reset_slot(struct pci_slot *slot)
5453{
5454 int rc;
5455
5456 rc = pci_slot_reset(slot, 1);
5457 if (rc)
5458 return rc;
5459
5460 if (pci_slot_trylock(slot)) {
5461 pci_slot_save_and_disable_locked(slot);
5462 might_sleep();
5463 rc = pci_reset_hotplug_slot(slot->hotplug, 0);
5464 pci_slot_restore_locked(slot);
5465 pci_slot_unlock(slot);
5466 } else
5467 rc = -EAGAIN;
5468
5469 return rc;
5470}
5471
5472static int pci_bus_reset(struct pci_bus *bus, int probe)
5473{
5474 int ret;
5475
5476 if (!bus->self || !pci_bus_resetable(bus))
5477 return -ENOTTY;
5478
5479 if (probe)
5480 return 0;
5481
5482 pci_bus_lock(bus);
5483
5484 might_sleep();
5485
5486 ret = pci_bridge_secondary_bus_reset(bus->self);
5487
5488 pci_bus_unlock(bus);
5489
5490 return ret;
5491}
5492
5493/**
5494 * pci_bus_error_reset - reset the bridge's subordinate bus
5495 * @bridge: The parent device that connects to the bus to reset
5496 *
5497 * This function will first try to reset the slots on this bus if the method is
5498 * available. If slot reset fails or is not available, this will fall back to a
5499 * secondary bus reset.
5500 */
5501int pci_bus_error_reset(struct pci_dev *bridge)
5502{
5503 struct pci_bus *bus = bridge->subordinate;
5504 struct pci_slot *slot;
5505
5506 if (!bus)
5507 return -ENOTTY;
5508
5509 mutex_lock(&pci_slot_mutex);
5510 if (list_empty(&bus->slots))
5511 goto bus_reset;
5512
5513 list_for_each_entry(slot, &bus->slots, list)
5514 if (pci_probe_reset_slot(slot))
5515 goto bus_reset;
5516
5517 list_for_each_entry(slot, &bus->slots, list)
5518 if (pci_slot_reset(slot, 0))
5519 goto bus_reset;
5520
5521 mutex_unlock(&pci_slot_mutex);
5522 return 0;
5523bus_reset:
5524 mutex_unlock(&pci_slot_mutex);
5525 return pci_bus_reset(bridge->subordinate, 0);
5526}
5527
5528/**
5529 * pci_probe_reset_bus - probe whether a PCI bus can be reset
5530 * @bus: PCI bus to probe
5531 *
5532 * Return 0 if bus can be reset, negative if a bus reset is not supported.
5533 */
5534int pci_probe_reset_bus(struct pci_bus *bus)
5535{
5536 return pci_bus_reset(bus, 1);
5537}
5538EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_probe_reset_bus);
5539
5540/**
5541 * __pci_reset_bus - Try to reset a PCI bus
5542 * @bus: top level PCI bus to reset
5543 *
5544 * Same as above except return -EAGAIN if the bus cannot be locked
5545 */
5546static int __pci_reset_bus(struct pci_bus *bus)
5547{
5548 int rc;
5549
5550 rc = pci_bus_reset(bus, 1);
5551 if (rc)
5552 return rc;
5553
5554 if (pci_bus_trylock(bus)) {
5555 pci_bus_save_and_disable_locked(bus);
5556 might_sleep();
5557 rc = pci_bridge_secondary_bus_reset(bus->self);
5558 pci_bus_restore_locked(bus);
5559 pci_bus_unlock(bus);
5560 } else
5561 rc = -EAGAIN;
5562
5563 return rc;
5564}
5565
5566/**
5567 * pci_reset_bus - Try to reset a PCI bus
5568 * @pdev: top level PCI device to reset via slot/bus
5569 *
5570 * Same as above except return -EAGAIN if the bus cannot be locked
5571 */
5572int pci_reset_bus(struct pci_dev *pdev)
5573{
5574 return (!pci_probe_reset_slot(pdev->slot)) ?
5575 __pci_reset_slot(pdev->slot) : __pci_reset_bus(pdev->bus);
5576}
5577EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_reset_bus);
5578
5579/**
5580 * pcix_get_max_mmrbc - get PCI-X maximum designed memory read byte count
5581 * @dev: PCI device to query
5582 *
5583 * Returns mmrbc: maximum designed memory read count in bytes or
5584 * appropriate error value.
5585 */
5586int pcix_get_max_mmrbc(struct pci_dev *dev)
5587{
5588 int cap;
5589 u32 stat;
5590
5591 cap = pci_find_capability(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_PCIX);
5592 if (!cap)
5593 return -EINVAL;
5594
5595 if (pci_read_config_dword(dev, cap + PCI_X_STATUS, &stat))
5596 return -EINVAL;
5597
5598 return 512 << ((stat & PCI_X_STATUS_MAX_READ) >> 21);
5599}
5600EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcix_get_max_mmrbc);
5601
5602/**
5603 * pcix_get_mmrbc - get PCI-X maximum memory read byte count
5604 * @dev: PCI device to query
5605 *
5606 * Returns mmrbc: maximum memory read count in bytes or appropriate error
5607 * value.
5608 */
5609int pcix_get_mmrbc(struct pci_dev *dev)
5610{
5611 int cap;
5612 u16 cmd;
5613
5614 cap = pci_find_capability(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_PCIX);
5615 if (!cap)
5616 return -EINVAL;
5617
5618 if (pci_read_config_word(dev, cap + PCI_X_CMD, &cmd))
5619 return -EINVAL;
5620
5621 return 512 << ((cmd & PCI_X_CMD_MAX_READ) >> 2);
5622}
5623EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcix_get_mmrbc);
5624
5625/**
5626 * pcix_set_mmrbc - set PCI-X maximum memory read byte count
5627 * @dev: PCI device to query
5628 * @mmrbc: maximum memory read count in bytes
5629 * valid values are 512, 1024, 2048, 4096
5630 *
5631 * If possible sets maximum memory read byte count, some bridges have errata
5632 * that prevent this.
5633 */
5634int pcix_set_mmrbc(struct pci_dev *dev, int mmrbc)
5635{
5636 int cap;
5637 u32 stat, v, o;
5638 u16 cmd;
5639
5640 if (mmrbc < 512 || mmrbc > 4096 || !is_power_of_2(mmrbc))
5641 return -EINVAL;
5642
5643 v = ffs(mmrbc) - 10;
5644
5645 cap = pci_find_capability(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_PCIX);
5646 if (!cap)
5647 return -EINVAL;
5648
5649 if (pci_read_config_dword(dev, cap + PCI_X_STATUS, &stat))
5650 return -EINVAL;
5651
5652 if (v > (stat & PCI_X_STATUS_MAX_READ) >> 21)
5653 return -E2BIG;
5654
5655 if (pci_read_config_word(dev, cap + PCI_X_CMD, &cmd))
5656 return -EINVAL;
5657
5658 o = (cmd & PCI_X_CMD_MAX_READ) >> 2;
5659 if (o != v) {
5660 if (v > o && (dev->bus->bus_flags & PCI_BUS_FLAGS_NO_MMRBC))
5661 return -EIO;
5662
5663 cmd &= ~PCI_X_CMD_MAX_READ;
5664 cmd |= v << 2;
5665 if (pci_write_config_word(dev, cap + PCI_X_CMD, cmd))
5666 return -EIO;
5667 }
5668 return 0;
5669}
5670EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcix_set_mmrbc);
5671
5672/**
5673 * pcie_get_readrq - get PCI Express read request size
5674 * @dev: PCI device to query
5675 *
5676 * Returns maximum memory read request in bytes or appropriate error value.
5677 */
5678int pcie_get_readrq(struct pci_dev *dev)
5679{
5680 u16 ctl;
5681
5682 pcie_capability_read_word(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL, &ctl);
5683
5684 return 128 << ((ctl & PCI_EXP_DEVCTL_READRQ) >> 12);
5685}
5686EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcie_get_readrq);
5687
5688/**
5689 * pcie_set_readrq - set PCI Express maximum memory read request
5690 * @dev: PCI device to query
5691 * @rq: maximum memory read count in bytes
5692 * valid values are 128, 256, 512, 1024, 2048, 4096
5693 *
5694 * If possible sets maximum memory read request in bytes
5695 */
5696int pcie_set_readrq(struct pci_dev *dev, int rq)
5697{
5698 u16 v;
5699 int ret;
5700
5701 if (rq < 128 || rq > 4096 || !is_power_of_2(rq))
5702 return -EINVAL;
5703
5704 /*
5705 * If using the "performance" PCIe config, we clamp the read rq
5706 * size to the max packet size to keep the host bridge from
5707 * generating requests larger than we can cope with.
5708 */
5709 if (pcie_bus_config == PCIE_BUS_PERFORMANCE) {
5710 int mps = pcie_get_mps(dev);
5711
5712 if (mps < rq)
5713 rq = mps;
5714 }
5715
5716 v = (ffs(rq) - 8) << 12;
5717
5718 ret = pcie_capability_clear_and_set_word(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL,
5719 PCI_EXP_DEVCTL_READRQ, v);
5720
5721 return pcibios_err_to_errno(ret);
5722}
5723EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcie_set_readrq);
5724
5725/**
5726 * pcie_get_mps - get PCI Express maximum payload size
5727 * @dev: PCI device to query
5728 *
5729 * Returns maximum payload size in bytes
5730 */
5731int pcie_get_mps(struct pci_dev *dev)
5732{
5733 u16 ctl;
5734
5735 pcie_capability_read_word(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL, &ctl);
5736
5737 return 128 << ((ctl & PCI_EXP_DEVCTL_PAYLOAD) >> 5);
5738}
5739EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcie_get_mps);
5740
5741/**
5742 * pcie_set_mps - set PCI Express maximum payload size
5743 * @dev: PCI device to query
5744 * @mps: maximum payload size in bytes
5745 * valid values are 128, 256, 512, 1024, 2048, 4096
5746 *
5747 * If possible sets maximum payload size
5748 */
5749int pcie_set_mps(struct pci_dev *dev, int mps)
5750{
5751 u16 v;
5752 int ret;
5753
5754 if (mps < 128 || mps > 4096 || !is_power_of_2(mps))
5755 return -EINVAL;
5756
5757 v = ffs(mps) - 8;
5758 if (v > dev->pcie_mpss)
5759 return -EINVAL;
5760 v <<= 5;
5761
5762 ret = pcie_capability_clear_and_set_word(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL,
5763 PCI_EXP_DEVCTL_PAYLOAD, v);
5764
5765 return pcibios_err_to_errno(ret);
5766}
5767EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcie_set_mps);
5768
5769/**
5770 * pcie_bandwidth_available - determine minimum link settings of a PCIe
5771 * device and its bandwidth limitation
5772 * @dev: PCI device to query
5773 * @limiting_dev: storage for device causing the bandwidth limitation
5774 * @speed: storage for speed of limiting device
5775 * @width: storage for width of limiting device
5776 *
5777 * Walk up the PCI device chain and find the point where the minimum
5778 * bandwidth is available. Return the bandwidth available there and (if
5779 * limiting_dev, speed, and width pointers are supplied) information about
5780 * that point. The bandwidth returned is in Mb/s, i.e., megabits/second of
5781 * raw bandwidth.
5782 */
5783u32 pcie_bandwidth_available(struct pci_dev *dev, struct pci_dev **limiting_dev,
5784 enum pci_bus_speed *speed,
5785 enum pcie_link_width *width)
5786{
5787 u16 lnksta;
5788 enum pci_bus_speed next_speed;
5789 enum pcie_link_width next_width;
5790 u32 bw, next_bw;
5791
5792 if (speed)
5793 *speed = PCI_SPEED_UNKNOWN;
5794 if (width)
5795 *width = PCIE_LNK_WIDTH_UNKNOWN;
5796
5797 bw = 0;
5798
5799 while (dev) {
5800 pcie_capability_read_word(dev, PCI_EXP_LNKSTA, &lnksta);
5801
5802 next_speed = pcie_link_speed[lnksta & PCI_EXP_LNKSTA_CLS];
5803 next_width = (lnksta & PCI_EXP_LNKSTA_NLW) >>
5804 PCI_EXP_LNKSTA_NLW_SHIFT;
5805
5806 next_bw = next_width * PCIE_SPEED2MBS_ENC(next_speed);
5807
5808 /* Check if current device limits the total bandwidth */
5809 if (!bw || next_bw <= bw) {
5810 bw = next_bw;
5811
5812 if (limiting_dev)
5813 *limiting_dev = dev;
5814 if (speed)
5815 *speed = next_speed;
5816 if (width)
5817 *width = next_width;
5818 }
5819
5820 dev = pci_upstream_bridge(dev);
5821 }
5822
5823 return bw;
5824}
5825EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcie_bandwidth_available);
5826
5827/**
5828 * pcie_get_speed_cap - query for the PCI device's link speed capability
5829 * @dev: PCI device to query
5830 *
5831 * Query the PCI device speed capability. Return the maximum link speed
5832 * supported by the device.
5833 */
5834enum pci_bus_speed pcie_get_speed_cap(struct pci_dev *dev)
5835{
5836 u32 lnkcap2, lnkcap;
5837
5838 /*
5839 * Link Capabilities 2 was added in PCIe r3.0, sec 7.8.18. The
5840 * implementation note there recommends using the Supported Link
5841 * Speeds Vector in Link Capabilities 2 when supported.
5842 *
5843 * Without Link Capabilities 2, i.e., prior to PCIe r3.0, software
5844 * should use the Supported Link Speeds field in Link Capabilities,
5845 * where only 2.5 GT/s and 5.0 GT/s speeds were defined.
5846 */
5847 pcie_capability_read_dword(dev, PCI_EXP_LNKCAP2, &lnkcap2);
5848
5849 /* PCIe r3.0-compliant */
5850 if (lnkcap2)
5851 return PCIE_LNKCAP2_SLS2SPEED(lnkcap2);
5852
5853 pcie_capability_read_dword(dev, PCI_EXP_LNKCAP, &lnkcap);
5854 if ((lnkcap & PCI_EXP_LNKCAP_SLS) == PCI_EXP_LNKCAP_SLS_5_0GB)
5855 return PCIE_SPEED_5_0GT;
5856 else if ((lnkcap & PCI_EXP_LNKCAP_SLS) == PCI_EXP_LNKCAP_SLS_2_5GB)
5857 return PCIE_SPEED_2_5GT;
5858
5859 return PCI_SPEED_UNKNOWN;
5860}
5861EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcie_get_speed_cap);
5862
5863/**
5864 * pcie_get_width_cap - query for the PCI device's link width capability
5865 * @dev: PCI device to query
5866 *
5867 * Query the PCI device width capability. Return the maximum link width
5868 * supported by the device.
5869 */
5870enum pcie_link_width pcie_get_width_cap(struct pci_dev *dev)
5871{
5872 u32 lnkcap;
5873
5874 pcie_capability_read_dword(dev, PCI_EXP_LNKCAP, &lnkcap);
5875 if (lnkcap)
5876 return (lnkcap & PCI_EXP_LNKCAP_MLW) >> 4;
5877
5878 return PCIE_LNK_WIDTH_UNKNOWN;
5879}
5880EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcie_get_width_cap);
5881
5882/**
5883 * pcie_bandwidth_capable - calculate a PCI device's link bandwidth capability
5884 * @dev: PCI device
5885 * @speed: storage for link speed
5886 * @width: storage for link width
5887 *
5888 * Calculate a PCI device's link bandwidth by querying for its link speed
5889 * and width, multiplying them, and applying encoding overhead. The result
5890 * is in Mb/s, i.e., megabits/second of raw bandwidth.
5891 */
5892u32 pcie_bandwidth_capable(struct pci_dev *dev, enum pci_bus_speed *speed,
5893 enum pcie_link_width *width)
5894{
5895 *speed = pcie_get_speed_cap(dev);
5896 *width = pcie_get_width_cap(dev);
5897
5898 if (*speed == PCI_SPEED_UNKNOWN || *width == PCIE_LNK_WIDTH_UNKNOWN)
5899 return 0;
5900
5901 return *width * PCIE_SPEED2MBS_ENC(*speed);
5902}
5903
5904/**
5905 * __pcie_print_link_status - Report the PCI device's link speed and width
5906 * @dev: PCI device to query
5907 * @verbose: Print info even when enough bandwidth is available
5908 *
5909 * If the available bandwidth at the device is less than the device is
5910 * capable of, report the device's maximum possible bandwidth and the
5911 * upstream link that limits its performance. If @verbose, always print
5912 * the available bandwidth, even if the device isn't constrained.
5913 */
5914void __pcie_print_link_status(struct pci_dev *dev, bool verbose)
5915{
5916 enum pcie_link_width width, width_cap;
5917 enum pci_bus_speed speed, speed_cap;
5918 struct pci_dev *limiting_dev = NULL;
5919 u32 bw_avail, bw_cap;
5920
5921 bw_cap = pcie_bandwidth_capable(dev, &speed_cap, &width_cap);
5922 bw_avail = pcie_bandwidth_available(dev, &limiting_dev, &speed, &width);
5923
5924 if (bw_avail >= bw_cap && verbose)
5925 pci_info(dev, "%u.%03u Gb/s available PCIe bandwidth (%s x%d link)\n",
5926 bw_cap / 1000, bw_cap % 1000,
5927 pci_speed_string(speed_cap), width_cap);
5928 else if (bw_avail < bw_cap)
5929 pci_info(dev, "%u.%03u Gb/s available PCIe bandwidth, limited by %s x%d link at %s (capable of %u.%03u Gb/s with %s x%d link)\n",
5930 bw_avail / 1000, bw_avail % 1000,
5931 pci_speed_string(speed), width,
5932 limiting_dev ? pci_name(limiting_dev) : "<unknown>",
5933 bw_cap / 1000, bw_cap % 1000,
5934 pci_speed_string(speed_cap), width_cap);
5935}
5936
5937/**
5938 * pcie_print_link_status - Report the PCI device's link speed and width
5939 * @dev: PCI device to query
5940 *
5941 * Report the available bandwidth at the device.
5942 */
5943void pcie_print_link_status(struct pci_dev *dev)
5944{
5945 __pcie_print_link_status(dev, true);
5946}
5947EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcie_print_link_status);
5948
5949/**
5950 * pci_select_bars - Make BAR mask from the type of resource
5951 * @dev: the PCI device for which BAR mask is made
5952 * @flags: resource type mask to be selected
5953 *
5954 * This helper routine makes bar mask from the type of resource.
5955 */
5956int pci_select_bars(struct pci_dev *dev, unsigned long flags)
5957{
5958 int i, bars = 0;
5959 for (i = 0; i < PCI_NUM_RESOURCES; i++)
5960 if (pci_resource_flags(dev, i) & flags)
5961 bars |= (1 << i);
5962 return bars;
5963}
5964EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_select_bars);
5965
5966/* Some architectures require additional programming to enable VGA */
5967static arch_set_vga_state_t arch_set_vga_state;
5968
5969void __init pci_register_set_vga_state(arch_set_vga_state_t func)
5970{
5971 arch_set_vga_state = func; /* NULL disables */
5972}
5973
5974static int pci_set_vga_state_arch(struct pci_dev *dev, bool decode,
5975 unsigned int command_bits, u32 flags)
5976{
5977 if (arch_set_vga_state)
5978 return arch_set_vga_state(dev, decode, command_bits,
5979 flags);
5980 return 0;
5981}
5982
5983/**
5984 * pci_set_vga_state - set VGA decode state on device and parents if requested
5985 * @dev: the PCI device
5986 * @decode: true = enable decoding, false = disable decoding
5987 * @command_bits: PCI_COMMAND_IO and/or PCI_COMMAND_MEMORY
5988 * @flags: traverse ancestors and change bridges
5989 * CHANGE_BRIDGE_ONLY / CHANGE_BRIDGE
5990 */
5991int pci_set_vga_state(struct pci_dev *dev, bool decode,
5992 unsigned int command_bits, u32 flags)
5993{
5994 struct pci_bus *bus;
5995 struct pci_dev *bridge;
5996 u16 cmd;
5997 int rc;
5998
5999 WARN_ON((flags & PCI_VGA_STATE_CHANGE_DECODES) && (command_bits & ~(PCI_COMMAND_IO|PCI_COMMAND_MEMORY)));
6000
6001 /* ARCH specific VGA enables */
6002 rc = pci_set_vga_state_arch(dev, decode, command_bits, flags);
6003 if (rc)
6004 return rc;
6005
6006 if (flags & PCI_VGA_STATE_CHANGE_DECODES) {
6007 pci_read_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, &cmd);
6008 if (decode == true)
6009 cmd |= command_bits;
6010 else
6011 cmd &= ~command_bits;
6012 pci_write_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, cmd);
6013 }
6014
6015 if (!(flags & PCI_VGA_STATE_CHANGE_BRIDGE))
6016 return 0;
6017
6018 bus = dev->bus;
6019 while (bus) {
6020 bridge = bus->self;
6021 if (bridge) {
6022 pci_read_config_word(bridge, PCI_BRIDGE_CONTROL,
6023 &cmd);
6024 if (decode == true)
6025 cmd |= PCI_BRIDGE_CTL_VGA;
6026 else
6027 cmd &= ~PCI_BRIDGE_CTL_VGA;
6028 pci_write_config_word(bridge, PCI_BRIDGE_CONTROL,
6029 cmd);
6030 }
6031 bus = bus->parent;
6032 }
6033 return 0;
6034}
6035
6036#ifdef CONFIG_ACPI
6037bool pci_pr3_present(struct pci_dev *pdev)
6038{
6039 struct acpi_device *adev;
6040
6041 if (acpi_disabled)
6042 return false;
6043
6044 adev = ACPI_COMPANION(&pdev->dev);
6045 if (!adev)
6046 return false;
6047
6048 return adev->power.flags.power_resources &&
6049 acpi_has_method(adev->handle, "_PR3");
6050}
6051EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_pr3_present);
6052#endif
6053
6054/**
6055 * pci_add_dma_alias - Add a DMA devfn alias for a device
6056 * @dev: the PCI device for which alias is added
6057 * @devfn_from: alias slot and function
6058 * @nr_devfns: number of subsequent devfns to alias
6059 *
6060 * This helper encodes an 8-bit devfn as a bit number in dma_alias_mask
6061 * which is used to program permissible bus-devfn source addresses for DMA
6062 * requests in an IOMMU. These aliases factor into IOMMU group creation
6063 * and are useful for devices generating DMA requests beyond or different
6064 * from their logical bus-devfn. Examples include device quirks where the
6065 * device simply uses the wrong devfn, as well as non-transparent bridges
6066 * where the alias may be a proxy for devices in another domain.
6067 *
6068 * IOMMU group creation is performed during device discovery or addition,
6069 * prior to any potential DMA mapping and therefore prior to driver probing
6070 * (especially for userspace assigned devices where IOMMU group definition
6071 * cannot be left as a userspace activity). DMA aliases should therefore
6072 * be configured via quirks, such as the PCI fixup header quirk.
6073 */
6074void pci_add_dma_alias(struct pci_dev *dev, u8 devfn_from, unsigned nr_devfns)
6075{
6076 int devfn_to;
6077
6078 nr_devfns = min(nr_devfns, (unsigned) MAX_NR_DEVFNS - devfn_from);
6079 devfn_to = devfn_from + nr_devfns - 1;
6080
6081 if (!dev->dma_alias_mask)
6082 dev->dma_alias_mask = bitmap_zalloc(MAX_NR_DEVFNS, GFP_KERNEL);
6083 if (!dev->dma_alias_mask) {
6084 pci_warn(dev, "Unable to allocate DMA alias mask\n");
6085 return;
6086 }
6087
6088 bitmap_set(dev->dma_alias_mask, devfn_from, nr_devfns);
6089
6090 if (nr_devfns == 1)
6091 pci_info(dev, "Enabling fixed DMA alias to %02x.%d\n",
6092 PCI_SLOT(devfn_from), PCI_FUNC(devfn_from));
6093 else if (nr_devfns > 1)
6094 pci_info(dev, "Enabling fixed DMA alias for devfn range from %02x.%d to %02x.%d\n",
6095 PCI_SLOT(devfn_from), PCI_FUNC(devfn_from),
6096 PCI_SLOT(devfn_to), PCI_FUNC(devfn_to));
6097}
6098
6099bool pci_devs_are_dma_aliases(struct pci_dev *dev1, struct pci_dev *dev2)
6100{
6101 return (dev1->dma_alias_mask &&
6102 test_bit(dev2->devfn, dev1->dma_alias_mask)) ||
6103 (dev2->dma_alias_mask &&
6104 test_bit(dev1->devfn, dev2->dma_alias_mask)) ||
6105 pci_real_dma_dev(dev1) == dev2 ||
6106 pci_real_dma_dev(dev2) == dev1;
6107}
6108
6109bool pci_device_is_present(struct pci_dev *pdev)
6110{
6111 u32 v;
6112
6113 if (pci_dev_is_disconnected(pdev))
6114 return false;
6115 return pci_bus_read_dev_vendor_id(pdev->bus, pdev->devfn, &v, 0);
6116}
6117EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_device_is_present);
6118
6119void pci_ignore_hotplug(struct pci_dev *dev)
6120{
6121 struct pci_dev *bridge = dev->bus->self;
6122
6123 dev->ignore_hotplug = 1;
6124 /* Propagate the "ignore hotplug" setting to the parent bridge. */
6125 if (bridge)
6126 bridge->ignore_hotplug = 1;
6127}
6128EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_ignore_hotplug);
6129
6130/**
6131 * pci_real_dma_dev - Get PCI DMA device for PCI device
6132 * @dev: the PCI device that may have a PCI DMA alias
6133 *
6134 * Permits the platform to provide architecture-specific functionality to
6135 * devices needing to alias DMA to another PCI device on another PCI bus. If
6136 * the PCI device is on the same bus, it is recommended to use
6137 * pci_add_dma_alias(). This is the default implementation. Architecture
6138 * implementations can override this.
6139 */
6140struct pci_dev __weak *pci_real_dma_dev(struct pci_dev *dev)
6141{
6142 return dev;
6143}
6144
6145resource_size_t __weak pcibios_default_alignment(void)
6146{
6147 return 0;
6148}
6149
6150/*
6151 * Arches that don't want to expose struct resource to userland as-is in
6152 * sysfs and /proc can implement their own pci_resource_to_user().
6153 */
6154void __weak pci_resource_to_user(const struct pci_dev *dev, int bar,
6155 const struct resource *rsrc,
6156 resource_size_t *start, resource_size_t *end)
6157{
6158 *start = rsrc->start;
6159 *end = rsrc->end;
6160}
6161
6162static char *resource_alignment_param;
6163static DEFINE_SPINLOCK(resource_alignment_lock);
6164
6165/**
6166 * pci_specified_resource_alignment - get resource alignment specified by user.
6167 * @dev: the PCI device to get
6168 * @resize: whether or not to change resources' size when reassigning alignment
6169 *
6170 * RETURNS: Resource alignment if it is specified.
6171 * Zero if it is not specified.
6172 */
6173static resource_size_t pci_specified_resource_alignment(struct pci_dev *dev,
6174 bool *resize)
6175{
6176 int align_order, count;
6177 resource_size_t align = pcibios_default_alignment();
6178 const char *p;
6179 int ret;
6180
6181 spin_lock(&resource_alignment_lock);
6182 p = resource_alignment_param;
6183 if (!p || !*p)
6184 goto out;
6185 if (pci_has_flag(PCI_PROBE_ONLY)) {
6186 align = 0;
6187 pr_info_once("PCI: Ignoring requested alignments (PCI_PROBE_ONLY)\n");
6188 goto out;
6189 }
6190
6191 while (*p) {
6192 count = 0;
6193 if (sscanf(p, "%d%n", &align_order, &count) == 1 &&
6194 p[count] == '@') {
6195 p += count + 1;
6196 } else {
6197 align_order = -1;
6198 }
6199
6200 ret = pci_dev_str_match(dev, p, &p);
6201 if (ret == 1) {
6202 *resize = true;
6203 if (align_order == -1)
6204 align = PAGE_SIZE;
6205 else
6206 align = 1 << align_order;
6207 break;
6208 } else if (ret < 0) {
6209 pr_err("PCI: Can't parse resource_alignment parameter: %s\n",
6210 p);
6211 break;
6212 }
6213
6214 if (*p != ';' && *p != ',') {
6215 /* End of param or invalid format */
6216 break;
6217 }
6218 p++;
6219 }
6220out:
6221 spin_unlock(&resource_alignment_lock);
6222 return align;
6223}
6224
6225static void pci_request_resource_alignment(struct pci_dev *dev, int bar,
6226 resource_size_t align, bool resize)
6227{
6228 struct resource *r = &dev->resource[bar];
6229 resource_size_t size;
6230
6231 if (!(r->flags & IORESOURCE_MEM))
6232 return;
6233
6234 if (r->flags & IORESOURCE_PCI_FIXED) {
6235 pci_info(dev, "BAR%d %pR: ignoring requested alignment %#llx\n",
6236 bar, r, (unsigned long long)align);
6237 return;
6238 }
6239
6240 size = resource_size(r);
6241 if (size >= align)
6242 return;
6243
6244 /*
6245 * Increase the alignment of the resource. There are two ways we
6246 * can do this:
6247 *
6248 * 1) Increase the size of the resource. BARs are aligned on their
6249 * size, so when we reallocate space for this resource, we'll
6250 * allocate it with the larger alignment. This also prevents
6251 * assignment of any other BARs inside the alignment region, so
6252 * if we're requesting page alignment, this means no other BARs
6253 * will share the page.
6254 *
6255 * The disadvantage is that this makes the resource larger than
6256 * the hardware BAR, which may break drivers that compute things
6257 * based on the resource size, e.g., to find registers at a
6258 * fixed offset before the end of the BAR.
6259 *
6260 * 2) Retain the resource size, but use IORESOURCE_STARTALIGN and
6261 * set r->start to the desired alignment. By itself this
6262 * doesn't prevent other BARs being put inside the alignment
6263 * region, but if we realign *every* resource of every device in
6264 * the system, none of them will share an alignment region.
6265 *
6266 * When the user has requested alignment for only some devices via
6267 * the "pci=resource_alignment" argument, "resize" is true and we
6268 * use the first method. Otherwise we assume we're aligning all
6269 * devices and we use the second.
6270 */
6271
6272 pci_info(dev, "BAR%d %pR: requesting alignment to %#llx\n",
6273 bar, r, (unsigned long long)align);
6274
6275 if (resize) {
6276 r->start = 0;
6277 r->end = align - 1;
6278 } else {
6279 r->flags &= ~IORESOURCE_SIZEALIGN;
6280 r->flags |= IORESOURCE_STARTALIGN;
6281 r->start = align;
6282 r->end = r->start + size - 1;
6283 }
6284 r->flags |= IORESOURCE_UNSET;
6285}
6286
6287/*
6288 * This function disables memory decoding and releases memory resources
6289 * of the device specified by kernel's boot parameter 'pci=resource_alignment='.
6290 * It also rounds up size to specified alignment.
6291 * Later on, the kernel will assign page-aligned memory resource back
6292 * to the device.
6293 */
6294void pci_reassigndev_resource_alignment(struct pci_dev *dev)
6295{
6296 int i;
6297 struct resource *r;
6298 resource_size_t align;
6299 u16 command;
6300 bool resize = false;
6301
6302 /*
6303 * VF BARs are read-only zero according to SR-IOV spec r1.1, sec
6304 * 3.4.1.11. Their resources are allocated from the space
6305 * described by the VF BARx register in the PF's SR-IOV capability.
6306 * We can't influence their alignment here.
6307 */
6308 if (dev->is_virtfn)
6309 return;
6310
6311 /* check if specified PCI is target device to reassign */
6312 align = pci_specified_resource_alignment(dev, &resize);
6313 if (!align)
6314 return;
6315
6316 if (dev->hdr_type == PCI_HEADER_TYPE_NORMAL &&
6317 (dev->class >> 8) == PCI_CLASS_BRIDGE_HOST) {
6318 pci_warn(dev, "Can't reassign resources to host bridge\n");
6319 return;
6320 }
6321
6322 pci_read_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, &command);
6323 command &= ~PCI_COMMAND_MEMORY;
6324 pci_write_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, command);
6325
6326 for (i = 0; i <= PCI_ROM_RESOURCE; i++)
6327 pci_request_resource_alignment(dev, i, align, resize);
6328
6329 /*
6330 * Need to disable bridge's resource window,
6331 * to enable the kernel to reassign new resource
6332 * window later on.
6333 */
6334 if (dev->hdr_type == PCI_HEADER_TYPE_BRIDGE) {
6335 for (i = PCI_BRIDGE_RESOURCES; i < PCI_NUM_RESOURCES; i++) {
6336 r = &dev->resource[i];
6337 if (!(r->flags & IORESOURCE_MEM))
6338 continue;
6339 r->flags |= IORESOURCE_UNSET;
6340 r->end = resource_size(r) - 1;
6341 r->start = 0;
6342 }
6343 pci_disable_bridge_window(dev);
6344 }
6345}
6346
6347static ssize_t resource_alignment_show(struct bus_type *bus, char *buf)
6348{
6349 size_t count = 0;
6350
6351 spin_lock(&resource_alignment_lock);
6352 if (resource_alignment_param)
6353 count = snprintf(buf, PAGE_SIZE, "%s", resource_alignment_param);
6354 spin_unlock(&resource_alignment_lock);
6355
6356 /*
6357 * When set by the command line, resource_alignment_param will not
6358 * have a trailing line feed, which is ugly. So conditionally add
6359 * it here.
6360 */
6361 if (count >= 2 && buf[count - 2] != '\n' && count < PAGE_SIZE - 1) {
6362 buf[count - 1] = '\n';
6363 buf[count++] = 0;
6364 }
6365
6366 return count;
6367}
6368
6369static ssize_t resource_alignment_store(struct bus_type *bus,
6370 const char *buf, size_t count)
6371{
6372 char *param = kstrndup(buf, count, GFP_KERNEL);
6373
6374 if (!param)
6375 return -ENOMEM;
6376
6377 spin_lock(&resource_alignment_lock);
6378 kfree(resource_alignment_param);
6379 resource_alignment_param = param;
6380 spin_unlock(&resource_alignment_lock);
6381 return count;
6382}
6383
6384static BUS_ATTR_RW(resource_alignment);
6385
6386static int __init pci_resource_alignment_sysfs_init(void)
6387{
6388 return bus_create_file(&pci_bus_type,
6389 &bus_attr_resource_alignment);
6390}
6391late_initcall(pci_resource_alignment_sysfs_init);
6392
6393static void pci_no_domains(void)
6394{
6395#ifdef CONFIG_PCI_DOMAINS
6396 pci_domains_supported = 0;
6397#endif
6398}
6399
6400#ifdef CONFIG_PCI_DOMAINS_GENERIC
6401static atomic_t __domain_nr = ATOMIC_INIT(-1);
6402
6403static int pci_get_new_domain_nr(void)
6404{
6405 return atomic_inc_return(&__domain_nr);
6406}
6407
6408static int of_pci_bus_find_domain_nr(struct device *parent)
6409{
6410 static int use_dt_domains = -1;
6411 int domain = -1;
6412
6413 if (parent)
6414 domain = of_get_pci_domain_nr(parent->of_node);
6415
6416 /*
6417 * Check DT domain and use_dt_domains values.
6418 *
6419 * If DT domain property is valid (domain >= 0) and
6420 * use_dt_domains != 0, the DT assignment is valid since this means
6421 * we have not previously allocated a domain number by using
6422 * pci_get_new_domain_nr(); we should also update use_dt_domains to
6423 * 1, to indicate that we have just assigned a domain number from
6424 * DT.
6425 *
6426 * If DT domain property value is not valid (ie domain < 0), and we
6427 * have not previously assigned a domain number from DT
6428 * (use_dt_domains != 1) we should assign a domain number by
6429 * using the:
6430 *
6431 * pci_get_new_domain_nr()
6432 *
6433 * API and update the use_dt_domains value to keep track of method we
6434 * are using to assign domain numbers (use_dt_domains = 0).
6435 *
6436 * All other combinations imply we have a platform that is trying
6437 * to mix domain numbers obtained from DT and pci_get_new_domain_nr(),
6438 * which is a recipe for domain mishandling and it is prevented by
6439 * invalidating the domain value (domain = -1) and printing a
6440 * corresponding error.
6441 */
6442 if (domain >= 0 && use_dt_domains) {
6443 use_dt_domains = 1;
6444 } else if (domain < 0 && use_dt_domains != 1) {
6445 use_dt_domains = 0;
6446 domain = pci_get_new_domain_nr();
6447 } else {
6448 if (parent)
6449 pr_err("Node %pOF has ", parent->of_node);
6450 pr_err("Inconsistent \"linux,pci-domain\" property in DT\n");
6451 domain = -1;
6452 }
6453
6454 return domain;
6455}
6456
6457int pci_bus_find_domain_nr(struct pci_bus *bus, struct device *parent)
6458{
6459 return acpi_disabled ? of_pci_bus_find_domain_nr(parent) :
6460 acpi_pci_bus_find_domain_nr(bus);
6461}
6462#endif
6463
6464/**
6465 * pci_ext_cfg_avail - can we access extended PCI config space?
6466 *
6467 * Returns 1 if we can access PCI extended config space (offsets
6468 * greater than 0xff). This is the default implementation. Architecture
6469 * implementations can override this.
6470 */
6471int __weak pci_ext_cfg_avail(void)
6472{
6473 return 1;
6474}
6475
6476void __weak pci_fixup_cardbus(struct pci_bus *bus)
6477{
6478}
6479EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_fixup_cardbus);
6480
6481static int __init pci_setup(char *str)
6482{
6483 while (str) {
6484 char *k = strchr(str, ',');
6485 if (k)
6486 *k++ = 0;
6487 if (*str && (str = pcibios_setup(str)) && *str) {
6488 if (!strcmp(str, "nomsi")) {
6489 pci_no_msi();
6490 } else if (!strncmp(str, "noats", 5)) {
6491 pr_info("PCIe: ATS is disabled\n");
6492 pcie_ats_disabled = true;
6493 } else if (!strcmp(str, "noaer")) {
6494 pci_no_aer();
6495 } else if (!strcmp(str, "earlydump")) {
6496 pci_early_dump = true;
6497 } else if (!strncmp(str, "realloc=", 8)) {
6498 pci_realloc_get_opt(str + 8);
6499 } else if (!strncmp(str, "realloc", 7)) {
6500 pci_realloc_get_opt("on");
6501 } else if (!strcmp(str, "nodomains")) {
6502 pci_no_domains();
6503 } else if (!strncmp(str, "noari", 5)) {
6504 pcie_ari_disabled = true;
6505 } else if (!strncmp(str, "cbiosize=", 9)) {
6506 pci_cardbus_io_size = memparse(str + 9, &str);
6507 } else if (!strncmp(str, "cbmemsize=", 10)) {
6508 pci_cardbus_mem_size = memparse(str + 10, &str);
6509 } else if (!strncmp(str, "resource_alignment=", 19)) {
6510 resource_alignment_param = str + 19;
6511 } else if (!strncmp(str, "ecrc=", 5)) {
6512 pcie_ecrc_get_policy(str + 5);
6513 } else if (!strncmp(str, "hpiosize=", 9)) {
6514 pci_hotplug_io_size = memparse(str + 9, &str);
6515 } else if (!strncmp(str, "hpmmiosize=", 11)) {
6516 pci_hotplug_mmio_size = memparse(str + 11, &str);
6517 } else if (!strncmp(str, "hpmmioprefsize=", 15)) {
6518 pci_hotplug_mmio_pref_size = memparse(str + 15, &str);
6519 } else if (!strncmp(str, "hpmemsize=", 10)) {
6520 pci_hotplug_mmio_size = memparse(str + 10, &str);
6521 pci_hotplug_mmio_pref_size = pci_hotplug_mmio_size;
6522 } else if (!strncmp(str, "hpbussize=", 10)) {
6523 pci_hotplug_bus_size =
6524 simple_strtoul(str + 10, &str, 0);
6525 if (pci_hotplug_bus_size > 0xff)
6526 pci_hotplug_bus_size = DEFAULT_HOTPLUG_BUS_SIZE;
6527 } else if (!strncmp(str, "pcie_bus_tune_off", 17)) {
6528 pcie_bus_config = PCIE_BUS_TUNE_OFF;
6529 } else if (!strncmp(str, "pcie_bus_safe", 13)) {
6530 pcie_bus_config = PCIE_BUS_SAFE;
6531 } else if (!strncmp(str, "pcie_bus_perf", 13)) {
6532 pcie_bus_config = PCIE_BUS_PERFORMANCE;
6533 } else if (!strncmp(str, "pcie_bus_peer2peer", 18)) {
6534 pcie_bus_config = PCIE_BUS_PEER2PEER;
6535 } else if (!strncmp(str, "pcie_scan_all", 13)) {
6536 pci_add_flags(PCI_SCAN_ALL_PCIE_DEVS);
6537 } else if (!strncmp(str, "disable_acs_redir=", 18)) {
6538 disable_acs_redir_param = str + 18;
6539 } else {
6540 pr_err("PCI: Unknown option `%s'\n", str);
6541 }
6542 }
6543 str = k;
6544 }
6545 return 0;
6546}
6547early_param("pci", pci_setup);
6548
6549/*
6550 * 'resource_alignment_param' and 'disable_acs_redir_param' are initialized
6551 * in pci_setup(), above, to point to data in the __initdata section which
6552 * will be freed after the init sequence is complete. We can't allocate memory
6553 * in pci_setup() because some architectures do not have any memory allocation
6554 * service available during an early_param() call. So we allocate memory and
6555 * copy the variable here before the init section is freed.
6556 *
6557 */
6558static int __init pci_realloc_setup_params(void)
6559{
6560 resource_alignment_param = kstrdup(resource_alignment_param,
6561 GFP_KERNEL);
6562 disable_acs_redir_param = kstrdup(disable_acs_redir_param, GFP_KERNEL);
6563
6564 return 0;
6565}
6566pure_initcall(pci_realloc_setup_params);
1// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0
2/*
3 * PCI Bus Services, see include/linux/pci.h for further explanation.
4 *
5 * Copyright 1993 -- 1997 Drew Eckhardt, Frederic Potter,
6 * David Mosberger-Tang
7 *
8 * Copyright 1997 -- 2000 Martin Mares <mj@ucw.cz>
9 */
10
11#include <linux/acpi.h>
12#include <linux/kernel.h>
13#include <linux/delay.h>
14#include <linux/dmi.h>
15#include <linux/init.h>
16#include <linux/of.h>
17#include <linux/of_pci.h>
18#include <linux/pci.h>
19#include <linux/pm.h>
20#include <linux/slab.h>
21#include <linux/module.h>
22#include <linux/spinlock.h>
23#include <linux/string.h>
24#include <linux/log2.h>
25#include <linux/logic_pio.h>
26#include <linux/pci-aspm.h>
27#include <linux/pm_wakeup.h>
28#include <linux/interrupt.h>
29#include <linux/device.h>
30#include <linux/pm_runtime.h>
31#include <linux/pci_hotplug.h>
32#include <linux/vmalloc.h>
33#include <linux/pci-ats.h>
34#include <asm/setup.h>
35#include <asm/dma.h>
36#include <linux/aer.h>
37#include "pci.h"
38
39const char *pci_power_names[] = {
40 "error", "D0", "D1", "D2", "D3hot", "D3cold", "unknown",
41};
42EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_power_names);
43
44int isa_dma_bridge_buggy;
45EXPORT_SYMBOL(isa_dma_bridge_buggy);
46
47int pci_pci_problems;
48EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_pci_problems);
49
50unsigned int pci_pm_d3_delay;
51
52static void pci_pme_list_scan(struct work_struct *work);
53
54static LIST_HEAD(pci_pme_list);
55static DEFINE_MUTEX(pci_pme_list_mutex);
56static DECLARE_DELAYED_WORK(pci_pme_work, pci_pme_list_scan);
57
58struct pci_pme_device {
59 struct list_head list;
60 struct pci_dev *dev;
61};
62
63#define PME_TIMEOUT 1000 /* How long between PME checks */
64
65static void pci_dev_d3_sleep(struct pci_dev *dev)
66{
67 unsigned int delay = dev->d3_delay;
68
69 if (delay < pci_pm_d3_delay)
70 delay = pci_pm_d3_delay;
71
72 if (delay)
73 msleep(delay);
74}
75
76#ifdef CONFIG_PCI_DOMAINS
77int pci_domains_supported = 1;
78#endif
79
80#define DEFAULT_CARDBUS_IO_SIZE (256)
81#define DEFAULT_CARDBUS_MEM_SIZE (64*1024*1024)
82/* pci=cbmemsize=nnM,cbiosize=nn can override this */
83unsigned long pci_cardbus_io_size = DEFAULT_CARDBUS_IO_SIZE;
84unsigned long pci_cardbus_mem_size = DEFAULT_CARDBUS_MEM_SIZE;
85
86#define DEFAULT_HOTPLUG_IO_SIZE (256)
87#define DEFAULT_HOTPLUG_MEM_SIZE (2*1024*1024)
88/* pci=hpmemsize=nnM,hpiosize=nn can override this */
89unsigned long pci_hotplug_io_size = DEFAULT_HOTPLUG_IO_SIZE;
90unsigned long pci_hotplug_mem_size = DEFAULT_HOTPLUG_MEM_SIZE;
91
92#define DEFAULT_HOTPLUG_BUS_SIZE 1
93unsigned long pci_hotplug_bus_size = DEFAULT_HOTPLUG_BUS_SIZE;
94
95enum pcie_bus_config_types pcie_bus_config = PCIE_BUS_DEFAULT;
96
97/*
98 * The default CLS is used if arch didn't set CLS explicitly and not
99 * all pci devices agree on the same value. Arch can override either
100 * the dfl or actual value as it sees fit. Don't forget this is
101 * measured in 32-bit words, not bytes.
102 */
103u8 pci_dfl_cache_line_size = L1_CACHE_BYTES >> 2;
104u8 pci_cache_line_size;
105
106/*
107 * If we set up a device for bus mastering, we need to check the latency
108 * timer as certain BIOSes forget to set it properly.
109 */
110unsigned int pcibios_max_latency = 255;
111
112/* If set, the PCIe ARI capability will not be used. */
113static bool pcie_ari_disabled;
114
115/* Disable bridge_d3 for all PCIe ports */
116static bool pci_bridge_d3_disable;
117/* Force bridge_d3 for all PCIe ports */
118static bool pci_bridge_d3_force;
119
120static int __init pcie_port_pm_setup(char *str)
121{
122 if (!strcmp(str, "off"))
123 pci_bridge_d3_disable = true;
124 else if (!strcmp(str, "force"))
125 pci_bridge_d3_force = true;
126 return 1;
127}
128__setup("pcie_port_pm=", pcie_port_pm_setup);
129
130/* Time to wait after a reset for device to become responsive */
131#define PCIE_RESET_READY_POLL_MS 60000
132
133/**
134 * pci_bus_max_busnr - returns maximum PCI bus number of given bus' children
135 * @bus: pointer to PCI bus structure to search
136 *
137 * Given a PCI bus, returns the highest PCI bus number present in the set
138 * including the given PCI bus and its list of child PCI buses.
139 */
140unsigned char pci_bus_max_busnr(struct pci_bus *bus)
141{
142 struct pci_bus *tmp;
143 unsigned char max, n;
144
145 max = bus->busn_res.end;
146 list_for_each_entry(tmp, &bus->children, node) {
147 n = pci_bus_max_busnr(tmp);
148 if (n > max)
149 max = n;
150 }
151 return max;
152}
153EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_bus_max_busnr);
154
155#ifdef CONFIG_HAS_IOMEM
156void __iomem *pci_ioremap_bar(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bar)
157{
158 struct resource *res = &pdev->resource[bar];
159
160 /*
161 * Make sure the BAR is actually a memory resource, not an IO resource
162 */
163 if (res->flags & IORESOURCE_UNSET || !(res->flags & IORESOURCE_MEM)) {
164 pci_warn(pdev, "can't ioremap BAR %d: %pR\n", bar, res);
165 return NULL;
166 }
167 return ioremap_nocache(res->start, resource_size(res));
168}
169EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_ioremap_bar);
170
171void __iomem *pci_ioremap_wc_bar(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bar)
172{
173 /*
174 * Make sure the BAR is actually a memory resource, not an IO resource
175 */
176 if (!(pci_resource_flags(pdev, bar) & IORESOURCE_MEM)) {
177 WARN_ON(1);
178 return NULL;
179 }
180 return ioremap_wc(pci_resource_start(pdev, bar),
181 pci_resource_len(pdev, bar));
182}
183EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_ioremap_wc_bar);
184#endif
185
186
187static int __pci_find_next_cap_ttl(struct pci_bus *bus, unsigned int devfn,
188 u8 pos, int cap, int *ttl)
189{
190 u8 id;
191 u16 ent;
192
193 pci_bus_read_config_byte(bus, devfn, pos, &pos);
194
195 while ((*ttl)--) {
196 if (pos < 0x40)
197 break;
198 pos &= ~3;
199 pci_bus_read_config_word(bus, devfn, pos, &ent);
200
201 id = ent & 0xff;
202 if (id == 0xff)
203 break;
204 if (id == cap)
205 return pos;
206 pos = (ent >> 8);
207 }
208 return 0;
209}
210
211static int __pci_find_next_cap(struct pci_bus *bus, unsigned int devfn,
212 u8 pos, int cap)
213{
214 int ttl = PCI_FIND_CAP_TTL;
215
216 return __pci_find_next_cap_ttl(bus, devfn, pos, cap, &ttl);
217}
218
219int pci_find_next_capability(struct pci_dev *dev, u8 pos, int cap)
220{
221 return __pci_find_next_cap(dev->bus, dev->devfn,
222 pos + PCI_CAP_LIST_NEXT, cap);
223}
224EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_find_next_capability);
225
226static int __pci_bus_find_cap_start(struct pci_bus *bus,
227 unsigned int devfn, u8 hdr_type)
228{
229 u16 status;
230
231 pci_bus_read_config_word(bus, devfn, PCI_STATUS, &status);
232 if (!(status & PCI_STATUS_CAP_LIST))
233 return 0;
234
235 switch (hdr_type) {
236 case PCI_HEADER_TYPE_NORMAL:
237 case PCI_HEADER_TYPE_BRIDGE:
238 return PCI_CAPABILITY_LIST;
239 case PCI_HEADER_TYPE_CARDBUS:
240 return PCI_CB_CAPABILITY_LIST;
241 }
242
243 return 0;
244}
245
246/**
247 * pci_find_capability - query for devices' capabilities
248 * @dev: PCI device to query
249 * @cap: capability code
250 *
251 * Tell if a device supports a given PCI capability.
252 * Returns the address of the requested capability structure within the
253 * device's PCI configuration space or 0 in case the device does not
254 * support it. Possible values for @cap:
255 *
256 * %PCI_CAP_ID_PM Power Management
257 * %PCI_CAP_ID_AGP Accelerated Graphics Port
258 * %PCI_CAP_ID_VPD Vital Product Data
259 * %PCI_CAP_ID_SLOTID Slot Identification
260 * %PCI_CAP_ID_MSI Message Signalled Interrupts
261 * %PCI_CAP_ID_CHSWP CompactPCI HotSwap
262 * %PCI_CAP_ID_PCIX PCI-X
263 * %PCI_CAP_ID_EXP PCI Express
264 */
265int pci_find_capability(struct pci_dev *dev, int cap)
266{
267 int pos;
268
269 pos = __pci_bus_find_cap_start(dev->bus, dev->devfn, dev->hdr_type);
270 if (pos)
271 pos = __pci_find_next_cap(dev->bus, dev->devfn, pos, cap);
272
273 return pos;
274}
275EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_find_capability);
276
277/**
278 * pci_bus_find_capability - query for devices' capabilities
279 * @bus: the PCI bus to query
280 * @devfn: PCI device to query
281 * @cap: capability code
282 *
283 * Like pci_find_capability() but works for pci devices that do not have a
284 * pci_dev structure set up yet.
285 *
286 * Returns the address of the requested capability structure within the
287 * device's PCI configuration space or 0 in case the device does not
288 * support it.
289 */
290int pci_bus_find_capability(struct pci_bus *bus, unsigned int devfn, int cap)
291{
292 int pos;
293 u8 hdr_type;
294
295 pci_bus_read_config_byte(bus, devfn, PCI_HEADER_TYPE, &hdr_type);
296
297 pos = __pci_bus_find_cap_start(bus, devfn, hdr_type & 0x7f);
298 if (pos)
299 pos = __pci_find_next_cap(bus, devfn, pos, cap);
300
301 return pos;
302}
303EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_bus_find_capability);
304
305/**
306 * pci_find_next_ext_capability - Find an extended capability
307 * @dev: PCI device to query
308 * @start: address at which to start looking (0 to start at beginning of list)
309 * @cap: capability code
310 *
311 * Returns the address of the next matching extended capability structure
312 * within the device's PCI configuration space or 0 if the device does
313 * not support it. Some capabilities can occur several times, e.g., the
314 * vendor-specific capability, and this provides a way to find them all.
315 */
316int pci_find_next_ext_capability(struct pci_dev *dev, int start, int cap)
317{
318 u32 header;
319 int ttl;
320 int pos = PCI_CFG_SPACE_SIZE;
321
322 /* minimum 8 bytes per capability */
323 ttl = (PCI_CFG_SPACE_EXP_SIZE - PCI_CFG_SPACE_SIZE) / 8;
324
325 if (dev->cfg_size <= PCI_CFG_SPACE_SIZE)
326 return 0;
327
328 if (start)
329 pos = start;
330
331 if (pci_read_config_dword(dev, pos, &header) != PCIBIOS_SUCCESSFUL)
332 return 0;
333
334 /*
335 * If we have no capabilities, this is indicated by cap ID,
336 * cap version and next pointer all being 0.
337 */
338 if (header == 0)
339 return 0;
340
341 while (ttl-- > 0) {
342 if (PCI_EXT_CAP_ID(header) == cap && pos != start)
343 return pos;
344
345 pos = PCI_EXT_CAP_NEXT(header);
346 if (pos < PCI_CFG_SPACE_SIZE)
347 break;
348
349 if (pci_read_config_dword(dev, pos, &header) != PCIBIOS_SUCCESSFUL)
350 break;
351 }
352
353 return 0;
354}
355EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_find_next_ext_capability);
356
357/**
358 * pci_find_ext_capability - Find an extended capability
359 * @dev: PCI device to query
360 * @cap: capability code
361 *
362 * Returns the address of the requested extended capability structure
363 * within the device's PCI configuration space or 0 if the device does
364 * not support it. Possible values for @cap:
365 *
366 * %PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_ERR Advanced Error Reporting
367 * %PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_VC Virtual Channel
368 * %PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_DSN Device Serial Number
369 * %PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_PWR Power Budgeting
370 */
371int pci_find_ext_capability(struct pci_dev *dev, int cap)
372{
373 return pci_find_next_ext_capability(dev, 0, cap);
374}
375EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_find_ext_capability);
376
377static int __pci_find_next_ht_cap(struct pci_dev *dev, int pos, int ht_cap)
378{
379 int rc, ttl = PCI_FIND_CAP_TTL;
380 u8 cap, mask;
381
382 if (ht_cap == HT_CAPTYPE_SLAVE || ht_cap == HT_CAPTYPE_HOST)
383 mask = HT_3BIT_CAP_MASK;
384 else
385 mask = HT_5BIT_CAP_MASK;
386
387 pos = __pci_find_next_cap_ttl(dev->bus, dev->devfn, pos,
388 PCI_CAP_ID_HT, &ttl);
389 while (pos) {
390 rc = pci_read_config_byte(dev, pos + 3, &cap);
391 if (rc != PCIBIOS_SUCCESSFUL)
392 return 0;
393
394 if ((cap & mask) == ht_cap)
395 return pos;
396
397 pos = __pci_find_next_cap_ttl(dev->bus, dev->devfn,
398 pos + PCI_CAP_LIST_NEXT,
399 PCI_CAP_ID_HT, &ttl);
400 }
401
402 return 0;
403}
404/**
405 * pci_find_next_ht_capability - query a device's Hypertransport capabilities
406 * @dev: PCI device to query
407 * @pos: Position from which to continue searching
408 * @ht_cap: Hypertransport capability code
409 *
410 * To be used in conjunction with pci_find_ht_capability() to search for
411 * all capabilities matching @ht_cap. @pos should always be a value returned
412 * from pci_find_ht_capability().
413 *
414 * NB. To be 100% safe against broken PCI devices, the caller should take
415 * steps to avoid an infinite loop.
416 */
417int pci_find_next_ht_capability(struct pci_dev *dev, int pos, int ht_cap)
418{
419 return __pci_find_next_ht_cap(dev, pos + PCI_CAP_LIST_NEXT, ht_cap);
420}
421EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_find_next_ht_capability);
422
423/**
424 * pci_find_ht_capability - query a device's Hypertransport capabilities
425 * @dev: PCI device to query
426 * @ht_cap: Hypertransport capability code
427 *
428 * Tell if a device supports a given Hypertransport capability.
429 * Returns an address within the device's PCI configuration space
430 * or 0 in case the device does not support the request capability.
431 * The address points to the PCI capability, of type PCI_CAP_ID_HT,
432 * which has a Hypertransport capability matching @ht_cap.
433 */
434int pci_find_ht_capability(struct pci_dev *dev, int ht_cap)
435{
436 int pos;
437
438 pos = __pci_bus_find_cap_start(dev->bus, dev->devfn, dev->hdr_type);
439 if (pos)
440 pos = __pci_find_next_ht_cap(dev, pos, ht_cap);
441
442 return pos;
443}
444EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_find_ht_capability);
445
446/**
447 * pci_find_parent_resource - return resource region of parent bus of given region
448 * @dev: PCI device structure contains resources to be searched
449 * @res: child resource record for which parent is sought
450 *
451 * For given resource region of given device, return the resource
452 * region of parent bus the given region is contained in.
453 */
454struct resource *pci_find_parent_resource(const struct pci_dev *dev,
455 struct resource *res)
456{
457 const struct pci_bus *bus = dev->bus;
458 struct resource *r;
459 int i;
460
461 pci_bus_for_each_resource(bus, r, i) {
462 if (!r)
463 continue;
464 if (resource_contains(r, res)) {
465
466 /*
467 * If the window is prefetchable but the BAR is
468 * not, the allocator made a mistake.
469 */
470 if (r->flags & IORESOURCE_PREFETCH &&
471 !(res->flags & IORESOURCE_PREFETCH))
472 return NULL;
473
474 /*
475 * If we're below a transparent bridge, there may
476 * be both a positively-decoded aperture and a
477 * subtractively-decoded region that contain the BAR.
478 * We want the positively-decoded one, so this depends
479 * on pci_bus_for_each_resource() giving us those
480 * first.
481 */
482 return r;
483 }
484 }
485 return NULL;
486}
487EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_find_parent_resource);
488
489/**
490 * pci_find_resource - Return matching PCI device resource
491 * @dev: PCI device to query
492 * @res: Resource to look for
493 *
494 * Goes over standard PCI resources (BARs) and checks if the given resource
495 * is partially or fully contained in any of them. In that case the
496 * matching resource is returned, %NULL otherwise.
497 */
498struct resource *pci_find_resource(struct pci_dev *dev, struct resource *res)
499{
500 int i;
501
502 for (i = 0; i < PCI_ROM_RESOURCE; i++) {
503 struct resource *r = &dev->resource[i];
504
505 if (r->start && resource_contains(r, res))
506 return r;
507 }
508
509 return NULL;
510}
511EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_find_resource);
512
513/**
514 * pci_find_pcie_root_port - return PCIe Root Port
515 * @dev: PCI device to query
516 *
517 * Traverse up the parent chain and return the PCIe Root Port PCI Device
518 * for a given PCI Device.
519 */
520struct pci_dev *pci_find_pcie_root_port(struct pci_dev *dev)
521{
522 struct pci_dev *bridge, *highest_pcie_bridge = dev;
523
524 bridge = pci_upstream_bridge(dev);
525 while (bridge && pci_is_pcie(bridge)) {
526 highest_pcie_bridge = bridge;
527 bridge = pci_upstream_bridge(bridge);
528 }
529
530 if (pci_pcie_type(highest_pcie_bridge) != PCI_EXP_TYPE_ROOT_PORT)
531 return NULL;
532
533 return highest_pcie_bridge;
534}
535EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_find_pcie_root_port);
536
537/**
538 * pci_wait_for_pending - wait for @mask bit(s) to clear in status word @pos
539 * @dev: the PCI device to operate on
540 * @pos: config space offset of status word
541 * @mask: mask of bit(s) to care about in status word
542 *
543 * Return 1 when mask bit(s) in status word clear, 0 otherwise.
544 */
545int pci_wait_for_pending(struct pci_dev *dev, int pos, u16 mask)
546{
547 int i;
548
549 /* Wait for Transaction Pending bit clean */
550 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++) {
551 u16 status;
552 if (i)
553 msleep((1 << (i - 1)) * 100);
554
555 pci_read_config_word(dev, pos, &status);
556 if (!(status & mask))
557 return 1;
558 }
559
560 return 0;
561}
562
563/**
564 * pci_restore_bars - restore a device's BAR values (e.g. after wake-up)
565 * @dev: PCI device to have its BARs restored
566 *
567 * Restore the BAR values for a given device, so as to make it
568 * accessible by its driver.
569 */
570static void pci_restore_bars(struct pci_dev *dev)
571{
572 int i;
573
574 for (i = 0; i < PCI_BRIDGE_RESOURCES; i++)
575 pci_update_resource(dev, i);
576}
577
578static const struct pci_platform_pm_ops *pci_platform_pm;
579
580int pci_set_platform_pm(const struct pci_platform_pm_ops *ops)
581{
582 if (!ops->is_manageable || !ops->set_state || !ops->get_state ||
583 !ops->choose_state || !ops->set_wakeup || !ops->need_resume)
584 return -EINVAL;
585 pci_platform_pm = ops;
586 return 0;
587}
588
589static inline bool platform_pci_power_manageable(struct pci_dev *dev)
590{
591 return pci_platform_pm ? pci_platform_pm->is_manageable(dev) : false;
592}
593
594static inline int platform_pci_set_power_state(struct pci_dev *dev,
595 pci_power_t t)
596{
597 return pci_platform_pm ? pci_platform_pm->set_state(dev, t) : -ENOSYS;
598}
599
600static inline pci_power_t platform_pci_get_power_state(struct pci_dev *dev)
601{
602 return pci_platform_pm ? pci_platform_pm->get_state(dev) : PCI_UNKNOWN;
603}
604
605static inline pci_power_t platform_pci_choose_state(struct pci_dev *dev)
606{
607 return pci_platform_pm ?
608 pci_platform_pm->choose_state(dev) : PCI_POWER_ERROR;
609}
610
611static inline int platform_pci_set_wakeup(struct pci_dev *dev, bool enable)
612{
613 return pci_platform_pm ?
614 pci_platform_pm->set_wakeup(dev, enable) : -ENODEV;
615}
616
617static inline bool platform_pci_need_resume(struct pci_dev *dev)
618{
619 return pci_platform_pm ? pci_platform_pm->need_resume(dev) : false;
620}
621
622/**
623 * pci_raw_set_power_state - Use PCI PM registers to set the power state of
624 * given PCI device
625 * @dev: PCI device to handle.
626 * @state: PCI power state (D0, D1, D2, D3hot) to put the device into.
627 *
628 * RETURN VALUE:
629 * -EINVAL if the requested state is invalid.
630 * -EIO if device does not support PCI PM or its PM capabilities register has a
631 * wrong version, or device doesn't support the requested state.
632 * 0 if device already is in the requested state.
633 * 0 if device's power state has been successfully changed.
634 */
635static int pci_raw_set_power_state(struct pci_dev *dev, pci_power_t state)
636{
637 u16 pmcsr;
638 bool need_restore = false;
639
640 /* Check if we're already there */
641 if (dev->current_state == state)
642 return 0;
643
644 if (!dev->pm_cap)
645 return -EIO;
646
647 if (state < PCI_D0 || state > PCI_D3hot)
648 return -EINVAL;
649
650 /* Validate current state:
651 * Can enter D0 from any state, but if we can only go deeper
652 * to sleep if we're already in a low power state
653 */
654 if (state != PCI_D0 && dev->current_state <= PCI_D3cold
655 && dev->current_state > state) {
656 pci_err(dev, "invalid power transition (from state %d to %d)\n",
657 dev->current_state, state);
658 return -EINVAL;
659 }
660
661 /* check if this device supports the desired state */
662 if ((state == PCI_D1 && !dev->d1_support)
663 || (state == PCI_D2 && !dev->d2_support))
664 return -EIO;
665
666 pci_read_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, &pmcsr);
667
668 /* If we're (effectively) in D3, force entire word to 0.
669 * This doesn't affect PME_Status, disables PME_En, and
670 * sets PowerState to 0.
671 */
672 switch (dev->current_state) {
673 case PCI_D0:
674 case PCI_D1:
675 case PCI_D2:
676 pmcsr &= ~PCI_PM_CTRL_STATE_MASK;
677 pmcsr |= state;
678 break;
679 case PCI_D3hot:
680 case PCI_D3cold:
681 case PCI_UNKNOWN: /* Boot-up */
682 if ((pmcsr & PCI_PM_CTRL_STATE_MASK) == PCI_D3hot
683 && !(pmcsr & PCI_PM_CTRL_NO_SOFT_RESET))
684 need_restore = true;
685 /* Fall-through: force to D0 */
686 default:
687 pmcsr = 0;
688 break;
689 }
690
691 /* enter specified state */
692 pci_write_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, pmcsr);
693
694 /* Mandatory power management transition delays */
695 /* see PCI PM 1.1 5.6.1 table 18 */
696 if (state == PCI_D3hot || dev->current_state == PCI_D3hot)
697 pci_dev_d3_sleep(dev);
698 else if (state == PCI_D2 || dev->current_state == PCI_D2)
699 udelay(PCI_PM_D2_DELAY);
700
701 pci_read_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, &pmcsr);
702 dev->current_state = (pmcsr & PCI_PM_CTRL_STATE_MASK);
703 if (dev->current_state != state && printk_ratelimit())
704 pci_info(dev, "Refused to change power state, currently in D%d\n",
705 dev->current_state);
706
707 /*
708 * According to section 5.4.1 of the "PCI BUS POWER MANAGEMENT
709 * INTERFACE SPECIFICATION, REV. 1.2", a device transitioning
710 * from D3hot to D0 _may_ perform an internal reset, thereby
711 * going to "D0 Uninitialized" rather than "D0 Initialized".
712 * For example, at least some versions of the 3c905B and the
713 * 3c556B exhibit this behaviour.
714 *
715 * At least some laptop BIOSen (e.g. the Thinkpad T21) leave
716 * devices in a D3hot state at boot. Consequently, we need to
717 * restore at least the BARs so that the device will be
718 * accessible to its driver.
719 */
720 if (need_restore)
721 pci_restore_bars(dev);
722
723 if (dev->bus->self)
724 pcie_aspm_pm_state_change(dev->bus->self);
725
726 return 0;
727}
728
729/**
730 * pci_update_current_state - Read power state of given device and cache it
731 * @dev: PCI device to handle.
732 * @state: State to cache in case the device doesn't have the PM capability
733 *
734 * The power state is read from the PMCSR register, which however is
735 * inaccessible in D3cold. The platform firmware is therefore queried first
736 * to detect accessibility of the register. In case the platform firmware
737 * reports an incorrect state or the device isn't power manageable by the
738 * platform at all, we try to detect D3cold by testing accessibility of the
739 * vendor ID in config space.
740 */
741void pci_update_current_state(struct pci_dev *dev, pci_power_t state)
742{
743 if (platform_pci_get_power_state(dev) == PCI_D3cold ||
744 !pci_device_is_present(dev)) {
745 dev->current_state = PCI_D3cold;
746 } else if (dev->pm_cap) {
747 u16 pmcsr;
748
749 pci_read_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, &pmcsr);
750 dev->current_state = (pmcsr & PCI_PM_CTRL_STATE_MASK);
751 } else {
752 dev->current_state = state;
753 }
754}
755
756/**
757 * pci_power_up - Put the given device into D0 forcibly
758 * @dev: PCI device to power up
759 */
760void pci_power_up(struct pci_dev *dev)
761{
762 if (platform_pci_power_manageable(dev))
763 platform_pci_set_power_state(dev, PCI_D0);
764
765 pci_raw_set_power_state(dev, PCI_D0);
766 pci_update_current_state(dev, PCI_D0);
767}
768
769/**
770 * pci_platform_power_transition - Use platform to change device power state
771 * @dev: PCI device to handle.
772 * @state: State to put the device into.
773 */
774static int pci_platform_power_transition(struct pci_dev *dev, pci_power_t state)
775{
776 int error;
777
778 if (platform_pci_power_manageable(dev)) {
779 error = platform_pci_set_power_state(dev, state);
780 if (!error)
781 pci_update_current_state(dev, state);
782 } else
783 error = -ENODEV;
784
785 if (error && !dev->pm_cap) /* Fall back to PCI_D0 */
786 dev->current_state = PCI_D0;
787
788 return error;
789}
790
791/**
792 * pci_wakeup - Wake up a PCI device
793 * @pci_dev: Device to handle.
794 * @ign: ignored parameter
795 */
796static int pci_wakeup(struct pci_dev *pci_dev, void *ign)
797{
798 pci_wakeup_event(pci_dev);
799 pm_request_resume(&pci_dev->dev);
800 return 0;
801}
802
803/**
804 * pci_wakeup_bus - Walk given bus and wake up devices on it
805 * @bus: Top bus of the subtree to walk.
806 */
807void pci_wakeup_bus(struct pci_bus *bus)
808{
809 if (bus)
810 pci_walk_bus(bus, pci_wakeup, NULL);
811}
812
813/**
814 * __pci_start_power_transition - Start power transition of a PCI device
815 * @dev: PCI device to handle.
816 * @state: State to put the device into.
817 */
818static void __pci_start_power_transition(struct pci_dev *dev, pci_power_t state)
819{
820 if (state == PCI_D0) {
821 pci_platform_power_transition(dev, PCI_D0);
822 /*
823 * Mandatory power management transition delays, see
824 * PCI Express Base Specification Revision 2.0 Section
825 * 6.6.1: Conventional Reset. Do not delay for
826 * devices powered on/off by corresponding bridge,
827 * because have already delayed for the bridge.
828 */
829 if (dev->runtime_d3cold) {
830 if (dev->d3cold_delay)
831 msleep(dev->d3cold_delay);
832 /*
833 * When powering on a bridge from D3cold, the
834 * whole hierarchy may be powered on into
835 * D0uninitialized state, resume them to give
836 * them a chance to suspend again
837 */
838 pci_wakeup_bus(dev->subordinate);
839 }
840 }
841}
842
843/**
844 * __pci_dev_set_current_state - Set current state of a PCI device
845 * @dev: Device to handle
846 * @data: pointer to state to be set
847 */
848static int __pci_dev_set_current_state(struct pci_dev *dev, void *data)
849{
850 pci_power_t state = *(pci_power_t *)data;
851
852 dev->current_state = state;
853 return 0;
854}
855
856/**
857 * pci_bus_set_current_state - Walk given bus and set current state of devices
858 * @bus: Top bus of the subtree to walk.
859 * @state: state to be set
860 */
861void pci_bus_set_current_state(struct pci_bus *bus, pci_power_t state)
862{
863 if (bus)
864 pci_walk_bus(bus, __pci_dev_set_current_state, &state);
865}
866
867/**
868 * __pci_complete_power_transition - Complete power transition of a PCI device
869 * @dev: PCI device to handle.
870 * @state: State to put the device into.
871 *
872 * This function should not be called directly by device drivers.
873 */
874int __pci_complete_power_transition(struct pci_dev *dev, pci_power_t state)
875{
876 int ret;
877
878 if (state <= PCI_D0)
879 return -EINVAL;
880 ret = pci_platform_power_transition(dev, state);
881 /* Power off the bridge may power off the whole hierarchy */
882 if (!ret && state == PCI_D3cold)
883 pci_bus_set_current_state(dev->subordinate, PCI_D3cold);
884 return ret;
885}
886EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(__pci_complete_power_transition);
887
888/**
889 * pci_set_power_state - Set the power state of a PCI device
890 * @dev: PCI device to handle.
891 * @state: PCI power state (D0, D1, D2, D3hot) to put the device into.
892 *
893 * Transition a device to a new power state, using the platform firmware and/or
894 * the device's PCI PM registers.
895 *
896 * RETURN VALUE:
897 * -EINVAL if the requested state is invalid.
898 * -EIO if device does not support PCI PM or its PM capabilities register has a
899 * wrong version, or device doesn't support the requested state.
900 * 0 if the transition is to D1 or D2 but D1 and D2 are not supported.
901 * 0 if device already is in the requested state.
902 * 0 if the transition is to D3 but D3 is not supported.
903 * 0 if device's power state has been successfully changed.
904 */
905int pci_set_power_state(struct pci_dev *dev, pci_power_t state)
906{
907 int error;
908
909 /* bound the state we're entering */
910 if (state > PCI_D3cold)
911 state = PCI_D3cold;
912 else if (state < PCI_D0)
913 state = PCI_D0;
914 else if ((state == PCI_D1 || state == PCI_D2) && pci_no_d1d2(dev))
915 /*
916 * If the device or the parent bridge do not support PCI PM,
917 * ignore the request if we're doing anything other than putting
918 * it into D0 (which would only happen on boot).
919 */
920 return 0;
921
922 /* Check if we're already there */
923 if (dev->current_state == state)
924 return 0;
925
926 __pci_start_power_transition(dev, state);
927
928 /* This device is quirked not to be put into D3, so
929 don't put it in D3 */
930 if (state >= PCI_D3hot && (dev->dev_flags & PCI_DEV_FLAGS_NO_D3))
931 return 0;
932
933 /*
934 * To put device in D3cold, we put device into D3hot in native
935 * way, then put device into D3cold with platform ops
936 */
937 error = pci_raw_set_power_state(dev, state > PCI_D3hot ?
938 PCI_D3hot : state);
939
940 if (!__pci_complete_power_transition(dev, state))
941 error = 0;
942
943 return error;
944}
945EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_set_power_state);
946
947/**
948 * pci_choose_state - Choose the power state of a PCI device
949 * @dev: PCI device to be suspended
950 * @state: target sleep state for the whole system. This is the value
951 * that is passed to suspend() function.
952 *
953 * Returns PCI power state suitable for given device and given system
954 * message.
955 */
956
957pci_power_t pci_choose_state(struct pci_dev *dev, pm_message_t state)
958{
959 pci_power_t ret;
960
961 if (!dev->pm_cap)
962 return PCI_D0;
963
964 ret = platform_pci_choose_state(dev);
965 if (ret != PCI_POWER_ERROR)
966 return ret;
967
968 switch (state.event) {
969 case PM_EVENT_ON:
970 return PCI_D0;
971 case PM_EVENT_FREEZE:
972 case PM_EVENT_PRETHAW:
973 /* REVISIT both freeze and pre-thaw "should" use D0 */
974 case PM_EVENT_SUSPEND:
975 case PM_EVENT_HIBERNATE:
976 return PCI_D3hot;
977 default:
978 pci_info(dev, "unrecognized suspend event %d\n",
979 state.event);
980 BUG();
981 }
982 return PCI_D0;
983}
984EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_choose_state);
985
986#define PCI_EXP_SAVE_REGS 7
987
988static struct pci_cap_saved_state *_pci_find_saved_cap(struct pci_dev *pci_dev,
989 u16 cap, bool extended)
990{
991 struct pci_cap_saved_state *tmp;
992
993 hlist_for_each_entry(tmp, &pci_dev->saved_cap_space, next) {
994 if (tmp->cap.cap_extended == extended && tmp->cap.cap_nr == cap)
995 return tmp;
996 }
997 return NULL;
998}
999
1000struct pci_cap_saved_state *pci_find_saved_cap(struct pci_dev *dev, char cap)
1001{
1002 return _pci_find_saved_cap(dev, cap, false);
1003}
1004
1005struct pci_cap_saved_state *pci_find_saved_ext_cap(struct pci_dev *dev, u16 cap)
1006{
1007 return _pci_find_saved_cap(dev, cap, true);
1008}
1009
1010static int pci_save_pcie_state(struct pci_dev *dev)
1011{
1012 int i = 0;
1013 struct pci_cap_saved_state *save_state;
1014 u16 *cap;
1015
1016 if (!pci_is_pcie(dev))
1017 return 0;
1018
1019 save_state = pci_find_saved_cap(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_EXP);
1020 if (!save_state) {
1021 pci_err(dev, "buffer not found in %s\n", __func__);
1022 return -ENOMEM;
1023 }
1024
1025 cap = (u16 *)&save_state->cap.data[0];
1026 pcie_capability_read_word(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL, &cap[i++]);
1027 pcie_capability_read_word(dev, PCI_EXP_LNKCTL, &cap[i++]);
1028 pcie_capability_read_word(dev, PCI_EXP_SLTCTL, &cap[i++]);
1029 pcie_capability_read_word(dev, PCI_EXP_RTCTL, &cap[i++]);
1030 pcie_capability_read_word(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL2, &cap[i++]);
1031 pcie_capability_read_word(dev, PCI_EXP_LNKCTL2, &cap[i++]);
1032 pcie_capability_read_word(dev, PCI_EXP_SLTCTL2, &cap[i++]);
1033
1034 return 0;
1035}
1036
1037static void pci_restore_pcie_state(struct pci_dev *dev)
1038{
1039 int i = 0;
1040 struct pci_cap_saved_state *save_state;
1041 u16 *cap;
1042
1043 save_state = pci_find_saved_cap(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_EXP);
1044 if (!save_state)
1045 return;
1046
1047 cap = (u16 *)&save_state->cap.data[0];
1048 pcie_capability_write_word(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL, cap[i++]);
1049 pcie_capability_write_word(dev, PCI_EXP_LNKCTL, cap[i++]);
1050 pcie_capability_write_word(dev, PCI_EXP_SLTCTL, cap[i++]);
1051 pcie_capability_write_word(dev, PCI_EXP_RTCTL, cap[i++]);
1052 pcie_capability_write_word(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL2, cap[i++]);
1053 pcie_capability_write_word(dev, PCI_EXP_LNKCTL2, cap[i++]);
1054 pcie_capability_write_word(dev, PCI_EXP_SLTCTL2, cap[i++]);
1055}
1056
1057
1058static int pci_save_pcix_state(struct pci_dev *dev)
1059{
1060 int pos;
1061 struct pci_cap_saved_state *save_state;
1062
1063 pos = pci_find_capability(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_PCIX);
1064 if (!pos)
1065 return 0;
1066
1067 save_state = pci_find_saved_cap(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_PCIX);
1068 if (!save_state) {
1069 pci_err(dev, "buffer not found in %s\n", __func__);
1070 return -ENOMEM;
1071 }
1072
1073 pci_read_config_word(dev, pos + PCI_X_CMD,
1074 (u16 *)save_state->cap.data);
1075
1076 return 0;
1077}
1078
1079static void pci_restore_pcix_state(struct pci_dev *dev)
1080{
1081 int i = 0, pos;
1082 struct pci_cap_saved_state *save_state;
1083 u16 *cap;
1084
1085 save_state = pci_find_saved_cap(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_PCIX);
1086 pos = pci_find_capability(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_PCIX);
1087 if (!save_state || !pos)
1088 return;
1089 cap = (u16 *)&save_state->cap.data[0];
1090
1091 pci_write_config_word(dev, pos + PCI_X_CMD, cap[i++]);
1092}
1093
1094
1095/**
1096 * pci_save_state - save the PCI configuration space of a device before suspending
1097 * @dev: - PCI device that we're dealing with
1098 */
1099int pci_save_state(struct pci_dev *dev)
1100{
1101 int i;
1102 /* XXX: 100% dword access ok here? */
1103 for (i = 0; i < 16; i++)
1104 pci_read_config_dword(dev, i * 4, &dev->saved_config_space[i]);
1105 dev->state_saved = true;
1106
1107 i = pci_save_pcie_state(dev);
1108 if (i != 0)
1109 return i;
1110
1111 i = pci_save_pcix_state(dev);
1112 if (i != 0)
1113 return i;
1114
1115 return pci_save_vc_state(dev);
1116}
1117EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_save_state);
1118
1119static void pci_restore_config_dword(struct pci_dev *pdev, int offset,
1120 u32 saved_val, int retry)
1121{
1122 u32 val;
1123
1124 pci_read_config_dword(pdev, offset, &val);
1125 if (val == saved_val)
1126 return;
1127
1128 for (;;) {
1129 pci_dbg(pdev, "restoring config space at offset %#x (was %#x, writing %#x)\n",
1130 offset, val, saved_val);
1131 pci_write_config_dword(pdev, offset, saved_val);
1132 if (retry-- <= 0)
1133 return;
1134
1135 pci_read_config_dword(pdev, offset, &val);
1136 if (val == saved_val)
1137 return;
1138
1139 mdelay(1);
1140 }
1141}
1142
1143static void pci_restore_config_space_range(struct pci_dev *pdev,
1144 int start, int end, int retry)
1145{
1146 int index;
1147
1148 for (index = end; index >= start; index--)
1149 pci_restore_config_dword(pdev, 4 * index,
1150 pdev->saved_config_space[index],
1151 retry);
1152}
1153
1154static void pci_restore_config_space(struct pci_dev *pdev)
1155{
1156 if (pdev->hdr_type == PCI_HEADER_TYPE_NORMAL) {
1157 pci_restore_config_space_range(pdev, 10, 15, 0);
1158 /* Restore BARs before the command register. */
1159 pci_restore_config_space_range(pdev, 4, 9, 10);
1160 pci_restore_config_space_range(pdev, 0, 3, 0);
1161 } else {
1162 pci_restore_config_space_range(pdev, 0, 15, 0);
1163 }
1164}
1165
1166/**
1167 * pci_restore_state - Restore the saved state of a PCI device
1168 * @dev: - PCI device that we're dealing with
1169 */
1170void pci_restore_state(struct pci_dev *dev)
1171{
1172 if (!dev->state_saved)
1173 return;
1174
1175 /* PCI Express register must be restored first */
1176 pci_restore_pcie_state(dev);
1177 pci_restore_pasid_state(dev);
1178 pci_restore_pri_state(dev);
1179 pci_restore_ats_state(dev);
1180 pci_restore_vc_state(dev);
1181
1182 pci_cleanup_aer_error_status_regs(dev);
1183
1184 pci_restore_config_space(dev);
1185
1186 pci_restore_pcix_state(dev);
1187 pci_restore_msi_state(dev);
1188
1189 /* Restore ACS and IOV configuration state */
1190 pci_enable_acs(dev);
1191 pci_restore_iov_state(dev);
1192
1193 dev->state_saved = false;
1194}
1195EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_restore_state);
1196
1197struct pci_saved_state {
1198 u32 config_space[16];
1199 struct pci_cap_saved_data cap[0];
1200};
1201
1202/**
1203 * pci_store_saved_state - Allocate and return an opaque struct containing
1204 * the device saved state.
1205 * @dev: PCI device that we're dealing with
1206 *
1207 * Return NULL if no state or error.
1208 */
1209struct pci_saved_state *pci_store_saved_state(struct pci_dev *dev)
1210{
1211 struct pci_saved_state *state;
1212 struct pci_cap_saved_state *tmp;
1213 struct pci_cap_saved_data *cap;
1214 size_t size;
1215
1216 if (!dev->state_saved)
1217 return NULL;
1218
1219 size = sizeof(*state) + sizeof(struct pci_cap_saved_data);
1220
1221 hlist_for_each_entry(tmp, &dev->saved_cap_space, next)
1222 size += sizeof(struct pci_cap_saved_data) + tmp->cap.size;
1223
1224 state = kzalloc(size, GFP_KERNEL);
1225 if (!state)
1226 return NULL;
1227
1228 memcpy(state->config_space, dev->saved_config_space,
1229 sizeof(state->config_space));
1230
1231 cap = state->cap;
1232 hlist_for_each_entry(tmp, &dev->saved_cap_space, next) {
1233 size_t len = sizeof(struct pci_cap_saved_data) + tmp->cap.size;
1234 memcpy(cap, &tmp->cap, len);
1235 cap = (struct pci_cap_saved_data *)((u8 *)cap + len);
1236 }
1237 /* Empty cap_save terminates list */
1238
1239 return state;
1240}
1241EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_store_saved_state);
1242
1243/**
1244 * pci_load_saved_state - Reload the provided save state into struct pci_dev.
1245 * @dev: PCI device that we're dealing with
1246 * @state: Saved state returned from pci_store_saved_state()
1247 */
1248int pci_load_saved_state(struct pci_dev *dev,
1249 struct pci_saved_state *state)
1250{
1251 struct pci_cap_saved_data *cap;
1252
1253 dev->state_saved = false;
1254
1255 if (!state)
1256 return 0;
1257
1258 memcpy(dev->saved_config_space, state->config_space,
1259 sizeof(state->config_space));
1260
1261 cap = state->cap;
1262 while (cap->size) {
1263 struct pci_cap_saved_state *tmp;
1264
1265 tmp = _pci_find_saved_cap(dev, cap->cap_nr, cap->cap_extended);
1266 if (!tmp || tmp->cap.size != cap->size)
1267 return -EINVAL;
1268
1269 memcpy(tmp->cap.data, cap->data, tmp->cap.size);
1270 cap = (struct pci_cap_saved_data *)((u8 *)cap +
1271 sizeof(struct pci_cap_saved_data) + cap->size);
1272 }
1273
1274 dev->state_saved = true;
1275 return 0;
1276}
1277EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_load_saved_state);
1278
1279/**
1280 * pci_load_and_free_saved_state - Reload the save state pointed to by state,
1281 * and free the memory allocated for it.
1282 * @dev: PCI device that we're dealing with
1283 * @state: Pointer to saved state returned from pci_store_saved_state()
1284 */
1285int pci_load_and_free_saved_state(struct pci_dev *dev,
1286 struct pci_saved_state **state)
1287{
1288 int ret = pci_load_saved_state(dev, *state);
1289 kfree(*state);
1290 *state = NULL;
1291 return ret;
1292}
1293EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_load_and_free_saved_state);
1294
1295int __weak pcibios_enable_device(struct pci_dev *dev, int bars)
1296{
1297 return pci_enable_resources(dev, bars);
1298}
1299
1300static int do_pci_enable_device(struct pci_dev *dev, int bars)
1301{
1302 int err;
1303 struct pci_dev *bridge;
1304 u16 cmd;
1305 u8 pin;
1306
1307 err = pci_set_power_state(dev, PCI_D0);
1308 if (err < 0 && err != -EIO)
1309 return err;
1310
1311 bridge = pci_upstream_bridge(dev);
1312 if (bridge)
1313 pcie_aspm_powersave_config_link(bridge);
1314
1315 err = pcibios_enable_device(dev, bars);
1316 if (err < 0)
1317 return err;
1318 pci_fixup_device(pci_fixup_enable, dev);
1319
1320 if (dev->msi_enabled || dev->msix_enabled)
1321 return 0;
1322
1323 pci_read_config_byte(dev, PCI_INTERRUPT_PIN, &pin);
1324 if (pin) {
1325 pci_read_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, &cmd);
1326 if (cmd & PCI_COMMAND_INTX_DISABLE)
1327 pci_write_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND,
1328 cmd & ~PCI_COMMAND_INTX_DISABLE);
1329 }
1330
1331 return 0;
1332}
1333
1334/**
1335 * pci_reenable_device - Resume abandoned device
1336 * @dev: PCI device to be resumed
1337 *
1338 * Note this function is a backend of pci_default_resume and is not supposed
1339 * to be called by normal code, write proper resume handler and use it instead.
1340 */
1341int pci_reenable_device(struct pci_dev *dev)
1342{
1343 if (pci_is_enabled(dev))
1344 return do_pci_enable_device(dev, (1 << PCI_NUM_RESOURCES) - 1);
1345 return 0;
1346}
1347EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_reenable_device);
1348
1349static void pci_enable_bridge(struct pci_dev *dev)
1350{
1351 struct pci_dev *bridge;
1352 int retval;
1353
1354 bridge = pci_upstream_bridge(dev);
1355 if (bridge)
1356 pci_enable_bridge(bridge);
1357
1358 if (pci_is_enabled(dev)) {
1359 if (!dev->is_busmaster)
1360 pci_set_master(dev);
1361 return;
1362 }
1363
1364 retval = pci_enable_device(dev);
1365 if (retval)
1366 pci_err(dev, "Error enabling bridge (%d), continuing\n",
1367 retval);
1368 pci_set_master(dev);
1369}
1370
1371static int pci_enable_device_flags(struct pci_dev *dev, unsigned long flags)
1372{
1373 struct pci_dev *bridge;
1374 int err;
1375 int i, bars = 0;
1376
1377 /*
1378 * Power state could be unknown at this point, either due to a fresh
1379 * boot or a device removal call. So get the current power state
1380 * so that things like MSI message writing will behave as expected
1381 * (e.g. if the device really is in D0 at enable time).
1382 */
1383 if (dev->pm_cap) {
1384 u16 pmcsr;
1385 pci_read_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, &pmcsr);
1386 dev->current_state = (pmcsr & PCI_PM_CTRL_STATE_MASK);
1387 }
1388
1389 if (atomic_inc_return(&dev->enable_cnt) > 1)
1390 return 0; /* already enabled */
1391
1392 bridge = pci_upstream_bridge(dev);
1393 if (bridge)
1394 pci_enable_bridge(bridge);
1395
1396 /* only skip sriov related */
1397 for (i = 0; i <= PCI_ROM_RESOURCE; i++)
1398 if (dev->resource[i].flags & flags)
1399 bars |= (1 << i);
1400 for (i = PCI_BRIDGE_RESOURCES; i < DEVICE_COUNT_RESOURCE; i++)
1401 if (dev->resource[i].flags & flags)
1402 bars |= (1 << i);
1403
1404 err = do_pci_enable_device(dev, bars);
1405 if (err < 0)
1406 atomic_dec(&dev->enable_cnt);
1407 return err;
1408}
1409
1410/**
1411 * pci_enable_device_io - Initialize a device for use with IO space
1412 * @dev: PCI device to be initialized
1413 *
1414 * Initialize device before it's used by a driver. Ask low-level code
1415 * to enable I/O resources. Wake up the device if it was suspended.
1416 * Beware, this function can fail.
1417 */
1418int pci_enable_device_io(struct pci_dev *dev)
1419{
1420 return pci_enable_device_flags(dev, IORESOURCE_IO);
1421}
1422EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_enable_device_io);
1423
1424/**
1425 * pci_enable_device_mem - Initialize a device for use with Memory space
1426 * @dev: PCI device to be initialized
1427 *
1428 * Initialize device before it's used by a driver. Ask low-level code
1429 * to enable Memory resources. Wake up the device if it was suspended.
1430 * Beware, this function can fail.
1431 */
1432int pci_enable_device_mem(struct pci_dev *dev)
1433{
1434 return pci_enable_device_flags(dev, IORESOURCE_MEM);
1435}
1436EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_enable_device_mem);
1437
1438/**
1439 * pci_enable_device - Initialize device before it's used by a driver.
1440 * @dev: PCI device to be initialized
1441 *
1442 * Initialize device before it's used by a driver. Ask low-level code
1443 * to enable I/O and memory. Wake up the device if it was suspended.
1444 * Beware, this function can fail.
1445 *
1446 * Note we don't actually enable the device many times if we call
1447 * this function repeatedly (we just increment the count).
1448 */
1449int pci_enable_device(struct pci_dev *dev)
1450{
1451 return pci_enable_device_flags(dev, IORESOURCE_MEM | IORESOURCE_IO);
1452}
1453EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_enable_device);
1454
1455/*
1456 * Managed PCI resources. This manages device on/off, intx/msi/msix
1457 * on/off and BAR regions. pci_dev itself records msi/msix status, so
1458 * there's no need to track it separately. pci_devres is initialized
1459 * when a device is enabled using managed PCI device enable interface.
1460 */
1461struct pci_devres {
1462 unsigned int enabled:1;
1463 unsigned int pinned:1;
1464 unsigned int orig_intx:1;
1465 unsigned int restore_intx:1;
1466 unsigned int mwi:1;
1467 u32 region_mask;
1468};
1469
1470static void pcim_release(struct device *gendev, void *res)
1471{
1472 struct pci_dev *dev = to_pci_dev(gendev);
1473 struct pci_devres *this = res;
1474 int i;
1475
1476 if (dev->msi_enabled)
1477 pci_disable_msi(dev);
1478 if (dev->msix_enabled)
1479 pci_disable_msix(dev);
1480
1481 for (i = 0; i < DEVICE_COUNT_RESOURCE; i++)
1482 if (this->region_mask & (1 << i))
1483 pci_release_region(dev, i);
1484
1485 if (this->mwi)
1486 pci_clear_mwi(dev);
1487
1488 if (this->restore_intx)
1489 pci_intx(dev, this->orig_intx);
1490
1491 if (this->enabled && !this->pinned)
1492 pci_disable_device(dev);
1493}
1494
1495static struct pci_devres *get_pci_dr(struct pci_dev *pdev)
1496{
1497 struct pci_devres *dr, *new_dr;
1498
1499 dr = devres_find(&pdev->dev, pcim_release, NULL, NULL);
1500 if (dr)
1501 return dr;
1502
1503 new_dr = devres_alloc(pcim_release, sizeof(*new_dr), GFP_KERNEL);
1504 if (!new_dr)
1505 return NULL;
1506 return devres_get(&pdev->dev, new_dr, NULL, NULL);
1507}
1508
1509static struct pci_devres *find_pci_dr(struct pci_dev *pdev)
1510{
1511 if (pci_is_managed(pdev))
1512 return devres_find(&pdev->dev, pcim_release, NULL, NULL);
1513 return NULL;
1514}
1515
1516/**
1517 * pcim_enable_device - Managed pci_enable_device()
1518 * @pdev: PCI device to be initialized
1519 *
1520 * Managed pci_enable_device().
1521 */
1522int pcim_enable_device(struct pci_dev *pdev)
1523{
1524 struct pci_devres *dr;
1525 int rc;
1526
1527 dr = get_pci_dr(pdev);
1528 if (unlikely(!dr))
1529 return -ENOMEM;
1530 if (dr->enabled)
1531 return 0;
1532
1533 rc = pci_enable_device(pdev);
1534 if (!rc) {
1535 pdev->is_managed = 1;
1536 dr->enabled = 1;
1537 }
1538 return rc;
1539}
1540EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcim_enable_device);
1541
1542/**
1543 * pcim_pin_device - Pin managed PCI device
1544 * @pdev: PCI device to pin
1545 *
1546 * Pin managed PCI device @pdev. Pinned device won't be disabled on
1547 * driver detach. @pdev must have been enabled with
1548 * pcim_enable_device().
1549 */
1550void pcim_pin_device(struct pci_dev *pdev)
1551{
1552 struct pci_devres *dr;
1553
1554 dr = find_pci_dr(pdev);
1555 WARN_ON(!dr || !dr->enabled);
1556 if (dr)
1557 dr->pinned = 1;
1558}
1559EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcim_pin_device);
1560
1561/*
1562 * pcibios_add_device - provide arch specific hooks when adding device dev
1563 * @dev: the PCI device being added
1564 *
1565 * Permits the platform to provide architecture specific functionality when
1566 * devices are added. This is the default implementation. Architecture
1567 * implementations can override this.
1568 */
1569int __weak pcibios_add_device(struct pci_dev *dev)
1570{
1571 return 0;
1572}
1573
1574/**
1575 * pcibios_release_device - provide arch specific hooks when releasing device dev
1576 * @dev: the PCI device being released
1577 *
1578 * Permits the platform to provide architecture specific functionality when
1579 * devices are released. This is the default implementation. Architecture
1580 * implementations can override this.
1581 */
1582void __weak pcibios_release_device(struct pci_dev *dev) {}
1583
1584/**
1585 * pcibios_disable_device - disable arch specific PCI resources for device dev
1586 * @dev: the PCI device to disable
1587 *
1588 * Disables architecture specific PCI resources for the device. This
1589 * is the default implementation. Architecture implementations can
1590 * override this.
1591 */
1592void __weak pcibios_disable_device(struct pci_dev *dev) {}
1593
1594/**
1595 * pcibios_penalize_isa_irq - penalize an ISA IRQ
1596 * @irq: ISA IRQ to penalize
1597 * @active: IRQ active or not
1598 *
1599 * Permits the platform to provide architecture-specific functionality when
1600 * penalizing ISA IRQs. This is the default implementation. Architecture
1601 * implementations can override this.
1602 */
1603void __weak pcibios_penalize_isa_irq(int irq, int active) {}
1604
1605static void do_pci_disable_device(struct pci_dev *dev)
1606{
1607 u16 pci_command;
1608
1609 pci_read_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, &pci_command);
1610 if (pci_command & PCI_COMMAND_MASTER) {
1611 pci_command &= ~PCI_COMMAND_MASTER;
1612 pci_write_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, pci_command);
1613 }
1614
1615 pcibios_disable_device(dev);
1616}
1617
1618/**
1619 * pci_disable_enabled_device - Disable device without updating enable_cnt
1620 * @dev: PCI device to disable
1621 *
1622 * NOTE: This function is a backend of PCI power management routines and is
1623 * not supposed to be called drivers.
1624 */
1625void pci_disable_enabled_device(struct pci_dev *dev)
1626{
1627 if (pci_is_enabled(dev))
1628 do_pci_disable_device(dev);
1629}
1630
1631/**
1632 * pci_disable_device - Disable PCI device after use
1633 * @dev: PCI device to be disabled
1634 *
1635 * Signal to the system that the PCI device is not in use by the system
1636 * anymore. This only involves disabling PCI bus-mastering, if active.
1637 *
1638 * Note we don't actually disable the device until all callers of
1639 * pci_enable_device() have called pci_disable_device().
1640 */
1641void pci_disable_device(struct pci_dev *dev)
1642{
1643 struct pci_devres *dr;
1644
1645 dr = find_pci_dr(dev);
1646 if (dr)
1647 dr->enabled = 0;
1648
1649 dev_WARN_ONCE(&dev->dev, atomic_read(&dev->enable_cnt) <= 0,
1650 "disabling already-disabled device");
1651
1652 if (atomic_dec_return(&dev->enable_cnt) != 0)
1653 return;
1654
1655 do_pci_disable_device(dev);
1656
1657 dev->is_busmaster = 0;
1658}
1659EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_disable_device);
1660
1661/**
1662 * pcibios_set_pcie_reset_state - set reset state for device dev
1663 * @dev: the PCIe device reset
1664 * @state: Reset state to enter into
1665 *
1666 *
1667 * Sets the PCIe reset state for the device. This is the default
1668 * implementation. Architecture implementations can override this.
1669 */
1670int __weak pcibios_set_pcie_reset_state(struct pci_dev *dev,
1671 enum pcie_reset_state state)
1672{
1673 return -EINVAL;
1674}
1675
1676/**
1677 * pci_set_pcie_reset_state - set reset state for device dev
1678 * @dev: the PCIe device reset
1679 * @state: Reset state to enter into
1680 *
1681 *
1682 * Sets the PCI reset state for the device.
1683 */
1684int pci_set_pcie_reset_state(struct pci_dev *dev, enum pcie_reset_state state)
1685{
1686 return pcibios_set_pcie_reset_state(dev, state);
1687}
1688EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_set_pcie_reset_state);
1689
1690/**
1691 * pcie_clear_root_pme_status - Clear root port PME interrupt status.
1692 * @dev: PCIe root port or event collector.
1693 */
1694void pcie_clear_root_pme_status(struct pci_dev *dev)
1695{
1696 pcie_capability_set_dword(dev, PCI_EXP_RTSTA, PCI_EXP_RTSTA_PME);
1697}
1698
1699/**
1700 * pci_check_pme_status - Check if given device has generated PME.
1701 * @dev: Device to check.
1702 *
1703 * Check the PME status of the device and if set, clear it and clear PME enable
1704 * (if set). Return 'true' if PME status and PME enable were both set or
1705 * 'false' otherwise.
1706 */
1707bool pci_check_pme_status(struct pci_dev *dev)
1708{
1709 int pmcsr_pos;
1710 u16 pmcsr;
1711 bool ret = false;
1712
1713 if (!dev->pm_cap)
1714 return false;
1715
1716 pmcsr_pos = dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL;
1717 pci_read_config_word(dev, pmcsr_pos, &pmcsr);
1718 if (!(pmcsr & PCI_PM_CTRL_PME_STATUS))
1719 return false;
1720
1721 /* Clear PME status. */
1722 pmcsr |= PCI_PM_CTRL_PME_STATUS;
1723 if (pmcsr & PCI_PM_CTRL_PME_ENABLE) {
1724 /* Disable PME to avoid interrupt flood. */
1725 pmcsr &= ~PCI_PM_CTRL_PME_ENABLE;
1726 ret = true;
1727 }
1728
1729 pci_write_config_word(dev, pmcsr_pos, pmcsr);
1730
1731 return ret;
1732}
1733
1734/**
1735 * pci_pme_wakeup - Wake up a PCI device if its PME Status bit is set.
1736 * @dev: Device to handle.
1737 * @pme_poll_reset: Whether or not to reset the device's pme_poll flag.
1738 *
1739 * Check if @dev has generated PME and queue a resume request for it in that
1740 * case.
1741 */
1742static int pci_pme_wakeup(struct pci_dev *dev, void *pme_poll_reset)
1743{
1744 if (pme_poll_reset && dev->pme_poll)
1745 dev->pme_poll = false;
1746
1747 if (pci_check_pme_status(dev)) {
1748 pci_wakeup_event(dev);
1749 pm_request_resume(&dev->dev);
1750 }
1751 return 0;
1752}
1753
1754/**
1755 * pci_pme_wakeup_bus - Walk given bus and wake up devices on it, if necessary.
1756 * @bus: Top bus of the subtree to walk.
1757 */
1758void pci_pme_wakeup_bus(struct pci_bus *bus)
1759{
1760 if (bus)
1761 pci_walk_bus(bus, pci_pme_wakeup, (void *)true);
1762}
1763
1764
1765/**
1766 * pci_pme_capable - check the capability of PCI device to generate PME#
1767 * @dev: PCI device to handle.
1768 * @state: PCI state from which device will issue PME#.
1769 */
1770bool pci_pme_capable(struct pci_dev *dev, pci_power_t state)
1771{
1772 if (!dev->pm_cap)
1773 return false;
1774
1775 return !!(dev->pme_support & (1 << state));
1776}
1777EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_pme_capable);
1778
1779static void pci_pme_list_scan(struct work_struct *work)
1780{
1781 struct pci_pme_device *pme_dev, *n;
1782
1783 mutex_lock(&pci_pme_list_mutex);
1784 list_for_each_entry_safe(pme_dev, n, &pci_pme_list, list) {
1785 if (pme_dev->dev->pme_poll) {
1786 struct pci_dev *bridge;
1787
1788 bridge = pme_dev->dev->bus->self;
1789 /*
1790 * If bridge is in low power state, the
1791 * configuration space of subordinate devices
1792 * may be not accessible
1793 */
1794 if (bridge && bridge->current_state != PCI_D0)
1795 continue;
1796 pci_pme_wakeup(pme_dev->dev, NULL);
1797 } else {
1798 list_del(&pme_dev->list);
1799 kfree(pme_dev);
1800 }
1801 }
1802 if (!list_empty(&pci_pme_list))
1803 queue_delayed_work(system_freezable_wq, &pci_pme_work,
1804 msecs_to_jiffies(PME_TIMEOUT));
1805 mutex_unlock(&pci_pme_list_mutex);
1806}
1807
1808static void __pci_pme_active(struct pci_dev *dev, bool enable)
1809{
1810 u16 pmcsr;
1811
1812 if (!dev->pme_support)
1813 return;
1814
1815 pci_read_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, &pmcsr);
1816 /* Clear PME_Status by writing 1 to it and enable PME# */
1817 pmcsr |= PCI_PM_CTRL_PME_STATUS | PCI_PM_CTRL_PME_ENABLE;
1818 if (!enable)
1819 pmcsr &= ~PCI_PM_CTRL_PME_ENABLE;
1820
1821 pci_write_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, pmcsr);
1822}
1823
1824/**
1825 * pci_pme_restore - Restore PME configuration after config space restore.
1826 * @dev: PCI device to update.
1827 */
1828void pci_pme_restore(struct pci_dev *dev)
1829{
1830 u16 pmcsr;
1831
1832 if (!dev->pme_support)
1833 return;
1834
1835 pci_read_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, &pmcsr);
1836 if (dev->wakeup_prepared) {
1837 pmcsr |= PCI_PM_CTRL_PME_ENABLE;
1838 pmcsr &= ~PCI_PM_CTRL_PME_STATUS;
1839 } else {
1840 pmcsr &= ~PCI_PM_CTRL_PME_ENABLE;
1841 pmcsr |= PCI_PM_CTRL_PME_STATUS;
1842 }
1843 pci_write_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, pmcsr);
1844}
1845
1846/**
1847 * pci_pme_active - enable or disable PCI device's PME# function
1848 * @dev: PCI device to handle.
1849 * @enable: 'true' to enable PME# generation; 'false' to disable it.
1850 *
1851 * The caller must verify that the device is capable of generating PME# before
1852 * calling this function with @enable equal to 'true'.
1853 */
1854void pci_pme_active(struct pci_dev *dev, bool enable)
1855{
1856 __pci_pme_active(dev, enable);
1857
1858 /*
1859 * PCI (as opposed to PCIe) PME requires that the device have
1860 * its PME# line hooked up correctly. Not all hardware vendors
1861 * do this, so the PME never gets delivered and the device
1862 * remains asleep. The easiest way around this is to
1863 * periodically walk the list of suspended devices and check
1864 * whether any have their PME flag set. The assumption is that
1865 * we'll wake up often enough anyway that this won't be a huge
1866 * hit, and the power savings from the devices will still be a
1867 * win.
1868 *
1869 * Although PCIe uses in-band PME message instead of PME# line
1870 * to report PME, PME does not work for some PCIe devices in
1871 * reality. For example, there are devices that set their PME
1872 * status bits, but don't really bother to send a PME message;
1873 * there are PCI Express Root Ports that don't bother to
1874 * trigger interrupts when they receive PME messages from the
1875 * devices below. So PME poll is used for PCIe devices too.
1876 */
1877
1878 if (dev->pme_poll) {
1879 struct pci_pme_device *pme_dev;
1880 if (enable) {
1881 pme_dev = kmalloc(sizeof(struct pci_pme_device),
1882 GFP_KERNEL);
1883 if (!pme_dev) {
1884 pci_warn(dev, "can't enable PME#\n");
1885 return;
1886 }
1887 pme_dev->dev = dev;
1888 mutex_lock(&pci_pme_list_mutex);
1889 list_add(&pme_dev->list, &pci_pme_list);
1890 if (list_is_singular(&pci_pme_list))
1891 queue_delayed_work(system_freezable_wq,
1892 &pci_pme_work,
1893 msecs_to_jiffies(PME_TIMEOUT));
1894 mutex_unlock(&pci_pme_list_mutex);
1895 } else {
1896 mutex_lock(&pci_pme_list_mutex);
1897 list_for_each_entry(pme_dev, &pci_pme_list, list) {
1898 if (pme_dev->dev == dev) {
1899 list_del(&pme_dev->list);
1900 kfree(pme_dev);
1901 break;
1902 }
1903 }
1904 mutex_unlock(&pci_pme_list_mutex);
1905 }
1906 }
1907
1908 pci_dbg(dev, "PME# %s\n", enable ? "enabled" : "disabled");
1909}
1910EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_pme_active);
1911
1912/**
1913 * __pci_enable_wake - enable PCI device as wakeup event source
1914 * @dev: PCI device affected
1915 * @state: PCI state from which device will issue wakeup events
1916 * @enable: True to enable event generation; false to disable
1917 *
1918 * This enables the device as a wakeup event source, or disables it.
1919 * When such events involves platform-specific hooks, those hooks are
1920 * called automatically by this routine.
1921 *
1922 * Devices with legacy power management (no standard PCI PM capabilities)
1923 * always require such platform hooks.
1924 *
1925 * RETURN VALUE:
1926 * 0 is returned on success
1927 * -EINVAL is returned if device is not supposed to wake up the system
1928 * Error code depending on the platform is returned if both the platform and
1929 * the native mechanism fail to enable the generation of wake-up events
1930 */
1931static int __pci_enable_wake(struct pci_dev *dev, pci_power_t state, bool enable)
1932{
1933 int ret = 0;
1934
1935 /*
1936 * Bridges can only signal wakeup on behalf of subordinate devices,
1937 * but that is set up elsewhere, so skip them.
1938 */
1939 if (pci_has_subordinate(dev))
1940 return 0;
1941
1942 /* Don't do the same thing twice in a row for one device. */
1943 if (!!enable == !!dev->wakeup_prepared)
1944 return 0;
1945
1946 /*
1947 * According to "PCI System Architecture" 4th ed. by Tom Shanley & Don
1948 * Anderson we should be doing PME# wake enable followed by ACPI wake
1949 * enable. To disable wake-up we call the platform first, for symmetry.
1950 */
1951
1952 if (enable) {
1953 int error;
1954
1955 if (pci_pme_capable(dev, state))
1956 pci_pme_active(dev, true);
1957 else
1958 ret = 1;
1959 error = platform_pci_set_wakeup(dev, true);
1960 if (ret)
1961 ret = error;
1962 if (!ret)
1963 dev->wakeup_prepared = true;
1964 } else {
1965 platform_pci_set_wakeup(dev, false);
1966 pci_pme_active(dev, false);
1967 dev->wakeup_prepared = false;
1968 }
1969
1970 return ret;
1971}
1972
1973/**
1974 * pci_enable_wake - change wakeup settings for a PCI device
1975 * @pci_dev: Target device
1976 * @state: PCI state from which device will issue wakeup events
1977 * @enable: Whether or not to enable event generation
1978 *
1979 * If @enable is set, check device_may_wakeup() for the device before calling
1980 * __pci_enable_wake() for it.
1981 */
1982int pci_enable_wake(struct pci_dev *pci_dev, pci_power_t state, bool enable)
1983{
1984 if (enable && !device_may_wakeup(&pci_dev->dev))
1985 return -EINVAL;
1986
1987 return __pci_enable_wake(pci_dev, state, enable);
1988}
1989EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_enable_wake);
1990
1991/**
1992 * pci_wake_from_d3 - enable/disable device to wake up from D3_hot or D3_cold
1993 * @dev: PCI device to prepare
1994 * @enable: True to enable wake-up event generation; false to disable
1995 *
1996 * Many drivers want the device to wake up the system from D3_hot or D3_cold
1997 * and this function allows them to set that up cleanly - pci_enable_wake()
1998 * should not be called twice in a row to enable wake-up due to PCI PM vs ACPI
1999 * ordering constraints.
2000 *
2001 * This function only returns error code if the device is not allowed to wake
2002 * up the system from sleep or it is not capable of generating PME# from both
2003 * D3_hot and D3_cold and the platform is unable to enable wake-up power for it.
2004 */
2005int pci_wake_from_d3(struct pci_dev *dev, bool enable)
2006{
2007 return pci_pme_capable(dev, PCI_D3cold) ?
2008 pci_enable_wake(dev, PCI_D3cold, enable) :
2009 pci_enable_wake(dev, PCI_D3hot, enable);
2010}
2011EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_wake_from_d3);
2012
2013/**
2014 * pci_target_state - find an appropriate low power state for a given PCI dev
2015 * @dev: PCI device
2016 * @wakeup: Whether or not wakeup functionality will be enabled for the device.
2017 *
2018 * Use underlying platform code to find a supported low power state for @dev.
2019 * If the platform can't manage @dev, return the deepest state from which it
2020 * can generate wake events, based on any available PME info.
2021 */
2022static pci_power_t pci_target_state(struct pci_dev *dev, bool wakeup)
2023{
2024 pci_power_t target_state = PCI_D3hot;
2025
2026 if (platform_pci_power_manageable(dev)) {
2027 /*
2028 * Call the platform to choose the target state of the device
2029 * and enable wake-up from this state if supported.
2030 */
2031 pci_power_t state = platform_pci_choose_state(dev);
2032
2033 switch (state) {
2034 case PCI_POWER_ERROR:
2035 case PCI_UNKNOWN:
2036 break;
2037 case PCI_D1:
2038 case PCI_D2:
2039 if (pci_no_d1d2(dev))
2040 break;
2041 default:
2042 target_state = state;
2043 }
2044
2045 return target_state;
2046 }
2047
2048 if (!dev->pm_cap)
2049 target_state = PCI_D0;
2050
2051 /*
2052 * If the device is in D3cold even though it's not power-manageable by
2053 * the platform, it may have been powered down by non-standard means.
2054 * Best to let it slumber.
2055 */
2056 if (dev->current_state == PCI_D3cold)
2057 target_state = PCI_D3cold;
2058
2059 if (wakeup) {
2060 /*
2061 * Find the deepest state from which the device can generate
2062 * wake-up events, make it the target state and enable device
2063 * to generate PME#.
2064 */
2065 if (dev->pme_support) {
2066 while (target_state
2067 && !(dev->pme_support & (1 << target_state)))
2068 target_state--;
2069 }
2070 }
2071
2072 return target_state;
2073}
2074
2075/**
2076 * pci_prepare_to_sleep - prepare PCI device for system-wide transition into a sleep state
2077 * @dev: Device to handle.
2078 *
2079 * Choose the power state appropriate for the device depending on whether
2080 * it can wake up the system and/or is power manageable by the platform
2081 * (PCI_D3hot is the default) and put the device into that state.
2082 */
2083int pci_prepare_to_sleep(struct pci_dev *dev)
2084{
2085 bool wakeup = device_may_wakeup(&dev->dev);
2086 pci_power_t target_state = pci_target_state(dev, wakeup);
2087 int error;
2088
2089 if (target_state == PCI_POWER_ERROR)
2090 return -EIO;
2091
2092 pci_enable_wake(dev, target_state, wakeup);
2093
2094 error = pci_set_power_state(dev, target_state);
2095
2096 if (error)
2097 pci_enable_wake(dev, target_state, false);
2098
2099 return error;
2100}
2101EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_prepare_to_sleep);
2102
2103/**
2104 * pci_back_from_sleep - turn PCI device on during system-wide transition into working state
2105 * @dev: Device to handle.
2106 *
2107 * Disable device's system wake-up capability and put it into D0.
2108 */
2109int pci_back_from_sleep(struct pci_dev *dev)
2110{
2111 pci_enable_wake(dev, PCI_D0, false);
2112 return pci_set_power_state(dev, PCI_D0);
2113}
2114EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_back_from_sleep);
2115
2116/**
2117 * pci_finish_runtime_suspend - Carry out PCI-specific part of runtime suspend.
2118 * @dev: PCI device being suspended.
2119 *
2120 * Prepare @dev to generate wake-up events at run time and put it into a low
2121 * power state.
2122 */
2123int pci_finish_runtime_suspend(struct pci_dev *dev)
2124{
2125 pci_power_t target_state;
2126 int error;
2127
2128 target_state = pci_target_state(dev, device_can_wakeup(&dev->dev));
2129 if (target_state == PCI_POWER_ERROR)
2130 return -EIO;
2131
2132 dev->runtime_d3cold = target_state == PCI_D3cold;
2133
2134 __pci_enable_wake(dev, target_state, pci_dev_run_wake(dev));
2135
2136 error = pci_set_power_state(dev, target_state);
2137
2138 if (error) {
2139 pci_enable_wake(dev, target_state, false);
2140 dev->runtime_d3cold = false;
2141 }
2142
2143 return error;
2144}
2145
2146/**
2147 * pci_dev_run_wake - Check if device can generate run-time wake-up events.
2148 * @dev: Device to check.
2149 *
2150 * Return true if the device itself is capable of generating wake-up events
2151 * (through the platform or using the native PCIe PME) or if the device supports
2152 * PME and one of its upstream bridges can generate wake-up events.
2153 */
2154bool pci_dev_run_wake(struct pci_dev *dev)
2155{
2156 struct pci_bus *bus = dev->bus;
2157
2158 if (!dev->pme_support)
2159 return false;
2160
2161 /* PME-capable in principle, but not from the target power state */
2162 if (!pci_pme_capable(dev, pci_target_state(dev, true)))
2163 return false;
2164
2165 if (device_can_wakeup(&dev->dev))
2166 return true;
2167
2168 while (bus->parent) {
2169 struct pci_dev *bridge = bus->self;
2170
2171 if (device_can_wakeup(&bridge->dev))
2172 return true;
2173
2174 bus = bus->parent;
2175 }
2176
2177 /* We have reached the root bus. */
2178 if (bus->bridge)
2179 return device_can_wakeup(bus->bridge);
2180
2181 return false;
2182}
2183EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_dev_run_wake);
2184
2185/**
2186 * pci_dev_keep_suspended - Check if the device can stay in the suspended state.
2187 * @pci_dev: Device to check.
2188 *
2189 * Return 'true' if the device is runtime-suspended, it doesn't have to be
2190 * reconfigured due to wakeup settings difference between system and runtime
2191 * suspend and the current power state of it is suitable for the upcoming
2192 * (system) transition.
2193 *
2194 * If the device is not configured for system wakeup, disable PME for it before
2195 * returning 'true' to prevent it from waking up the system unnecessarily.
2196 */
2197bool pci_dev_keep_suspended(struct pci_dev *pci_dev)
2198{
2199 struct device *dev = &pci_dev->dev;
2200 bool wakeup = device_may_wakeup(dev);
2201
2202 if (!pm_runtime_suspended(dev)
2203 || pci_target_state(pci_dev, wakeup) != pci_dev->current_state
2204 || platform_pci_need_resume(pci_dev))
2205 return false;
2206
2207 /*
2208 * At this point the device is good to go unless it's been configured
2209 * to generate PME at the runtime suspend time, but it is not supposed
2210 * to wake up the system. In that case, simply disable PME for it
2211 * (it will have to be re-enabled on exit from system resume).
2212 *
2213 * If the device's power state is D3cold and the platform check above
2214 * hasn't triggered, the device's configuration is suitable and we don't
2215 * need to manipulate it at all.
2216 */
2217 spin_lock_irq(&dev->power.lock);
2218
2219 if (pm_runtime_suspended(dev) && pci_dev->current_state < PCI_D3cold &&
2220 !wakeup)
2221 __pci_pme_active(pci_dev, false);
2222
2223 spin_unlock_irq(&dev->power.lock);
2224 return true;
2225}
2226
2227/**
2228 * pci_dev_complete_resume - Finalize resume from system sleep for a device.
2229 * @pci_dev: Device to handle.
2230 *
2231 * If the device is runtime suspended and wakeup-capable, enable PME for it as
2232 * it might have been disabled during the prepare phase of system suspend if
2233 * the device was not configured for system wakeup.
2234 */
2235void pci_dev_complete_resume(struct pci_dev *pci_dev)
2236{
2237 struct device *dev = &pci_dev->dev;
2238
2239 if (!pci_dev_run_wake(pci_dev))
2240 return;
2241
2242 spin_lock_irq(&dev->power.lock);
2243
2244 if (pm_runtime_suspended(dev) && pci_dev->current_state < PCI_D3cold)
2245 __pci_pme_active(pci_dev, true);
2246
2247 spin_unlock_irq(&dev->power.lock);
2248}
2249
2250void pci_config_pm_runtime_get(struct pci_dev *pdev)
2251{
2252 struct device *dev = &pdev->dev;
2253 struct device *parent = dev->parent;
2254
2255 if (parent)
2256 pm_runtime_get_sync(parent);
2257 pm_runtime_get_noresume(dev);
2258 /*
2259 * pdev->current_state is set to PCI_D3cold during suspending,
2260 * so wait until suspending completes
2261 */
2262 pm_runtime_barrier(dev);
2263 /*
2264 * Only need to resume devices in D3cold, because config
2265 * registers are still accessible for devices suspended but
2266 * not in D3cold.
2267 */
2268 if (pdev->current_state == PCI_D3cold)
2269 pm_runtime_resume(dev);
2270}
2271
2272void pci_config_pm_runtime_put(struct pci_dev *pdev)
2273{
2274 struct device *dev = &pdev->dev;
2275 struct device *parent = dev->parent;
2276
2277 pm_runtime_put(dev);
2278 if (parent)
2279 pm_runtime_put_sync(parent);
2280}
2281
2282/**
2283 * pci_bridge_d3_possible - Is it possible to put the bridge into D3
2284 * @bridge: Bridge to check
2285 *
2286 * This function checks if it is possible to move the bridge to D3.
2287 * Currently we only allow D3 for recent enough PCIe ports.
2288 */
2289bool pci_bridge_d3_possible(struct pci_dev *bridge)
2290{
2291 if (!pci_is_pcie(bridge))
2292 return false;
2293
2294 switch (pci_pcie_type(bridge)) {
2295 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_ROOT_PORT:
2296 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_UPSTREAM:
2297 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_DOWNSTREAM:
2298 if (pci_bridge_d3_disable)
2299 return false;
2300
2301 /*
2302 * Hotplug interrupts cannot be delivered if the link is down,
2303 * so parents of a hotplug port must stay awake. In addition,
2304 * hotplug ports handled by firmware in System Management Mode
2305 * may not be put into D3 by the OS (Thunderbolt on non-Macs).
2306 * For simplicity, disallow in general for now.
2307 */
2308 if (bridge->is_hotplug_bridge)
2309 return false;
2310
2311 if (pci_bridge_d3_force)
2312 return true;
2313
2314 /*
2315 * It should be safe to put PCIe ports from 2015 or newer
2316 * to D3.
2317 */
2318 if (dmi_get_bios_year() >= 2015)
2319 return true;
2320 break;
2321 }
2322
2323 return false;
2324}
2325
2326static int pci_dev_check_d3cold(struct pci_dev *dev, void *data)
2327{
2328 bool *d3cold_ok = data;
2329
2330 if (/* The device needs to be allowed to go D3cold ... */
2331 dev->no_d3cold || !dev->d3cold_allowed ||
2332
2333 /* ... and if it is wakeup capable to do so from D3cold. */
2334 (device_may_wakeup(&dev->dev) &&
2335 !pci_pme_capable(dev, PCI_D3cold)) ||
2336
2337 /* If it is a bridge it must be allowed to go to D3. */
2338 !pci_power_manageable(dev))
2339
2340 *d3cold_ok = false;
2341
2342 return !*d3cold_ok;
2343}
2344
2345/*
2346 * pci_bridge_d3_update - Update bridge D3 capabilities
2347 * @dev: PCI device which is changed
2348 *
2349 * Update upstream bridge PM capabilities accordingly depending on if the
2350 * device PM configuration was changed or the device is being removed. The
2351 * change is also propagated upstream.
2352 */
2353void pci_bridge_d3_update(struct pci_dev *dev)
2354{
2355 bool remove = !device_is_registered(&dev->dev);
2356 struct pci_dev *bridge;
2357 bool d3cold_ok = true;
2358
2359 bridge = pci_upstream_bridge(dev);
2360 if (!bridge || !pci_bridge_d3_possible(bridge))
2361 return;
2362
2363 /*
2364 * If D3 is currently allowed for the bridge, removing one of its
2365 * children won't change that.
2366 */
2367 if (remove && bridge->bridge_d3)
2368 return;
2369
2370 /*
2371 * If D3 is currently allowed for the bridge and a child is added or
2372 * changed, disallowance of D3 can only be caused by that child, so
2373 * we only need to check that single device, not any of its siblings.
2374 *
2375 * If D3 is currently not allowed for the bridge, checking the device
2376 * first may allow us to skip checking its siblings.
2377 */
2378 if (!remove)
2379 pci_dev_check_d3cold(dev, &d3cold_ok);
2380
2381 /*
2382 * If D3 is currently not allowed for the bridge, this may be caused
2383 * either by the device being changed/removed or any of its siblings,
2384 * so we need to go through all children to find out if one of them
2385 * continues to block D3.
2386 */
2387 if (d3cold_ok && !bridge->bridge_d3)
2388 pci_walk_bus(bridge->subordinate, pci_dev_check_d3cold,
2389 &d3cold_ok);
2390
2391 if (bridge->bridge_d3 != d3cold_ok) {
2392 bridge->bridge_d3 = d3cold_ok;
2393 /* Propagate change to upstream bridges */
2394 pci_bridge_d3_update(bridge);
2395 }
2396}
2397
2398/**
2399 * pci_d3cold_enable - Enable D3cold for device
2400 * @dev: PCI device to handle
2401 *
2402 * This function can be used in drivers to enable D3cold from the device
2403 * they handle. It also updates upstream PCI bridge PM capabilities
2404 * accordingly.
2405 */
2406void pci_d3cold_enable(struct pci_dev *dev)
2407{
2408 if (dev->no_d3cold) {
2409 dev->no_d3cold = false;
2410 pci_bridge_d3_update(dev);
2411 }
2412}
2413EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_d3cold_enable);
2414
2415/**
2416 * pci_d3cold_disable - Disable D3cold for device
2417 * @dev: PCI device to handle
2418 *
2419 * This function can be used in drivers to disable D3cold from the device
2420 * they handle. It also updates upstream PCI bridge PM capabilities
2421 * accordingly.
2422 */
2423void pci_d3cold_disable(struct pci_dev *dev)
2424{
2425 if (!dev->no_d3cold) {
2426 dev->no_d3cold = true;
2427 pci_bridge_d3_update(dev);
2428 }
2429}
2430EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_d3cold_disable);
2431
2432/**
2433 * pci_pm_init - Initialize PM functions of given PCI device
2434 * @dev: PCI device to handle.
2435 */
2436void pci_pm_init(struct pci_dev *dev)
2437{
2438 int pm;
2439 u16 pmc;
2440
2441 pm_runtime_forbid(&dev->dev);
2442 pm_runtime_set_active(&dev->dev);
2443 pm_runtime_enable(&dev->dev);
2444 device_enable_async_suspend(&dev->dev);
2445 dev->wakeup_prepared = false;
2446
2447 dev->pm_cap = 0;
2448 dev->pme_support = 0;
2449
2450 /* find PCI PM capability in list */
2451 pm = pci_find_capability(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_PM);
2452 if (!pm)
2453 return;
2454 /* Check device's ability to generate PME# */
2455 pci_read_config_word(dev, pm + PCI_PM_PMC, &pmc);
2456
2457 if ((pmc & PCI_PM_CAP_VER_MASK) > 3) {
2458 pci_err(dev, "unsupported PM cap regs version (%u)\n",
2459 pmc & PCI_PM_CAP_VER_MASK);
2460 return;
2461 }
2462
2463 dev->pm_cap = pm;
2464 dev->d3_delay = PCI_PM_D3_WAIT;
2465 dev->d3cold_delay = PCI_PM_D3COLD_WAIT;
2466 dev->bridge_d3 = pci_bridge_d3_possible(dev);
2467 dev->d3cold_allowed = true;
2468
2469 dev->d1_support = false;
2470 dev->d2_support = false;
2471 if (!pci_no_d1d2(dev)) {
2472 if (pmc & PCI_PM_CAP_D1)
2473 dev->d1_support = true;
2474 if (pmc & PCI_PM_CAP_D2)
2475 dev->d2_support = true;
2476
2477 if (dev->d1_support || dev->d2_support)
2478 pci_printk(KERN_DEBUG, dev, "supports%s%s\n",
2479 dev->d1_support ? " D1" : "",
2480 dev->d2_support ? " D2" : "");
2481 }
2482
2483 pmc &= PCI_PM_CAP_PME_MASK;
2484 if (pmc) {
2485 pci_printk(KERN_DEBUG, dev, "PME# supported from%s%s%s%s%s\n",
2486 (pmc & PCI_PM_CAP_PME_D0) ? " D0" : "",
2487 (pmc & PCI_PM_CAP_PME_D1) ? " D1" : "",
2488 (pmc & PCI_PM_CAP_PME_D2) ? " D2" : "",
2489 (pmc & PCI_PM_CAP_PME_D3) ? " D3hot" : "",
2490 (pmc & PCI_PM_CAP_PME_D3cold) ? " D3cold" : "");
2491 dev->pme_support = pmc >> PCI_PM_CAP_PME_SHIFT;
2492 dev->pme_poll = true;
2493 /*
2494 * Make device's PM flags reflect the wake-up capability, but
2495 * let the user space enable it to wake up the system as needed.
2496 */
2497 device_set_wakeup_capable(&dev->dev, true);
2498 /* Disable the PME# generation functionality */
2499 pci_pme_active(dev, false);
2500 }
2501}
2502
2503static unsigned long pci_ea_flags(struct pci_dev *dev, u8 prop)
2504{
2505 unsigned long flags = IORESOURCE_PCI_FIXED | IORESOURCE_PCI_EA_BEI;
2506
2507 switch (prop) {
2508 case PCI_EA_P_MEM:
2509 case PCI_EA_P_VF_MEM:
2510 flags |= IORESOURCE_MEM;
2511 break;
2512 case PCI_EA_P_MEM_PREFETCH:
2513 case PCI_EA_P_VF_MEM_PREFETCH:
2514 flags |= IORESOURCE_MEM | IORESOURCE_PREFETCH;
2515 break;
2516 case PCI_EA_P_IO:
2517 flags |= IORESOURCE_IO;
2518 break;
2519 default:
2520 return 0;
2521 }
2522
2523 return flags;
2524}
2525
2526static struct resource *pci_ea_get_resource(struct pci_dev *dev, u8 bei,
2527 u8 prop)
2528{
2529 if (bei <= PCI_EA_BEI_BAR5 && prop <= PCI_EA_P_IO)
2530 return &dev->resource[bei];
2531#ifdef CONFIG_PCI_IOV
2532 else if (bei >= PCI_EA_BEI_VF_BAR0 && bei <= PCI_EA_BEI_VF_BAR5 &&
2533 (prop == PCI_EA_P_VF_MEM || prop == PCI_EA_P_VF_MEM_PREFETCH))
2534 return &dev->resource[PCI_IOV_RESOURCES +
2535 bei - PCI_EA_BEI_VF_BAR0];
2536#endif
2537 else if (bei == PCI_EA_BEI_ROM)
2538 return &dev->resource[PCI_ROM_RESOURCE];
2539 else
2540 return NULL;
2541}
2542
2543/* Read an Enhanced Allocation (EA) entry */
2544static int pci_ea_read(struct pci_dev *dev, int offset)
2545{
2546 struct resource *res;
2547 int ent_size, ent_offset = offset;
2548 resource_size_t start, end;
2549 unsigned long flags;
2550 u32 dw0, bei, base, max_offset;
2551 u8 prop;
2552 bool support_64 = (sizeof(resource_size_t) >= 8);
2553
2554 pci_read_config_dword(dev, ent_offset, &dw0);
2555 ent_offset += 4;
2556
2557 /* Entry size field indicates DWORDs after 1st */
2558 ent_size = ((dw0 & PCI_EA_ES) + 1) << 2;
2559
2560 if (!(dw0 & PCI_EA_ENABLE)) /* Entry not enabled */
2561 goto out;
2562
2563 bei = (dw0 & PCI_EA_BEI) >> 4;
2564 prop = (dw0 & PCI_EA_PP) >> 8;
2565
2566 /*
2567 * If the Property is in the reserved range, try the Secondary
2568 * Property instead.
2569 */
2570 if (prop > PCI_EA_P_BRIDGE_IO && prop < PCI_EA_P_MEM_RESERVED)
2571 prop = (dw0 & PCI_EA_SP) >> 16;
2572 if (prop > PCI_EA_P_BRIDGE_IO)
2573 goto out;
2574
2575 res = pci_ea_get_resource(dev, bei, prop);
2576 if (!res) {
2577 pci_err(dev, "Unsupported EA entry BEI: %u\n", bei);
2578 goto out;
2579 }
2580
2581 flags = pci_ea_flags(dev, prop);
2582 if (!flags) {
2583 pci_err(dev, "Unsupported EA properties: %#x\n", prop);
2584 goto out;
2585 }
2586
2587 /* Read Base */
2588 pci_read_config_dword(dev, ent_offset, &base);
2589 start = (base & PCI_EA_FIELD_MASK);
2590 ent_offset += 4;
2591
2592 /* Read MaxOffset */
2593 pci_read_config_dword(dev, ent_offset, &max_offset);
2594 ent_offset += 4;
2595
2596 /* Read Base MSBs (if 64-bit entry) */
2597 if (base & PCI_EA_IS_64) {
2598 u32 base_upper;
2599
2600 pci_read_config_dword(dev, ent_offset, &base_upper);
2601 ent_offset += 4;
2602
2603 flags |= IORESOURCE_MEM_64;
2604
2605 /* entry starts above 32-bit boundary, can't use */
2606 if (!support_64 && base_upper)
2607 goto out;
2608
2609 if (support_64)
2610 start |= ((u64)base_upper << 32);
2611 }
2612
2613 end = start + (max_offset | 0x03);
2614
2615 /* Read MaxOffset MSBs (if 64-bit entry) */
2616 if (max_offset & PCI_EA_IS_64) {
2617 u32 max_offset_upper;
2618
2619 pci_read_config_dword(dev, ent_offset, &max_offset_upper);
2620 ent_offset += 4;
2621
2622 flags |= IORESOURCE_MEM_64;
2623
2624 /* entry too big, can't use */
2625 if (!support_64 && max_offset_upper)
2626 goto out;
2627
2628 if (support_64)
2629 end += ((u64)max_offset_upper << 32);
2630 }
2631
2632 if (end < start) {
2633 pci_err(dev, "EA Entry crosses address boundary\n");
2634 goto out;
2635 }
2636
2637 if (ent_size != ent_offset - offset) {
2638 pci_err(dev, "EA Entry Size (%d) does not match length read (%d)\n",
2639 ent_size, ent_offset - offset);
2640 goto out;
2641 }
2642
2643 res->name = pci_name(dev);
2644 res->start = start;
2645 res->end = end;
2646 res->flags = flags;
2647
2648 if (bei <= PCI_EA_BEI_BAR5)
2649 pci_printk(KERN_DEBUG, dev, "BAR %d: %pR (from Enhanced Allocation, properties %#02x)\n",
2650 bei, res, prop);
2651 else if (bei == PCI_EA_BEI_ROM)
2652 pci_printk(KERN_DEBUG, dev, "ROM: %pR (from Enhanced Allocation, properties %#02x)\n",
2653 res, prop);
2654 else if (bei >= PCI_EA_BEI_VF_BAR0 && bei <= PCI_EA_BEI_VF_BAR5)
2655 pci_printk(KERN_DEBUG, dev, "VF BAR %d: %pR (from Enhanced Allocation, properties %#02x)\n",
2656 bei - PCI_EA_BEI_VF_BAR0, res, prop);
2657 else
2658 pci_printk(KERN_DEBUG, dev, "BEI %d res: %pR (from Enhanced Allocation, properties %#02x)\n",
2659 bei, res, prop);
2660
2661out:
2662 return offset + ent_size;
2663}
2664
2665/* Enhanced Allocation Initialization */
2666void pci_ea_init(struct pci_dev *dev)
2667{
2668 int ea;
2669 u8 num_ent;
2670 int offset;
2671 int i;
2672
2673 /* find PCI EA capability in list */
2674 ea = pci_find_capability(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_EA);
2675 if (!ea)
2676 return;
2677
2678 /* determine the number of entries */
2679 pci_bus_read_config_byte(dev->bus, dev->devfn, ea + PCI_EA_NUM_ENT,
2680 &num_ent);
2681 num_ent &= PCI_EA_NUM_ENT_MASK;
2682
2683 offset = ea + PCI_EA_FIRST_ENT;
2684
2685 /* Skip DWORD 2 for type 1 functions */
2686 if (dev->hdr_type == PCI_HEADER_TYPE_BRIDGE)
2687 offset += 4;
2688
2689 /* parse each EA entry */
2690 for (i = 0; i < num_ent; ++i)
2691 offset = pci_ea_read(dev, offset);
2692}
2693
2694static void pci_add_saved_cap(struct pci_dev *pci_dev,
2695 struct pci_cap_saved_state *new_cap)
2696{
2697 hlist_add_head(&new_cap->next, &pci_dev->saved_cap_space);
2698}
2699
2700/**
2701 * _pci_add_cap_save_buffer - allocate buffer for saving given
2702 * capability registers
2703 * @dev: the PCI device
2704 * @cap: the capability to allocate the buffer for
2705 * @extended: Standard or Extended capability ID
2706 * @size: requested size of the buffer
2707 */
2708static int _pci_add_cap_save_buffer(struct pci_dev *dev, u16 cap,
2709 bool extended, unsigned int size)
2710{
2711 int pos;
2712 struct pci_cap_saved_state *save_state;
2713
2714 if (extended)
2715 pos = pci_find_ext_capability(dev, cap);
2716 else
2717 pos = pci_find_capability(dev, cap);
2718
2719 if (!pos)
2720 return 0;
2721
2722 save_state = kzalloc(sizeof(*save_state) + size, GFP_KERNEL);
2723 if (!save_state)
2724 return -ENOMEM;
2725
2726 save_state->cap.cap_nr = cap;
2727 save_state->cap.cap_extended = extended;
2728 save_state->cap.size = size;
2729 pci_add_saved_cap(dev, save_state);
2730
2731 return 0;
2732}
2733
2734int pci_add_cap_save_buffer(struct pci_dev *dev, char cap, unsigned int size)
2735{
2736 return _pci_add_cap_save_buffer(dev, cap, false, size);
2737}
2738
2739int pci_add_ext_cap_save_buffer(struct pci_dev *dev, u16 cap, unsigned int size)
2740{
2741 return _pci_add_cap_save_buffer(dev, cap, true, size);
2742}
2743
2744/**
2745 * pci_allocate_cap_save_buffers - allocate buffers for saving capabilities
2746 * @dev: the PCI device
2747 */
2748void pci_allocate_cap_save_buffers(struct pci_dev *dev)
2749{
2750 int error;
2751
2752 error = pci_add_cap_save_buffer(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_EXP,
2753 PCI_EXP_SAVE_REGS * sizeof(u16));
2754 if (error)
2755 pci_err(dev, "unable to preallocate PCI Express save buffer\n");
2756
2757 error = pci_add_cap_save_buffer(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_PCIX, sizeof(u16));
2758 if (error)
2759 pci_err(dev, "unable to preallocate PCI-X save buffer\n");
2760
2761 pci_allocate_vc_save_buffers(dev);
2762}
2763
2764void pci_free_cap_save_buffers(struct pci_dev *dev)
2765{
2766 struct pci_cap_saved_state *tmp;
2767 struct hlist_node *n;
2768
2769 hlist_for_each_entry_safe(tmp, n, &dev->saved_cap_space, next)
2770 kfree(tmp);
2771}
2772
2773/**
2774 * pci_configure_ari - enable or disable ARI forwarding
2775 * @dev: the PCI device
2776 *
2777 * If @dev and its upstream bridge both support ARI, enable ARI in the
2778 * bridge. Otherwise, disable ARI in the bridge.
2779 */
2780void pci_configure_ari(struct pci_dev *dev)
2781{
2782 u32 cap;
2783 struct pci_dev *bridge;
2784
2785 if (pcie_ari_disabled || !pci_is_pcie(dev) || dev->devfn)
2786 return;
2787
2788 bridge = dev->bus->self;
2789 if (!bridge)
2790 return;
2791
2792 pcie_capability_read_dword(bridge, PCI_EXP_DEVCAP2, &cap);
2793 if (!(cap & PCI_EXP_DEVCAP2_ARI))
2794 return;
2795
2796 if (pci_find_ext_capability(dev, PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_ARI)) {
2797 pcie_capability_set_word(bridge, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL2,
2798 PCI_EXP_DEVCTL2_ARI);
2799 bridge->ari_enabled = 1;
2800 } else {
2801 pcie_capability_clear_word(bridge, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL2,
2802 PCI_EXP_DEVCTL2_ARI);
2803 bridge->ari_enabled = 0;
2804 }
2805}
2806
2807static int pci_acs_enable;
2808
2809/**
2810 * pci_request_acs - ask for ACS to be enabled if supported
2811 */
2812void pci_request_acs(void)
2813{
2814 pci_acs_enable = 1;
2815}
2816
2817/**
2818 * pci_std_enable_acs - enable ACS on devices using standard ACS capabilites
2819 * @dev: the PCI device
2820 */
2821static void pci_std_enable_acs(struct pci_dev *dev)
2822{
2823 int pos;
2824 u16 cap;
2825 u16 ctrl;
2826
2827 pos = pci_find_ext_capability(dev, PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_ACS);
2828 if (!pos)
2829 return;
2830
2831 pci_read_config_word(dev, pos + PCI_ACS_CAP, &cap);
2832 pci_read_config_word(dev, pos + PCI_ACS_CTRL, &ctrl);
2833
2834 /* Source Validation */
2835 ctrl |= (cap & PCI_ACS_SV);
2836
2837 /* P2P Request Redirect */
2838 ctrl |= (cap & PCI_ACS_RR);
2839
2840 /* P2P Completion Redirect */
2841 ctrl |= (cap & PCI_ACS_CR);
2842
2843 /* Upstream Forwarding */
2844 ctrl |= (cap & PCI_ACS_UF);
2845
2846 pci_write_config_word(dev, pos + PCI_ACS_CTRL, ctrl);
2847}
2848
2849/**
2850 * pci_enable_acs - enable ACS if hardware support it
2851 * @dev: the PCI device
2852 */
2853void pci_enable_acs(struct pci_dev *dev)
2854{
2855 if (!pci_acs_enable)
2856 return;
2857
2858 if (!pci_dev_specific_enable_acs(dev))
2859 return;
2860
2861 pci_std_enable_acs(dev);
2862}
2863
2864static bool pci_acs_flags_enabled(struct pci_dev *pdev, u16 acs_flags)
2865{
2866 int pos;
2867 u16 cap, ctrl;
2868
2869 pos = pci_find_ext_capability(pdev, PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_ACS);
2870 if (!pos)
2871 return false;
2872
2873 /*
2874 * Except for egress control, capabilities are either required
2875 * or only required if controllable. Features missing from the
2876 * capability field can therefore be assumed as hard-wired enabled.
2877 */
2878 pci_read_config_word(pdev, pos + PCI_ACS_CAP, &cap);
2879 acs_flags &= (cap | PCI_ACS_EC);
2880
2881 pci_read_config_word(pdev, pos + PCI_ACS_CTRL, &ctrl);
2882 return (ctrl & acs_flags) == acs_flags;
2883}
2884
2885/**
2886 * pci_acs_enabled - test ACS against required flags for a given device
2887 * @pdev: device to test
2888 * @acs_flags: required PCI ACS flags
2889 *
2890 * Return true if the device supports the provided flags. Automatically
2891 * filters out flags that are not implemented on multifunction devices.
2892 *
2893 * Note that this interface checks the effective ACS capabilities of the
2894 * device rather than the actual capabilities. For instance, most single
2895 * function endpoints are not required to support ACS because they have no
2896 * opportunity for peer-to-peer access. We therefore return 'true'
2897 * regardless of whether the device exposes an ACS capability. This makes
2898 * it much easier for callers of this function to ignore the actual type
2899 * or topology of the device when testing ACS support.
2900 */
2901bool pci_acs_enabled(struct pci_dev *pdev, u16 acs_flags)
2902{
2903 int ret;
2904
2905 ret = pci_dev_specific_acs_enabled(pdev, acs_flags);
2906 if (ret >= 0)
2907 return ret > 0;
2908
2909 /*
2910 * Conventional PCI and PCI-X devices never support ACS, either
2911 * effectively or actually. The shared bus topology implies that
2912 * any device on the bus can receive or snoop DMA.
2913 */
2914 if (!pci_is_pcie(pdev))
2915 return false;
2916
2917 switch (pci_pcie_type(pdev)) {
2918 /*
2919 * PCI/X-to-PCIe bridges are not specifically mentioned by the spec,
2920 * but since their primary interface is PCI/X, we conservatively
2921 * handle them as we would a non-PCIe device.
2922 */
2923 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_PCIE_BRIDGE:
2924 /*
2925 * PCIe 3.0, 6.12.1 excludes ACS on these devices. "ACS is never
2926 * applicable... must never implement an ACS Extended Capability...".
2927 * This seems arbitrary, but we take a conservative interpretation
2928 * of this statement.
2929 */
2930 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_PCI_BRIDGE:
2931 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_RC_EC:
2932 return false;
2933 /*
2934 * PCIe 3.0, 6.12.1.1 specifies that downstream and root ports should
2935 * implement ACS in order to indicate their peer-to-peer capabilities,
2936 * regardless of whether they are single- or multi-function devices.
2937 */
2938 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_DOWNSTREAM:
2939 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_ROOT_PORT:
2940 return pci_acs_flags_enabled(pdev, acs_flags);
2941 /*
2942 * PCIe 3.0, 6.12.1.2 specifies ACS capabilities that should be
2943 * implemented by the remaining PCIe types to indicate peer-to-peer
2944 * capabilities, but only when they are part of a multifunction
2945 * device. The footnote for section 6.12 indicates the specific
2946 * PCIe types included here.
2947 */
2948 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_ENDPOINT:
2949 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_UPSTREAM:
2950 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_LEG_END:
2951 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_RC_END:
2952 if (!pdev->multifunction)
2953 break;
2954
2955 return pci_acs_flags_enabled(pdev, acs_flags);
2956 }
2957
2958 /*
2959 * PCIe 3.0, 6.12.1.3 specifies no ACS capabilities are applicable
2960 * to single function devices with the exception of downstream ports.
2961 */
2962 return true;
2963}
2964
2965/**
2966 * pci_acs_path_enable - test ACS flags from start to end in a hierarchy
2967 * @start: starting downstream device
2968 * @end: ending upstream device or NULL to search to the root bus
2969 * @acs_flags: required flags
2970 *
2971 * Walk up a device tree from start to end testing PCI ACS support. If
2972 * any step along the way does not support the required flags, return false.
2973 */
2974bool pci_acs_path_enabled(struct pci_dev *start,
2975 struct pci_dev *end, u16 acs_flags)
2976{
2977 struct pci_dev *pdev, *parent = start;
2978
2979 do {
2980 pdev = parent;
2981
2982 if (!pci_acs_enabled(pdev, acs_flags))
2983 return false;
2984
2985 if (pci_is_root_bus(pdev->bus))
2986 return (end == NULL);
2987
2988 parent = pdev->bus->self;
2989 } while (pdev != end);
2990
2991 return true;
2992}
2993
2994/**
2995 * pci_rebar_find_pos - find position of resize ctrl reg for BAR
2996 * @pdev: PCI device
2997 * @bar: BAR to find
2998 *
2999 * Helper to find the position of the ctrl register for a BAR.
3000 * Returns -ENOTSUPP if resizable BARs are not supported at all.
3001 * Returns -ENOENT if no ctrl register for the BAR could be found.
3002 */
3003static int pci_rebar_find_pos(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bar)
3004{
3005 unsigned int pos, nbars, i;
3006 u32 ctrl;
3007
3008 pos = pci_find_ext_capability(pdev, PCI_EXT_CAP_ID_REBAR);
3009 if (!pos)
3010 return -ENOTSUPP;
3011
3012 pci_read_config_dword(pdev, pos + PCI_REBAR_CTRL, &ctrl);
3013 nbars = (ctrl & PCI_REBAR_CTRL_NBAR_MASK) >>
3014 PCI_REBAR_CTRL_NBAR_SHIFT;
3015
3016 for (i = 0; i < nbars; i++, pos += 8) {
3017 int bar_idx;
3018
3019 pci_read_config_dword(pdev, pos + PCI_REBAR_CTRL, &ctrl);
3020 bar_idx = ctrl & PCI_REBAR_CTRL_BAR_IDX;
3021 if (bar_idx == bar)
3022 return pos;
3023 }
3024
3025 return -ENOENT;
3026}
3027
3028/**
3029 * pci_rebar_get_possible_sizes - get possible sizes for BAR
3030 * @pdev: PCI device
3031 * @bar: BAR to query
3032 *
3033 * Get the possible sizes of a resizable BAR as bitmask defined in the spec
3034 * (bit 0=1MB, bit 19=512GB). Returns 0 if BAR isn't resizable.
3035 */
3036u32 pci_rebar_get_possible_sizes(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bar)
3037{
3038 int pos;
3039 u32 cap;
3040
3041 pos = pci_rebar_find_pos(pdev, bar);
3042 if (pos < 0)
3043 return 0;
3044
3045 pci_read_config_dword(pdev, pos + PCI_REBAR_CAP, &cap);
3046 return (cap & PCI_REBAR_CAP_SIZES) >> 4;
3047}
3048
3049/**
3050 * pci_rebar_get_current_size - get the current size of a BAR
3051 * @pdev: PCI device
3052 * @bar: BAR to set size to
3053 *
3054 * Read the size of a BAR from the resizable BAR config.
3055 * Returns size if found or negative error code.
3056 */
3057int pci_rebar_get_current_size(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bar)
3058{
3059 int pos;
3060 u32 ctrl;
3061
3062 pos = pci_rebar_find_pos(pdev, bar);
3063 if (pos < 0)
3064 return pos;
3065
3066 pci_read_config_dword(pdev, pos + PCI_REBAR_CTRL, &ctrl);
3067 return (ctrl & PCI_REBAR_CTRL_BAR_SIZE) >> 8;
3068}
3069
3070/**
3071 * pci_rebar_set_size - set a new size for a BAR
3072 * @pdev: PCI device
3073 * @bar: BAR to set size to
3074 * @size: new size as defined in the spec (0=1MB, 19=512GB)
3075 *
3076 * Set the new size of a BAR as defined in the spec.
3077 * Returns zero if resizing was successful, error code otherwise.
3078 */
3079int pci_rebar_set_size(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bar, int size)
3080{
3081 int pos;
3082 u32 ctrl;
3083
3084 pos = pci_rebar_find_pos(pdev, bar);
3085 if (pos < 0)
3086 return pos;
3087
3088 pci_read_config_dword(pdev, pos + PCI_REBAR_CTRL, &ctrl);
3089 ctrl &= ~PCI_REBAR_CTRL_BAR_SIZE;
3090 ctrl |= size << 8;
3091 pci_write_config_dword(pdev, pos + PCI_REBAR_CTRL, ctrl);
3092 return 0;
3093}
3094
3095/**
3096 * pci_enable_atomic_ops_to_root - enable AtomicOp requests to root port
3097 * @dev: the PCI device
3098 * @cap_mask: mask of desired AtomicOp sizes, including one or more of:
3099 * PCI_EXP_DEVCAP2_ATOMIC_COMP32
3100 * PCI_EXP_DEVCAP2_ATOMIC_COMP64
3101 * PCI_EXP_DEVCAP2_ATOMIC_COMP128
3102 *
3103 * Return 0 if all upstream bridges support AtomicOp routing, egress
3104 * blocking is disabled on all upstream ports, and the root port supports
3105 * the requested completion capabilities (32-bit, 64-bit and/or 128-bit
3106 * AtomicOp completion), or negative otherwise.
3107 */
3108int pci_enable_atomic_ops_to_root(struct pci_dev *dev, u32 cap_mask)
3109{
3110 struct pci_bus *bus = dev->bus;
3111 struct pci_dev *bridge;
3112 u32 cap, ctl2;
3113
3114 if (!pci_is_pcie(dev))
3115 return -EINVAL;
3116
3117 /*
3118 * Per PCIe r4.0, sec 6.15, endpoints and root ports may be
3119 * AtomicOp requesters. For now, we only support endpoints as
3120 * requesters and root ports as completers. No endpoints as
3121 * completers, and no peer-to-peer.
3122 */
3123
3124 switch (pci_pcie_type(dev)) {
3125 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_ENDPOINT:
3126 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_LEG_END:
3127 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_RC_END:
3128 break;
3129 default:
3130 return -EINVAL;
3131 }
3132
3133 while (bus->parent) {
3134 bridge = bus->self;
3135
3136 pcie_capability_read_dword(bridge, PCI_EXP_DEVCAP2, &cap);
3137
3138 switch (pci_pcie_type(bridge)) {
3139 /* Ensure switch ports support AtomicOp routing */
3140 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_UPSTREAM:
3141 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_DOWNSTREAM:
3142 if (!(cap & PCI_EXP_DEVCAP2_ATOMIC_ROUTE))
3143 return -EINVAL;
3144 break;
3145
3146 /* Ensure root port supports all the sizes we care about */
3147 case PCI_EXP_TYPE_ROOT_PORT:
3148 if ((cap & cap_mask) != cap_mask)
3149 return -EINVAL;
3150 break;
3151 }
3152
3153 /* Ensure upstream ports don't block AtomicOps on egress */
3154 if (!bridge->has_secondary_link) {
3155 pcie_capability_read_dword(bridge, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL2,
3156 &ctl2);
3157 if (ctl2 & PCI_EXP_DEVCTL2_ATOMIC_EGRESS_BLOCK)
3158 return -EINVAL;
3159 }
3160
3161 bus = bus->parent;
3162 }
3163
3164 pcie_capability_set_word(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL2,
3165 PCI_EXP_DEVCTL2_ATOMIC_REQ);
3166 return 0;
3167}
3168EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_enable_atomic_ops_to_root);
3169
3170/**
3171 * pci_swizzle_interrupt_pin - swizzle INTx for device behind bridge
3172 * @dev: the PCI device
3173 * @pin: the INTx pin (1=INTA, 2=INTB, 3=INTC, 4=INTD)
3174 *
3175 * Perform INTx swizzling for a device behind one level of bridge. This is
3176 * required by section 9.1 of the PCI-to-PCI bridge specification for devices
3177 * behind bridges on add-in cards. For devices with ARI enabled, the slot
3178 * number is always 0 (see the Implementation Note in section 2.2.8.1 of
3179 * the PCI Express Base Specification, Revision 2.1)
3180 */
3181u8 pci_swizzle_interrupt_pin(const struct pci_dev *dev, u8 pin)
3182{
3183 int slot;
3184
3185 if (pci_ari_enabled(dev->bus))
3186 slot = 0;
3187 else
3188 slot = PCI_SLOT(dev->devfn);
3189
3190 return (((pin - 1) + slot) % 4) + 1;
3191}
3192
3193int pci_get_interrupt_pin(struct pci_dev *dev, struct pci_dev **bridge)
3194{
3195 u8 pin;
3196
3197 pin = dev->pin;
3198 if (!pin)
3199 return -1;
3200
3201 while (!pci_is_root_bus(dev->bus)) {
3202 pin = pci_swizzle_interrupt_pin(dev, pin);
3203 dev = dev->bus->self;
3204 }
3205 *bridge = dev;
3206 return pin;
3207}
3208
3209/**
3210 * pci_common_swizzle - swizzle INTx all the way to root bridge
3211 * @dev: the PCI device
3212 * @pinp: pointer to the INTx pin value (1=INTA, 2=INTB, 3=INTD, 4=INTD)
3213 *
3214 * Perform INTx swizzling for a device. This traverses through all PCI-to-PCI
3215 * bridges all the way up to a PCI root bus.
3216 */
3217u8 pci_common_swizzle(struct pci_dev *dev, u8 *pinp)
3218{
3219 u8 pin = *pinp;
3220
3221 while (!pci_is_root_bus(dev->bus)) {
3222 pin = pci_swizzle_interrupt_pin(dev, pin);
3223 dev = dev->bus->self;
3224 }
3225 *pinp = pin;
3226 return PCI_SLOT(dev->devfn);
3227}
3228EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_common_swizzle);
3229
3230/**
3231 * pci_release_region - Release a PCI bar
3232 * @pdev: PCI device whose resources were previously reserved by pci_request_region
3233 * @bar: BAR to release
3234 *
3235 * Releases the PCI I/O and memory resources previously reserved by a
3236 * successful call to pci_request_region. Call this function only
3237 * after all use of the PCI regions has ceased.
3238 */
3239void pci_release_region(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bar)
3240{
3241 struct pci_devres *dr;
3242
3243 if (pci_resource_len(pdev, bar) == 0)
3244 return;
3245 if (pci_resource_flags(pdev, bar) & IORESOURCE_IO)
3246 release_region(pci_resource_start(pdev, bar),
3247 pci_resource_len(pdev, bar));
3248 else if (pci_resource_flags(pdev, bar) & IORESOURCE_MEM)
3249 release_mem_region(pci_resource_start(pdev, bar),
3250 pci_resource_len(pdev, bar));
3251
3252 dr = find_pci_dr(pdev);
3253 if (dr)
3254 dr->region_mask &= ~(1 << bar);
3255}
3256EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_release_region);
3257
3258/**
3259 * __pci_request_region - Reserved PCI I/O and memory resource
3260 * @pdev: PCI device whose resources are to be reserved
3261 * @bar: BAR to be reserved
3262 * @res_name: Name to be associated with resource.
3263 * @exclusive: whether the region access is exclusive or not
3264 *
3265 * Mark the PCI region associated with PCI device @pdev BR @bar as
3266 * being reserved by owner @res_name. Do not access any
3267 * address inside the PCI regions unless this call returns
3268 * successfully.
3269 *
3270 * If @exclusive is set, then the region is marked so that userspace
3271 * is explicitly not allowed to map the resource via /dev/mem or
3272 * sysfs MMIO access.
3273 *
3274 * Returns 0 on success, or %EBUSY on error. A warning
3275 * message is also printed on failure.
3276 */
3277static int __pci_request_region(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bar,
3278 const char *res_name, int exclusive)
3279{
3280 struct pci_devres *dr;
3281
3282 if (pci_resource_len(pdev, bar) == 0)
3283 return 0;
3284
3285 if (pci_resource_flags(pdev, bar) & IORESOURCE_IO) {
3286 if (!request_region(pci_resource_start(pdev, bar),
3287 pci_resource_len(pdev, bar), res_name))
3288 goto err_out;
3289 } else if (pci_resource_flags(pdev, bar) & IORESOURCE_MEM) {
3290 if (!__request_mem_region(pci_resource_start(pdev, bar),
3291 pci_resource_len(pdev, bar), res_name,
3292 exclusive))
3293 goto err_out;
3294 }
3295
3296 dr = find_pci_dr(pdev);
3297 if (dr)
3298 dr->region_mask |= 1 << bar;
3299
3300 return 0;
3301
3302err_out:
3303 pci_warn(pdev, "BAR %d: can't reserve %pR\n", bar,
3304 &pdev->resource[bar]);
3305 return -EBUSY;
3306}
3307
3308/**
3309 * pci_request_region - Reserve PCI I/O and memory resource
3310 * @pdev: PCI device whose resources are to be reserved
3311 * @bar: BAR to be reserved
3312 * @res_name: Name to be associated with resource
3313 *
3314 * Mark the PCI region associated with PCI device @pdev BAR @bar as
3315 * being reserved by owner @res_name. Do not access any
3316 * address inside the PCI regions unless this call returns
3317 * successfully.
3318 *
3319 * Returns 0 on success, or %EBUSY on error. A warning
3320 * message is also printed on failure.
3321 */
3322int pci_request_region(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bar, const char *res_name)
3323{
3324 return __pci_request_region(pdev, bar, res_name, 0);
3325}
3326EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_request_region);
3327
3328/**
3329 * pci_request_region_exclusive - Reserved PCI I/O and memory resource
3330 * @pdev: PCI device whose resources are to be reserved
3331 * @bar: BAR to be reserved
3332 * @res_name: Name to be associated with resource.
3333 *
3334 * Mark the PCI region associated with PCI device @pdev BR @bar as
3335 * being reserved by owner @res_name. Do not access any
3336 * address inside the PCI regions unless this call returns
3337 * successfully.
3338 *
3339 * Returns 0 on success, or %EBUSY on error. A warning
3340 * message is also printed on failure.
3341 *
3342 * The key difference that _exclusive makes it that userspace is
3343 * explicitly not allowed to map the resource via /dev/mem or
3344 * sysfs.
3345 */
3346int pci_request_region_exclusive(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bar,
3347 const char *res_name)
3348{
3349 return __pci_request_region(pdev, bar, res_name, IORESOURCE_EXCLUSIVE);
3350}
3351EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_request_region_exclusive);
3352
3353/**
3354 * pci_release_selected_regions - Release selected PCI I/O and memory resources
3355 * @pdev: PCI device whose resources were previously reserved
3356 * @bars: Bitmask of BARs to be released
3357 *
3358 * Release selected PCI I/O and memory resources previously reserved.
3359 * Call this function only after all use of the PCI regions has ceased.
3360 */
3361void pci_release_selected_regions(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bars)
3362{
3363 int i;
3364
3365 for (i = 0; i < 6; i++)
3366 if (bars & (1 << i))
3367 pci_release_region(pdev, i);
3368}
3369EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_release_selected_regions);
3370
3371static int __pci_request_selected_regions(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bars,
3372 const char *res_name, int excl)
3373{
3374 int i;
3375
3376 for (i = 0; i < 6; i++)
3377 if (bars & (1 << i))
3378 if (__pci_request_region(pdev, i, res_name, excl))
3379 goto err_out;
3380 return 0;
3381
3382err_out:
3383 while (--i >= 0)
3384 if (bars & (1 << i))
3385 pci_release_region(pdev, i);
3386
3387 return -EBUSY;
3388}
3389
3390
3391/**
3392 * pci_request_selected_regions - Reserve selected PCI I/O and memory resources
3393 * @pdev: PCI device whose resources are to be reserved
3394 * @bars: Bitmask of BARs to be requested
3395 * @res_name: Name to be associated with resource
3396 */
3397int pci_request_selected_regions(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bars,
3398 const char *res_name)
3399{
3400 return __pci_request_selected_regions(pdev, bars, res_name, 0);
3401}
3402EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_request_selected_regions);
3403
3404int pci_request_selected_regions_exclusive(struct pci_dev *pdev, int bars,
3405 const char *res_name)
3406{
3407 return __pci_request_selected_regions(pdev, bars, res_name,
3408 IORESOURCE_EXCLUSIVE);
3409}
3410EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_request_selected_regions_exclusive);
3411
3412/**
3413 * pci_release_regions - Release reserved PCI I/O and memory resources
3414 * @pdev: PCI device whose resources were previously reserved by pci_request_regions
3415 *
3416 * Releases all PCI I/O and memory resources previously reserved by a
3417 * successful call to pci_request_regions. Call this function only
3418 * after all use of the PCI regions has ceased.
3419 */
3420
3421void pci_release_regions(struct pci_dev *pdev)
3422{
3423 pci_release_selected_regions(pdev, (1 << 6) - 1);
3424}
3425EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_release_regions);
3426
3427/**
3428 * pci_request_regions - Reserved PCI I/O and memory resources
3429 * @pdev: PCI device whose resources are to be reserved
3430 * @res_name: Name to be associated with resource.
3431 *
3432 * Mark all PCI regions associated with PCI device @pdev as
3433 * being reserved by owner @res_name. Do not access any
3434 * address inside the PCI regions unless this call returns
3435 * successfully.
3436 *
3437 * Returns 0 on success, or %EBUSY on error. A warning
3438 * message is also printed on failure.
3439 */
3440int pci_request_regions(struct pci_dev *pdev, const char *res_name)
3441{
3442 return pci_request_selected_regions(pdev, ((1 << 6) - 1), res_name);
3443}
3444EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_request_regions);
3445
3446/**
3447 * pci_request_regions_exclusive - Reserved PCI I/O and memory resources
3448 * @pdev: PCI device whose resources are to be reserved
3449 * @res_name: Name to be associated with resource.
3450 *
3451 * Mark all PCI regions associated with PCI device @pdev as
3452 * being reserved by owner @res_name. Do not access any
3453 * address inside the PCI regions unless this call returns
3454 * successfully.
3455 *
3456 * pci_request_regions_exclusive() will mark the region so that
3457 * /dev/mem and the sysfs MMIO access will not be allowed.
3458 *
3459 * Returns 0 on success, or %EBUSY on error. A warning
3460 * message is also printed on failure.
3461 */
3462int pci_request_regions_exclusive(struct pci_dev *pdev, const char *res_name)
3463{
3464 return pci_request_selected_regions_exclusive(pdev,
3465 ((1 << 6) - 1), res_name);
3466}
3467EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_request_regions_exclusive);
3468
3469/*
3470 * Record the PCI IO range (expressed as CPU physical address + size).
3471 * Return a negative value if an error has occured, zero otherwise
3472 */
3473int pci_register_io_range(struct fwnode_handle *fwnode, phys_addr_t addr,
3474 resource_size_t size)
3475{
3476 int ret = 0;
3477#ifdef PCI_IOBASE
3478 struct logic_pio_hwaddr *range;
3479
3480 if (!size || addr + size < addr)
3481 return -EINVAL;
3482
3483 range = kzalloc(sizeof(*range), GFP_ATOMIC);
3484 if (!range)
3485 return -ENOMEM;
3486
3487 range->fwnode = fwnode;
3488 range->size = size;
3489 range->hw_start = addr;
3490 range->flags = LOGIC_PIO_CPU_MMIO;
3491
3492 ret = logic_pio_register_range(range);
3493 if (ret)
3494 kfree(range);
3495#endif
3496
3497 return ret;
3498}
3499
3500phys_addr_t pci_pio_to_address(unsigned long pio)
3501{
3502 phys_addr_t address = (phys_addr_t)OF_BAD_ADDR;
3503
3504#ifdef PCI_IOBASE
3505 if (pio >= MMIO_UPPER_LIMIT)
3506 return address;
3507
3508 address = logic_pio_to_hwaddr(pio);
3509#endif
3510
3511 return address;
3512}
3513
3514unsigned long __weak pci_address_to_pio(phys_addr_t address)
3515{
3516#ifdef PCI_IOBASE
3517 return logic_pio_trans_cpuaddr(address);
3518#else
3519 if (address > IO_SPACE_LIMIT)
3520 return (unsigned long)-1;
3521
3522 return (unsigned long) address;
3523#endif
3524}
3525
3526/**
3527 * pci_remap_iospace - Remap the memory mapped I/O space
3528 * @res: Resource describing the I/O space
3529 * @phys_addr: physical address of range to be mapped
3530 *
3531 * Remap the memory mapped I/O space described by the @res
3532 * and the CPU physical address @phys_addr into virtual address space.
3533 * Only architectures that have memory mapped IO functions defined
3534 * (and the PCI_IOBASE value defined) should call this function.
3535 */
3536int pci_remap_iospace(const struct resource *res, phys_addr_t phys_addr)
3537{
3538#if defined(PCI_IOBASE) && defined(CONFIG_MMU)
3539 unsigned long vaddr = (unsigned long)PCI_IOBASE + res->start;
3540
3541 if (!(res->flags & IORESOURCE_IO))
3542 return -EINVAL;
3543
3544 if (res->end > IO_SPACE_LIMIT)
3545 return -EINVAL;
3546
3547 return ioremap_page_range(vaddr, vaddr + resource_size(res), phys_addr,
3548 pgprot_device(PAGE_KERNEL));
3549#else
3550 /* this architecture does not have memory mapped I/O space,
3551 so this function should never be called */
3552 WARN_ONCE(1, "This architecture does not support memory mapped I/O\n");
3553 return -ENODEV;
3554#endif
3555}
3556EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_remap_iospace);
3557
3558/**
3559 * pci_unmap_iospace - Unmap the memory mapped I/O space
3560 * @res: resource to be unmapped
3561 *
3562 * Unmap the CPU virtual address @res from virtual address space.
3563 * Only architectures that have memory mapped IO functions defined
3564 * (and the PCI_IOBASE value defined) should call this function.
3565 */
3566void pci_unmap_iospace(struct resource *res)
3567{
3568#if defined(PCI_IOBASE) && defined(CONFIG_MMU)
3569 unsigned long vaddr = (unsigned long)PCI_IOBASE + res->start;
3570
3571 unmap_kernel_range(vaddr, resource_size(res));
3572#endif
3573}
3574EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_unmap_iospace);
3575
3576/**
3577 * devm_pci_remap_cfgspace - Managed pci_remap_cfgspace()
3578 * @dev: Generic device to remap IO address for
3579 * @offset: Resource address to map
3580 * @size: Size of map
3581 *
3582 * Managed pci_remap_cfgspace(). Map is automatically unmapped on driver
3583 * detach.
3584 */
3585void __iomem *devm_pci_remap_cfgspace(struct device *dev,
3586 resource_size_t offset,
3587 resource_size_t size)
3588{
3589 void __iomem **ptr, *addr;
3590
3591 ptr = devres_alloc(devm_ioremap_release, sizeof(*ptr), GFP_KERNEL);
3592 if (!ptr)
3593 return NULL;
3594
3595 addr = pci_remap_cfgspace(offset, size);
3596 if (addr) {
3597 *ptr = addr;
3598 devres_add(dev, ptr);
3599 } else
3600 devres_free(ptr);
3601
3602 return addr;
3603}
3604EXPORT_SYMBOL(devm_pci_remap_cfgspace);
3605
3606/**
3607 * devm_pci_remap_cfg_resource - check, request region and ioremap cfg resource
3608 * @dev: generic device to handle the resource for
3609 * @res: configuration space resource to be handled
3610 *
3611 * Checks that a resource is a valid memory region, requests the memory
3612 * region and ioremaps with pci_remap_cfgspace() API that ensures the
3613 * proper PCI configuration space memory attributes are guaranteed.
3614 *
3615 * All operations are managed and will be undone on driver detach.
3616 *
3617 * Returns a pointer to the remapped memory or an ERR_PTR() encoded error code
3618 * on failure. Usage example::
3619 *
3620 * res = platform_get_resource(pdev, IORESOURCE_MEM, 0);
3621 * base = devm_pci_remap_cfg_resource(&pdev->dev, res);
3622 * if (IS_ERR(base))
3623 * return PTR_ERR(base);
3624 */
3625void __iomem *devm_pci_remap_cfg_resource(struct device *dev,
3626 struct resource *res)
3627{
3628 resource_size_t size;
3629 const char *name;
3630 void __iomem *dest_ptr;
3631
3632 BUG_ON(!dev);
3633
3634 if (!res || resource_type(res) != IORESOURCE_MEM) {
3635 dev_err(dev, "invalid resource\n");
3636 return IOMEM_ERR_PTR(-EINVAL);
3637 }
3638
3639 size = resource_size(res);
3640 name = res->name ?: dev_name(dev);
3641
3642 if (!devm_request_mem_region(dev, res->start, size, name)) {
3643 dev_err(dev, "can't request region for resource %pR\n", res);
3644 return IOMEM_ERR_PTR(-EBUSY);
3645 }
3646
3647 dest_ptr = devm_pci_remap_cfgspace(dev, res->start, size);
3648 if (!dest_ptr) {
3649 dev_err(dev, "ioremap failed for resource %pR\n", res);
3650 devm_release_mem_region(dev, res->start, size);
3651 dest_ptr = IOMEM_ERR_PTR(-ENOMEM);
3652 }
3653
3654 return dest_ptr;
3655}
3656EXPORT_SYMBOL(devm_pci_remap_cfg_resource);
3657
3658static void __pci_set_master(struct pci_dev *dev, bool enable)
3659{
3660 u16 old_cmd, cmd;
3661
3662 pci_read_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, &old_cmd);
3663 if (enable)
3664 cmd = old_cmd | PCI_COMMAND_MASTER;
3665 else
3666 cmd = old_cmd & ~PCI_COMMAND_MASTER;
3667 if (cmd != old_cmd) {
3668 pci_dbg(dev, "%s bus mastering\n",
3669 enable ? "enabling" : "disabling");
3670 pci_write_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, cmd);
3671 }
3672 dev->is_busmaster = enable;
3673}
3674
3675/**
3676 * pcibios_setup - process "pci=" kernel boot arguments
3677 * @str: string used to pass in "pci=" kernel boot arguments
3678 *
3679 * Process kernel boot arguments. This is the default implementation.
3680 * Architecture specific implementations can override this as necessary.
3681 */
3682char * __weak __init pcibios_setup(char *str)
3683{
3684 return str;
3685}
3686
3687/**
3688 * pcibios_set_master - enable PCI bus-mastering for device dev
3689 * @dev: the PCI device to enable
3690 *
3691 * Enables PCI bus-mastering for the device. This is the default
3692 * implementation. Architecture specific implementations can override
3693 * this if necessary.
3694 */
3695void __weak pcibios_set_master(struct pci_dev *dev)
3696{
3697 u8 lat;
3698
3699 /* The latency timer doesn't apply to PCIe (either Type 0 or Type 1) */
3700 if (pci_is_pcie(dev))
3701 return;
3702
3703 pci_read_config_byte(dev, PCI_LATENCY_TIMER, &lat);
3704 if (lat < 16)
3705 lat = (64 <= pcibios_max_latency) ? 64 : pcibios_max_latency;
3706 else if (lat > pcibios_max_latency)
3707 lat = pcibios_max_latency;
3708 else
3709 return;
3710
3711 pci_write_config_byte(dev, PCI_LATENCY_TIMER, lat);
3712}
3713
3714/**
3715 * pci_set_master - enables bus-mastering for device dev
3716 * @dev: the PCI device to enable
3717 *
3718 * Enables bus-mastering on the device and calls pcibios_set_master()
3719 * to do the needed arch specific settings.
3720 */
3721void pci_set_master(struct pci_dev *dev)
3722{
3723 __pci_set_master(dev, true);
3724 pcibios_set_master(dev);
3725}
3726EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_set_master);
3727
3728/**
3729 * pci_clear_master - disables bus-mastering for device dev
3730 * @dev: the PCI device to disable
3731 */
3732void pci_clear_master(struct pci_dev *dev)
3733{
3734 __pci_set_master(dev, false);
3735}
3736EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_clear_master);
3737
3738/**
3739 * pci_set_cacheline_size - ensure the CACHE_LINE_SIZE register is programmed
3740 * @dev: the PCI device for which MWI is to be enabled
3741 *
3742 * Helper function for pci_set_mwi.
3743 * Originally copied from drivers/net/acenic.c.
3744 * Copyright 1998-2001 by Jes Sorensen, <jes@trained-monkey.org>.
3745 *
3746 * RETURNS: An appropriate -ERRNO error value on error, or zero for success.
3747 */
3748int pci_set_cacheline_size(struct pci_dev *dev)
3749{
3750 u8 cacheline_size;
3751
3752 if (!pci_cache_line_size)
3753 return -EINVAL;
3754
3755 /* Validate current setting: the PCI_CACHE_LINE_SIZE must be
3756 equal to or multiple of the right value. */
3757 pci_read_config_byte(dev, PCI_CACHE_LINE_SIZE, &cacheline_size);
3758 if (cacheline_size >= pci_cache_line_size &&
3759 (cacheline_size % pci_cache_line_size) == 0)
3760 return 0;
3761
3762 /* Write the correct value. */
3763 pci_write_config_byte(dev, PCI_CACHE_LINE_SIZE, pci_cache_line_size);
3764 /* Read it back. */
3765 pci_read_config_byte(dev, PCI_CACHE_LINE_SIZE, &cacheline_size);
3766 if (cacheline_size == pci_cache_line_size)
3767 return 0;
3768
3769 pci_printk(KERN_DEBUG, dev, "cache line size of %d is not supported\n",
3770 pci_cache_line_size << 2);
3771
3772 return -EINVAL;
3773}
3774EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_set_cacheline_size);
3775
3776/**
3777 * pci_set_mwi - enables memory-write-invalidate PCI transaction
3778 * @dev: the PCI device for which MWI is enabled
3779 *
3780 * Enables the Memory-Write-Invalidate transaction in %PCI_COMMAND.
3781 *
3782 * RETURNS: An appropriate -ERRNO error value on error, or zero for success.
3783 */
3784int pci_set_mwi(struct pci_dev *dev)
3785{
3786#ifdef PCI_DISABLE_MWI
3787 return 0;
3788#else
3789 int rc;
3790 u16 cmd;
3791
3792 rc = pci_set_cacheline_size(dev);
3793 if (rc)
3794 return rc;
3795
3796 pci_read_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, &cmd);
3797 if (!(cmd & PCI_COMMAND_INVALIDATE)) {
3798 pci_dbg(dev, "enabling Mem-Wr-Inval\n");
3799 cmd |= PCI_COMMAND_INVALIDATE;
3800 pci_write_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, cmd);
3801 }
3802 return 0;
3803#endif
3804}
3805EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_set_mwi);
3806
3807/**
3808 * pcim_set_mwi - a device-managed pci_set_mwi()
3809 * @dev: the PCI device for which MWI is enabled
3810 *
3811 * Managed pci_set_mwi().
3812 *
3813 * RETURNS: An appropriate -ERRNO error value on error, or zero for success.
3814 */
3815int pcim_set_mwi(struct pci_dev *dev)
3816{
3817 struct pci_devres *dr;
3818
3819 dr = find_pci_dr(dev);
3820 if (!dr)
3821 return -ENOMEM;
3822
3823 dr->mwi = 1;
3824 return pci_set_mwi(dev);
3825}
3826EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcim_set_mwi);
3827
3828/**
3829 * pci_try_set_mwi - enables memory-write-invalidate PCI transaction
3830 * @dev: the PCI device for which MWI is enabled
3831 *
3832 * Enables the Memory-Write-Invalidate transaction in %PCI_COMMAND.
3833 * Callers are not required to check the return value.
3834 *
3835 * RETURNS: An appropriate -ERRNO error value on error, or zero for success.
3836 */
3837int pci_try_set_mwi(struct pci_dev *dev)
3838{
3839#ifdef PCI_DISABLE_MWI
3840 return 0;
3841#else
3842 return pci_set_mwi(dev);
3843#endif
3844}
3845EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_try_set_mwi);
3846
3847/**
3848 * pci_clear_mwi - disables Memory-Write-Invalidate for device dev
3849 * @dev: the PCI device to disable
3850 *
3851 * Disables PCI Memory-Write-Invalidate transaction on the device
3852 */
3853void pci_clear_mwi(struct pci_dev *dev)
3854{
3855#ifndef PCI_DISABLE_MWI
3856 u16 cmd;
3857
3858 pci_read_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, &cmd);
3859 if (cmd & PCI_COMMAND_INVALIDATE) {
3860 cmd &= ~PCI_COMMAND_INVALIDATE;
3861 pci_write_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, cmd);
3862 }
3863#endif
3864}
3865EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_clear_mwi);
3866
3867/**
3868 * pci_intx - enables/disables PCI INTx for device dev
3869 * @pdev: the PCI device to operate on
3870 * @enable: boolean: whether to enable or disable PCI INTx
3871 *
3872 * Enables/disables PCI INTx for device dev
3873 */
3874void pci_intx(struct pci_dev *pdev, int enable)
3875{
3876 u16 pci_command, new;
3877
3878 pci_read_config_word(pdev, PCI_COMMAND, &pci_command);
3879
3880 if (enable)
3881 new = pci_command & ~PCI_COMMAND_INTX_DISABLE;
3882 else
3883 new = pci_command | PCI_COMMAND_INTX_DISABLE;
3884
3885 if (new != pci_command) {
3886 struct pci_devres *dr;
3887
3888 pci_write_config_word(pdev, PCI_COMMAND, new);
3889
3890 dr = find_pci_dr(pdev);
3891 if (dr && !dr->restore_intx) {
3892 dr->restore_intx = 1;
3893 dr->orig_intx = !enable;
3894 }
3895 }
3896}
3897EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_intx);
3898
3899static bool pci_check_and_set_intx_mask(struct pci_dev *dev, bool mask)
3900{
3901 struct pci_bus *bus = dev->bus;
3902 bool mask_updated = true;
3903 u32 cmd_status_dword;
3904 u16 origcmd, newcmd;
3905 unsigned long flags;
3906 bool irq_pending;
3907
3908 /*
3909 * We do a single dword read to retrieve both command and status.
3910 * Document assumptions that make this possible.
3911 */
3912 BUILD_BUG_ON(PCI_COMMAND % 4);
3913 BUILD_BUG_ON(PCI_COMMAND + 2 != PCI_STATUS);
3914
3915 raw_spin_lock_irqsave(&pci_lock, flags);
3916
3917 bus->ops->read(bus, dev->devfn, PCI_COMMAND, 4, &cmd_status_dword);
3918
3919 irq_pending = (cmd_status_dword >> 16) & PCI_STATUS_INTERRUPT;
3920
3921 /*
3922 * Check interrupt status register to see whether our device
3923 * triggered the interrupt (when masking) or the next IRQ is
3924 * already pending (when unmasking).
3925 */
3926 if (mask != irq_pending) {
3927 mask_updated = false;
3928 goto done;
3929 }
3930
3931 origcmd = cmd_status_dword;
3932 newcmd = origcmd & ~PCI_COMMAND_INTX_DISABLE;
3933 if (mask)
3934 newcmd |= PCI_COMMAND_INTX_DISABLE;
3935 if (newcmd != origcmd)
3936 bus->ops->write(bus, dev->devfn, PCI_COMMAND, 2, newcmd);
3937
3938done:
3939 raw_spin_unlock_irqrestore(&pci_lock, flags);
3940
3941 return mask_updated;
3942}
3943
3944/**
3945 * pci_check_and_mask_intx - mask INTx on pending interrupt
3946 * @dev: the PCI device to operate on
3947 *
3948 * Check if the device dev has its INTx line asserted, mask it and
3949 * return true in that case. False is returned if no interrupt was
3950 * pending.
3951 */
3952bool pci_check_and_mask_intx(struct pci_dev *dev)
3953{
3954 return pci_check_and_set_intx_mask(dev, true);
3955}
3956EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_check_and_mask_intx);
3957
3958/**
3959 * pci_check_and_unmask_intx - unmask INTx if no interrupt is pending
3960 * @dev: the PCI device to operate on
3961 *
3962 * Check if the device dev has its INTx line asserted, unmask it if not
3963 * and return true. False is returned and the mask remains active if
3964 * there was still an interrupt pending.
3965 */
3966bool pci_check_and_unmask_intx(struct pci_dev *dev)
3967{
3968 return pci_check_and_set_intx_mask(dev, false);
3969}
3970EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_check_and_unmask_intx);
3971
3972/**
3973 * pci_wait_for_pending_transaction - waits for pending transaction
3974 * @dev: the PCI device to operate on
3975 *
3976 * Return 0 if transaction is pending 1 otherwise.
3977 */
3978int pci_wait_for_pending_transaction(struct pci_dev *dev)
3979{
3980 if (!pci_is_pcie(dev))
3981 return 1;
3982
3983 return pci_wait_for_pending(dev, pci_pcie_cap(dev) + PCI_EXP_DEVSTA,
3984 PCI_EXP_DEVSTA_TRPND);
3985}
3986EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_wait_for_pending_transaction);
3987
3988static int pci_dev_wait(struct pci_dev *dev, char *reset_type, int timeout)
3989{
3990 int delay = 1;
3991 u32 id;
3992
3993 /*
3994 * After reset, the device should not silently discard config
3995 * requests, but it may still indicate that it needs more time by
3996 * responding to them with CRS completions. The Root Port will
3997 * generally synthesize ~0 data to complete the read (except when
3998 * CRS SV is enabled and the read was for the Vendor ID; in that
3999 * case it synthesizes 0x0001 data).
4000 *
4001 * Wait for the device to return a non-CRS completion. Read the
4002 * Command register instead of Vendor ID so we don't have to
4003 * contend with the CRS SV value.
4004 */
4005 pci_read_config_dword(dev, PCI_COMMAND, &id);
4006 while (id == ~0) {
4007 if (delay > timeout) {
4008 pci_warn(dev, "not ready %dms after %s; giving up\n",
4009 delay - 1, reset_type);
4010 return -ENOTTY;
4011 }
4012
4013 if (delay > 1000)
4014 pci_info(dev, "not ready %dms after %s; waiting\n",
4015 delay - 1, reset_type);
4016
4017 msleep(delay);
4018 delay *= 2;
4019 pci_read_config_dword(dev, PCI_COMMAND, &id);
4020 }
4021
4022 if (delay > 1000)
4023 pci_info(dev, "ready %dms after %s\n", delay - 1,
4024 reset_type);
4025
4026 return 0;
4027}
4028
4029/**
4030 * pcie_has_flr - check if a device supports function level resets
4031 * @dev: device to check
4032 *
4033 * Returns true if the device advertises support for PCIe function level
4034 * resets.
4035 */
4036static bool pcie_has_flr(struct pci_dev *dev)
4037{
4038 u32 cap;
4039
4040 if (dev->dev_flags & PCI_DEV_FLAGS_NO_FLR_RESET)
4041 return false;
4042
4043 pcie_capability_read_dword(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVCAP, &cap);
4044 return cap & PCI_EXP_DEVCAP_FLR;
4045}
4046
4047/**
4048 * pcie_flr - initiate a PCIe function level reset
4049 * @dev: device to reset
4050 *
4051 * Initiate a function level reset on @dev. The caller should ensure the
4052 * device supports FLR before calling this function, e.g. by using the
4053 * pcie_has_flr() helper.
4054 */
4055int pcie_flr(struct pci_dev *dev)
4056{
4057 if (!pci_wait_for_pending_transaction(dev))
4058 pci_err(dev, "timed out waiting for pending transaction; performing function level reset anyway\n");
4059
4060 pcie_capability_set_word(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL_BCR_FLR);
4061
4062 /*
4063 * Per PCIe r4.0, sec 6.6.2, a device must complete an FLR within
4064 * 100ms, but may silently discard requests while the FLR is in
4065 * progress. Wait 100ms before trying to access the device.
4066 */
4067 msleep(100);
4068
4069 return pci_dev_wait(dev, "FLR", PCIE_RESET_READY_POLL_MS);
4070}
4071EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pcie_flr);
4072
4073static int pci_af_flr(struct pci_dev *dev, int probe)
4074{
4075 int pos;
4076 u8 cap;
4077
4078 pos = pci_find_capability(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_AF);
4079 if (!pos)
4080 return -ENOTTY;
4081
4082 if (dev->dev_flags & PCI_DEV_FLAGS_NO_FLR_RESET)
4083 return -ENOTTY;
4084
4085 pci_read_config_byte(dev, pos + PCI_AF_CAP, &cap);
4086 if (!(cap & PCI_AF_CAP_TP) || !(cap & PCI_AF_CAP_FLR))
4087 return -ENOTTY;
4088
4089 if (probe)
4090 return 0;
4091
4092 /*
4093 * Wait for Transaction Pending bit to clear. A word-aligned test
4094 * is used, so we use the conrol offset rather than status and shift
4095 * the test bit to match.
4096 */
4097 if (!pci_wait_for_pending(dev, pos + PCI_AF_CTRL,
4098 PCI_AF_STATUS_TP << 8))
4099 pci_err(dev, "timed out waiting for pending transaction; performing AF function level reset anyway\n");
4100
4101 pci_write_config_byte(dev, pos + PCI_AF_CTRL, PCI_AF_CTRL_FLR);
4102
4103 /*
4104 * Per Advanced Capabilities for Conventional PCI ECN, 13 April 2006,
4105 * updated 27 July 2006; a device must complete an FLR within
4106 * 100ms, but may silently discard requests while the FLR is in
4107 * progress. Wait 100ms before trying to access the device.
4108 */
4109 msleep(100);
4110
4111 return pci_dev_wait(dev, "AF_FLR", PCIE_RESET_READY_POLL_MS);
4112}
4113
4114/**
4115 * pci_pm_reset - Put device into PCI_D3 and back into PCI_D0.
4116 * @dev: Device to reset.
4117 * @probe: If set, only check if the device can be reset this way.
4118 *
4119 * If @dev supports native PCI PM and its PCI_PM_CTRL_NO_SOFT_RESET flag is
4120 * unset, it will be reinitialized internally when going from PCI_D3hot to
4121 * PCI_D0. If that's the case and the device is not in a low-power state
4122 * already, force it into PCI_D3hot and back to PCI_D0, causing it to be reset.
4123 *
4124 * NOTE: This causes the caller to sleep for twice the device power transition
4125 * cooldown period, which for the D0->D3hot and D3hot->D0 transitions is 10 ms
4126 * by default (i.e. unless the @dev's d3_delay field has a different value).
4127 * Moreover, only devices in D0 can be reset by this function.
4128 */
4129static int pci_pm_reset(struct pci_dev *dev, int probe)
4130{
4131 u16 csr;
4132
4133 if (!dev->pm_cap || dev->dev_flags & PCI_DEV_FLAGS_NO_PM_RESET)
4134 return -ENOTTY;
4135
4136 pci_read_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, &csr);
4137 if (csr & PCI_PM_CTRL_NO_SOFT_RESET)
4138 return -ENOTTY;
4139
4140 if (probe)
4141 return 0;
4142
4143 if (dev->current_state != PCI_D0)
4144 return -EINVAL;
4145
4146 csr &= ~PCI_PM_CTRL_STATE_MASK;
4147 csr |= PCI_D3hot;
4148 pci_write_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, csr);
4149 pci_dev_d3_sleep(dev);
4150
4151 csr &= ~PCI_PM_CTRL_STATE_MASK;
4152 csr |= PCI_D0;
4153 pci_write_config_word(dev, dev->pm_cap + PCI_PM_CTRL, csr);
4154 pci_dev_d3_sleep(dev);
4155
4156 return pci_dev_wait(dev, "PM D3->D0", PCIE_RESET_READY_POLL_MS);
4157}
4158
4159void pci_reset_secondary_bus(struct pci_dev *dev)
4160{
4161 u16 ctrl;
4162
4163 pci_read_config_word(dev, PCI_BRIDGE_CONTROL, &ctrl);
4164 ctrl |= PCI_BRIDGE_CTL_BUS_RESET;
4165 pci_write_config_word(dev, PCI_BRIDGE_CONTROL, ctrl);
4166
4167 /*
4168 * PCI spec v3.0 7.6.4.2 requires minimum Trst of 1ms. Double
4169 * this to 2ms to ensure that we meet the minimum requirement.
4170 */
4171 msleep(2);
4172
4173 ctrl &= ~PCI_BRIDGE_CTL_BUS_RESET;
4174 pci_write_config_word(dev, PCI_BRIDGE_CONTROL, ctrl);
4175
4176 /*
4177 * Trhfa for conventional PCI is 2^25 clock cycles.
4178 * Assuming a minimum 33MHz clock this results in a 1s
4179 * delay before we can consider subordinate devices to
4180 * be re-initialized. PCIe has some ways to shorten this,
4181 * but we don't make use of them yet.
4182 */
4183 ssleep(1);
4184}
4185
4186void __weak pcibios_reset_secondary_bus(struct pci_dev *dev)
4187{
4188 pci_reset_secondary_bus(dev);
4189}
4190
4191/**
4192 * pci_reset_bridge_secondary_bus - Reset the secondary bus on a PCI bridge.
4193 * @dev: Bridge device
4194 *
4195 * Use the bridge control register to assert reset on the secondary bus.
4196 * Devices on the secondary bus are left in power-on state.
4197 */
4198int pci_reset_bridge_secondary_bus(struct pci_dev *dev)
4199{
4200 pcibios_reset_secondary_bus(dev);
4201
4202 return pci_dev_wait(dev, "bus reset", PCIE_RESET_READY_POLL_MS);
4203}
4204EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_reset_bridge_secondary_bus);
4205
4206static int pci_parent_bus_reset(struct pci_dev *dev, int probe)
4207{
4208 struct pci_dev *pdev;
4209
4210 if (pci_is_root_bus(dev->bus) || dev->subordinate ||
4211 !dev->bus->self || dev->dev_flags & PCI_DEV_FLAGS_NO_BUS_RESET)
4212 return -ENOTTY;
4213
4214 list_for_each_entry(pdev, &dev->bus->devices, bus_list)
4215 if (pdev != dev)
4216 return -ENOTTY;
4217
4218 if (probe)
4219 return 0;
4220
4221 pci_reset_bridge_secondary_bus(dev->bus->self);
4222
4223 return 0;
4224}
4225
4226static int pci_reset_hotplug_slot(struct hotplug_slot *hotplug, int probe)
4227{
4228 int rc = -ENOTTY;
4229
4230 if (!hotplug || !try_module_get(hotplug->ops->owner))
4231 return rc;
4232
4233 if (hotplug->ops->reset_slot)
4234 rc = hotplug->ops->reset_slot(hotplug, probe);
4235
4236 module_put(hotplug->ops->owner);
4237
4238 return rc;
4239}
4240
4241static int pci_dev_reset_slot_function(struct pci_dev *dev, int probe)
4242{
4243 struct pci_dev *pdev;
4244
4245 if (dev->subordinate || !dev->slot ||
4246 dev->dev_flags & PCI_DEV_FLAGS_NO_BUS_RESET)
4247 return -ENOTTY;
4248
4249 list_for_each_entry(pdev, &dev->bus->devices, bus_list)
4250 if (pdev != dev && pdev->slot == dev->slot)
4251 return -ENOTTY;
4252
4253 return pci_reset_hotplug_slot(dev->slot->hotplug, probe);
4254}
4255
4256static void pci_dev_lock(struct pci_dev *dev)
4257{
4258 pci_cfg_access_lock(dev);
4259 /* block PM suspend, driver probe, etc. */
4260 device_lock(&dev->dev);
4261}
4262
4263/* Return 1 on successful lock, 0 on contention */
4264static int pci_dev_trylock(struct pci_dev *dev)
4265{
4266 if (pci_cfg_access_trylock(dev)) {
4267 if (device_trylock(&dev->dev))
4268 return 1;
4269 pci_cfg_access_unlock(dev);
4270 }
4271
4272 return 0;
4273}
4274
4275static void pci_dev_unlock(struct pci_dev *dev)
4276{
4277 device_unlock(&dev->dev);
4278 pci_cfg_access_unlock(dev);
4279}
4280
4281static void pci_dev_save_and_disable(struct pci_dev *dev)
4282{
4283 const struct pci_error_handlers *err_handler =
4284 dev->driver ? dev->driver->err_handler : NULL;
4285
4286 /*
4287 * dev->driver->err_handler->reset_prepare() is protected against
4288 * races with ->remove() by the device lock, which must be held by
4289 * the caller.
4290 */
4291 if (err_handler && err_handler->reset_prepare)
4292 err_handler->reset_prepare(dev);
4293
4294 /*
4295 * Wake-up device prior to save. PM registers default to D0 after
4296 * reset and a simple register restore doesn't reliably return
4297 * to a non-D0 state anyway.
4298 */
4299 pci_set_power_state(dev, PCI_D0);
4300
4301 pci_save_state(dev);
4302 /*
4303 * Disable the device by clearing the Command register, except for
4304 * INTx-disable which is set. This not only disables MMIO and I/O port
4305 * BARs, but also prevents the device from being Bus Master, preventing
4306 * DMA from the device including MSI/MSI-X interrupts. For PCI 2.3
4307 * compliant devices, INTx-disable prevents legacy interrupts.
4308 */
4309 pci_write_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, PCI_COMMAND_INTX_DISABLE);
4310}
4311
4312static void pci_dev_restore(struct pci_dev *dev)
4313{
4314 const struct pci_error_handlers *err_handler =
4315 dev->driver ? dev->driver->err_handler : NULL;
4316
4317 pci_restore_state(dev);
4318
4319 /*
4320 * dev->driver->err_handler->reset_done() is protected against
4321 * races with ->remove() by the device lock, which must be held by
4322 * the caller.
4323 */
4324 if (err_handler && err_handler->reset_done)
4325 err_handler->reset_done(dev);
4326}
4327
4328/**
4329 * __pci_reset_function_locked - reset a PCI device function while holding
4330 * the @dev mutex lock.
4331 * @dev: PCI device to reset
4332 *
4333 * Some devices allow an individual function to be reset without affecting
4334 * other functions in the same device. The PCI device must be responsive
4335 * to PCI config space in order to use this function.
4336 *
4337 * The device function is presumed to be unused and the caller is holding
4338 * the device mutex lock when this function is called.
4339 * Resetting the device will make the contents of PCI configuration space
4340 * random, so any caller of this must be prepared to reinitialise the
4341 * device including MSI, bus mastering, BARs, decoding IO and memory spaces,
4342 * etc.
4343 *
4344 * Returns 0 if the device function was successfully reset or negative if the
4345 * device doesn't support resetting a single function.
4346 */
4347int __pci_reset_function_locked(struct pci_dev *dev)
4348{
4349 int rc;
4350
4351 might_sleep();
4352
4353 /*
4354 * A reset method returns -ENOTTY if it doesn't support this device
4355 * and we should try the next method.
4356 *
4357 * If it returns 0 (success), we're finished. If it returns any
4358 * other error, we're also finished: this indicates that further
4359 * reset mechanisms might be broken on the device.
4360 */
4361 rc = pci_dev_specific_reset(dev, 0);
4362 if (rc != -ENOTTY)
4363 return rc;
4364 if (pcie_has_flr(dev)) {
4365 rc = pcie_flr(dev);
4366 if (rc != -ENOTTY)
4367 return rc;
4368 }
4369 rc = pci_af_flr(dev, 0);
4370 if (rc != -ENOTTY)
4371 return rc;
4372 rc = pci_pm_reset(dev, 0);
4373 if (rc != -ENOTTY)
4374 return rc;
4375 rc = pci_dev_reset_slot_function(dev, 0);
4376 if (rc != -ENOTTY)
4377 return rc;
4378 return pci_parent_bus_reset(dev, 0);
4379}
4380EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(__pci_reset_function_locked);
4381
4382/**
4383 * pci_probe_reset_function - check whether the device can be safely reset
4384 * @dev: PCI device to reset
4385 *
4386 * Some devices allow an individual function to be reset without affecting
4387 * other functions in the same device. The PCI device must be responsive
4388 * to PCI config space in order to use this function.
4389 *
4390 * Returns 0 if the device function can be reset or negative if the
4391 * device doesn't support resetting a single function.
4392 */
4393int pci_probe_reset_function(struct pci_dev *dev)
4394{
4395 int rc;
4396
4397 might_sleep();
4398
4399 rc = pci_dev_specific_reset(dev, 1);
4400 if (rc != -ENOTTY)
4401 return rc;
4402 if (pcie_has_flr(dev))
4403 return 0;
4404 rc = pci_af_flr(dev, 1);
4405 if (rc != -ENOTTY)
4406 return rc;
4407 rc = pci_pm_reset(dev, 1);
4408 if (rc != -ENOTTY)
4409 return rc;
4410 rc = pci_dev_reset_slot_function(dev, 1);
4411 if (rc != -ENOTTY)
4412 return rc;
4413
4414 return pci_parent_bus_reset(dev, 1);
4415}
4416
4417/**
4418 * pci_reset_function - quiesce and reset a PCI device function
4419 * @dev: PCI device to reset
4420 *
4421 * Some devices allow an individual function to be reset without affecting
4422 * other functions in the same device. The PCI device must be responsive
4423 * to PCI config space in order to use this function.
4424 *
4425 * This function does not just reset the PCI portion of a device, but
4426 * clears all the state associated with the device. This function differs
4427 * from __pci_reset_function_locked() in that it saves and restores device state
4428 * over the reset and takes the PCI device lock.
4429 *
4430 * Returns 0 if the device function was successfully reset or negative if the
4431 * device doesn't support resetting a single function.
4432 */
4433int pci_reset_function(struct pci_dev *dev)
4434{
4435 int rc;
4436
4437 if (!dev->reset_fn)
4438 return -ENOTTY;
4439
4440 pci_dev_lock(dev);
4441 pci_dev_save_and_disable(dev);
4442
4443 rc = __pci_reset_function_locked(dev);
4444
4445 pci_dev_restore(dev);
4446 pci_dev_unlock(dev);
4447
4448 return rc;
4449}
4450EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_reset_function);
4451
4452/**
4453 * pci_reset_function_locked - quiesce and reset a PCI device function
4454 * @dev: PCI device to reset
4455 *
4456 * Some devices allow an individual function to be reset without affecting
4457 * other functions in the same device. The PCI device must be responsive
4458 * to PCI config space in order to use this function.
4459 *
4460 * This function does not just reset the PCI portion of a device, but
4461 * clears all the state associated with the device. This function differs
4462 * from __pci_reset_function_locked() in that it saves and restores device state
4463 * over the reset. It also differs from pci_reset_function() in that it
4464 * requires the PCI device lock to be held.
4465 *
4466 * Returns 0 if the device function was successfully reset or negative if the
4467 * device doesn't support resetting a single function.
4468 */
4469int pci_reset_function_locked(struct pci_dev *dev)
4470{
4471 int rc;
4472
4473 if (!dev->reset_fn)
4474 return -ENOTTY;
4475
4476 pci_dev_save_and_disable(dev);
4477
4478 rc = __pci_reset_function_locked(dev);
4479
4480 pci_dev_restore(dev);
4481
4482 return rc;
4483}
4484EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_reset_function_locked);
4485
4486/**
4487 * pci_try_reset_function - quiesce and reset a PCI device function
4488 * @dev: PCI device to reset
4489 *
4490 * Same as above, except return -EAGAIN if unable to lock device.
4491 */
4492int pci_try_reset_function(struct pci_dev *dev)
4493{
4494 int rc;
4495
4496 if (!dev->reset_fn)
4497 return -ENOTTY;
4498
4499 if (!pci_dev_trylock(dev))
4500 return -EAGAIN;
4501
4502 pci_dev_save_and_disable(dev);
4503 rc = __pci_reset_function_locked(dev);
4504 pci_dev_restore(dev);
4505 pci_dev_unlock(dev);
4506
4507 return rc;
4508}
4509EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_try_reset_function);
4510
4511/* Do any devices on or below this bus prevent a bus reset? */
4512static bool pci_bus_resetable(struct pci_bus *bus)
4513{
4514 struct pci_dev *dev;
4515
4516
4517 if (bus->self && (bus->self->dev_flags & PCI_DEV_FLAGS_NO_BUS_RESET))
4518 return false;
4519
4520 list_for_each_entry(dev, &bus->devices, bus_list) {
4521 if (dev->dev_flags & PCI_DEV_FLAGS_NO_BUS_RESET ||
4522 (dev->subordinate && !pci_bus_resetable(dev->subordinate)))
4523 return false;
4524 }
4525
4526 return true;
4527}
4528
4529/* Lock devices from the top of the tree down */
4530static void pci_bus_lock(struct pci_bus *bus)
4531{
4532 struct pci_dev *dev;
4533
4534 list_for_each_entry(dev, &bus->devices, bus_list) {
4535 pci_dev_lock(dev);
4536 if (dev->subordinate)
4537 pci_bus_lock(dev->subordinate);
4538 }
4539}
4540
4541/* Unlock devices from the bottom of the tree up */
4542static void pci_bus_unlock(struct pci_bus *bus)
4543{
4544 struct pci_dev *dev;
4545
4546 list_for_each_entry(dev, &bus->devices, bus_list) {
4547 if (dev->subordinate)
4548 pci_bus_unlock(dev->subordinate);
4549 pci_dev_unlock(dev);
4550 }
4551}
4552
4553/* Return 1 on successful lock, 0 on contention */
4554static int pci_bus_trylock(struct pci_bus *bus)
4555{
4556 struct pci_dev *dev;
4557
4558 list_for_each_entry(dev, &bus->devices, bus_list) {
4559 if (!pci_dev_trylock(dev))
4560 goto unlock;
4561 if (dev->subordinate) {
4562 if (!pci_bus_trylock(dev->subordinate)) {
4563 pci_dev_unlock(dev);
4564 goto unlock;
4565 }
4566 }
4567 }
4568 return 1;
4569
4570unlock:
4571 list_for_each_entry_continue_reverse(dev, &bus->devices, bus_list) {
4572 if (dev->subordinate)
4573 pci_bus_unlock(dev->subordinate);
4574 pci_dev_unlock(dev);
4575 }
4576 return 0;
4577}
4578
4579/* Do any devices on or below this slot prevent a bus reset? */
4580static bool pci_slot_resetable(struct pci_slot *slot)
4581{
4582 struct pci_dev *dev;
4583
4584 if (slot->bus->self &&
4585 (slot->bus->self->dev_flags & PCI_DEV_FLAGS_NO_BUS_RESET))
4586 return false;
4587
4588 list_for_each_entry(dev, &slot->bus->devices, bus_list) {
4589 if (!dev->slot || dev->slot != slot)
4590 continue;
4591 if (dev->dev_flags & PCI_DEV_FLAGS_NO_BUS_RESET ||
4592 (dev->subordinate && !pci_bus_resetable(dev->subordinate)))
4593 return false;
4594 }
4595
4596 return true;
4597}
4598
4599/* Lock devices from the top of the tree down */
4600static void pci_slot_lock(struct pci_slot *slot)
4601{
4602 struct pci_dev *dev;
4603
4604 list_for_each_entry(dev, &slot->bus->devices, bus_list) {
4605 if (!dev->slot || dev->slot != slot)
4606 continue;
4607 pci_dev_lock(dev);
4608 if (dev->subordinate)
4609 pci_bus_lock(dev->subordinate);
4610 }
4611}
4612
4613/* Unlock devices from the bottom of the tree up */
4614static void pci_slot_unlock(struct pci_slot *slot)
4615{
4616 struct pci_dev *dev;
4617
4618 list_for_each_entry(dev, &slot->bus->devices, bus_list) {
4619 if (!dev->slot || dev->slot != slot)
4620 continue;
4621 if (dev->subordinate)
4622 pci_bus_unlock(dev->subordinate);
4623 pci_dev_unlock(dev);
4624 }
4625}
4626
4627/* Return 1 on successful lock, 0 on contention */
4628static int pci_slot_trylock(struct pci_slot *slot)
4629{
4630 struct pci_dev *dev;
4631
4632 list_for_each_entry(dev, &slot->bus->devices, bus_list) {
4633 if (!dev->slot || dev->slot != slot)
4634 continue;
4635 if (!pci_dev_trylock(dev))
4636 goto unlock;
4637 if (dev->subordinate) {
4638 if (!pci_bus_trylock(dev->subordinate)) {
4639 pci_dev_unlock(dev);
4640 goto unlock;
4641 }
4642 }
4643 }
4644 return 1;
4645
4646unlock:
4647 list_for_each_entry_continue_reverse(dev,
4648 &slot->bus->devices, bus_list) {
4649 if (!dev->slot || dev->slot != slot)
4650 continue;
4651 if (dev->subordinate)
4652 pci_bus_unlock(dev->subordinate);
4653 pci_dev_unlock(dev);
4654 }
4655 return 0;
4656}
4657
4658/* Save and disable devices from the top of the tree down */
4659static void pci_bus_save_and_disable(struct pci_bus *bus)
4660{
4661 struct pci_dev *dev;
4662
4663 list_for_each_entry(dev, &bus->devices, bus_list) {
4664 pci_dev_lock(dev);
4665 pci_dev_save_and_disable(dev);
4666 pci_dev_unlock(dev);
4667 if (dev->subordinate)
4668 pci_bus_save_and_disable(dev->subordinate);
4669 }
4670}
4671
4672/*
4673 * Restore devices from top of the tree down - parent bridges need to be
4674 * restored before we can get to subordinate devices.
4675 */
4676static void pci_bus_restore(struct pci_bus *bus)
4677{
4678 struct pci_dev *dev;
4679
4680 list_for_each_entry(dev, &bus->devices, bus_list) {
4681 pci_dev_lock(dev);
4682 pci_dev_restore(dev);
4683 pci_dev_unlock(dev);
4684 if (dev->subordinate)
4685 pci_bus_restore(dev->subordinate);
4686 }
4687}
4688
4689/* Save and disable devices from the top of the tree down */
4690static void pci_slot_save_and_disable(struct pci_slot *slot)
4691{
4692 struct pci_dev *dev;
4693
4694 list_for_each_entry(dev, &slot->bus->devices, bus_list) {
4695 if (!dev->slot || dev->slot != slot)
4696 continue;
4697 pci_dev_save_and_disable(dev);
4698 if (dev->subordinate)
4699 pci_bus_save_and_disable(dev->subordinate);
4700 }
4701}
4702
4703/*
4704 * Restore devices from top of the tree down - parent bridges need to be
4705 * restored before we can get to subordinate devices.
4706 */
4707static void pci_slot_restore(struct pci_slot *slot)
4708{
4709 struct pci_dev *dev;
4710
4711 list_for_each_entry(dev, &slot->bus->devices, bus_list) {
4712 if (!dev->slot || dev->slot != slot)
4713 continue;
4714 pci_dev_lock(dev);
4715 pci_dev_restore(dev);
4716 pci_dev_unlock(dev);
4717 if (dev->subordinate)
4718 pci_bus_restore(dev->subordinate);
4719 }
4720}
4721
4722static int pci_slot_reset(struct pci_slot *slot, int probe)
4723{
4724 int rc;
4725
4726 if (!slot || !pci_slot_resetable(slot))
4727 return -ENOTTY;
4728
4729 if (!probe)
4730 pci_slot_lock(slot);
4731
4732 might_sleep();
4733
4734 rc = pci_reset_hotplug_slot(slot->hotplug, probe);
4735
4736 if (!probe)
4737 pci_slot_unlock(slot);
4738
4739 return rc;
4740}
4741
4742/**
4743 * pci_probe_reset_slot - probe whether a PCI slot can be reset
4744 * @slot: PCI slot to probe
4745 *
4746 * Return 0 if slot can be reset, negative if a slot reset is not supported.
4747 */
4748int pci_probe_reset_slot(struct pci_slot *slot)
4749{
4750 return pci_slot_reset(slot, 1);
4751}
4752EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_probe_reset_slot);
4753
4754/**
4755 * pci_reset_slot - reset a PCI slot
4756 * @slot: PCI slot to reset
4757 *
4758 * A PCI bus may host multiple slots, each slot may support a reset mechanism
4759 * independent of other slots. For instance, some slots may support slot power
4760 * control. In the case of a 1:1 bus to slot architecture, this function may
4761 * wrap the bus reset to avoid spurious slot related events such as hotplug.
4762 * Generally a slot reset should be attempted before a bus reset. All of the
4763 * function of the slot and any subordinate buses behind the slot are reset
4764 * through this function. PCI config space of all devices in the slot and
4765 * behind the slot is saved before and restored after reset.
4766 *
4767 * Return 0 on success, non-zero on error.
4768 */
4769int pci_reset_slot(struct pci_slot *slot)
4770{
4771 int rc;
4772
4773 rc = pci_slot_reset(slot, 1);
4774 if (rc)
4775 return rc;
4776
4777 pci_slot_save_and_disable(slot);
4778
4779 rc = pci_slot_reset(slot, 0);
4780
4781 pci_slot_restore(slot);
4782
4783 return rc;
4784}
4785EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_reset_slot);
4786
4787/**
4788 * pci_try_reset_slot - Try to reset a PCI slot
4789 * @slot: PCI slot to reset
4790 *
4791 * Same as above except return -EAGAIN if the slot cannot be locked
4792 */
4793int pci_try_reset_slot(struct pci_slot *slot)
4794{
4795 int rc;
4796
4797 rc = pci_slot_reset(slot, 1);
4798 if (rc)
4799 return rc;
4800
4801 pci_slot_save_and_disable(slot);
4802
4803 if (pci_slot_trylock(slot)) {
4804 might_sleep();
4805 rc = pci_reset_hotplug_slot(slot->hotplug, 0);
4806 pci_slot_unlock(slot);
4807 } else
4808 rc = -EAGAIN;
4809
4810 pci_slot_restore(slot);
4811
4812 return rc;
4813}
4814EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_try_reset_slot);
4815
4816static int pci_bus_reset(struct pci_bus *bus, int probe)
4817{
4818 if (!bus->self || !pci_bus_resetable(bus))
4819 return -ENOTTY;
4820
4821 if (probe)
4822 return 0;
4823
4824 pci_bus_lock(bus);
4825
4826 might_sleep();
4827
4828 pci_reset_bridge_secondary_bus(bus->self);
4829
4830 pci_bus_unlock(bus);
4831
4832 return 0;
4833}
4834
4835/**
4836 * pci_probe_reset_bus - probe whether a PCI bus can be reset
4837 * @bus: PCI bus to probe
4838 *
4839 * Return 0 if bus can be reset, negative if a bus reset is not supported.
4840 */
4841int pci_probe_reset_bus(struct pci_bus *bus)
4842{
4843 return pci_bus_reset(bus, 1);
4844}
4845EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_probe_reset_bus);
4846
4847/**
4848 * pci_reset_bus - reset a PCI bus
4849 * @bus: top level PCI bus to reset
4850 *
4851 * Do a bus reset on the given bus and any subordinate buses, saving
4852 * and restoring state of all devices.
4853 *
4854 * Return 0 on success, non-zero on error.
4855 */
4856int pci_reset_bus(struct pci_bus *bus)
4857{
4858 int rc;
4859
4860 rc = pci_bus_reset(bus, 1);
4861 if (rc)
4862 return rc;
4863
4864 pci_bus_save_and_disable(bus);
4865
4866 rc = pci_bus_reset(bus, 0);
4867
4868 pci_bus_restore(bus);
4869
4870 return rc;
4871}
4872EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_reset_bus);
4873
4874/**
4875 * pci_try_reset_bus - Try to reset a PCI bus
4876 * @bus: top level PCI bus to reset
4877 *
4878 * Same as above except return -EAGAIN if the bus cannot be locked
4879 */
4880int pci_try_reset_bus(struct pci_bus *bus)
4881{
4882 int rc;
4883
4884 rc = pci_bus_reset(bus, 1);
4885 if (rc)
4886 return rc;
4887
4888 pci_bus_save_and_disable(bus);
4889
4890 if (pci_bus_trylock(bus)) {
4891 might_sleep();
4892 pci_reset_bridge_secondary_bus(bus->self);
4893 pci_bus_unlock(bus);
4894 } else
4895 rc = -EAGAIN;
4896
4897 pci_bus_restore(bus);
4898
4899 return rc;
4900}
4901EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_try_reset_bus);
4902
4903/**
4904 * pcix_get_max_mmrbc - get PCI-X maximum designed memory read byte count
4905 * @dev: PCI device to query
4906 *
4907 * Returns mmrbc: maximum designed memory read count in bytes
4908 * or appropriate error value.
4909 */
4910int pcix_get_max_mmrbc(struct pci_dev *dev)
4911{
4912 int cap;
4913 u32 stat;
4914
4915 cap = pci_find_capability(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_PCIX);
4916 if (!cap)
4917 return -EINVAL;
4918
4919 if (pci_read_config_dword(dev, cap + PCI_X_STATUS, &stat))
4920 return -EINVAL;
4921
4922 return 512 << ((stat & PCI_X_STATUS_MAX_READ) >> 21);
4923}
4924EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcix_get_max_mmrbc);
4925
4926/**
4927 * pcix_get_mmrbc - get PCI-X maximum memory read byte count
4928 * @dev: PCI device to query
4929 *
4930 * Returns mmrbc: maximum memory read count in bytes
4931 * or appropriate error value.
4932 */
4933int pcix_get_mmrbc(struct pci_dev *dev)
4934{
4935 int cap;
4936 u16 cmd;
4937
4938 cap = pci_find_capability(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_PCIX);
4939 if (!cap)
4940 return -EINVAL;
4941
4942 if (pci_read_config_word(dev, cap + PCI_X_CMD, &cmd))
4943 return -EINVAL;
4944
4945 return 512 << ((cmd & PCI_X_CMD_MAX_READ) >> 2);
4946}
4947EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcix_get_mmrbc);
4948
4949/**
4950 * pcix_set_mmrbc - set PCI-X maximum memory read byte count
4951 * @dev: PCI device to query
4952 * @mmrbc: maximum memory read count in bytes
4953 * valid values are 512, 1024, 2048, 4096
4954 *
4955 * If possible sets maximum memory read byte count, some bridges have erratas
4956 * that prevent this.
4957 */
4958int pcix_set_mmrbc(struct pci_dev *dev, int mmrbc)
4959{
4960 int cap;
4961 u32 stat, v, o;
4962 u16 cmd;
4963
4964 if (mmrbc < 512 || mmrbc > 4096 || !is_power_of_2(mmrbc))
4965 return -EINVAL;
4966
4967 v = ffs(mmrbc) - 10;
4968
4969 cap = pci_find_capability(dev, PCI_CAP_ID_PCIX);
4970 if (!cap)
4971 return -EINVAL;
4972
4973 if (pci_read_config_dword(dev, cap + PCI_X_STATUS, &stat))
4974 return -EINVAL;
4975
4976 if (v > (stat & PCI_X_STATUS_MAX_READ) >> 21)
4977 return -E2BIG;
4978
4979 if (pci_read_config_word(dev, cap + PCI_X_CMD, &cmd))
4980 return -EINVAL;
4981
4982 o = (cmd & PCI_X_CMD_MAX_READ) >> 2;
4983 if (o != v) {
4984 if (v > o && (dev->bus->bus_flags & PCI_BUS_FLAGS_NO_MMRBC))
4985 return -EIO;
4986
4987 cmd &= ~PCI_X_CMD_MAX_READ;
4988 cmd |= v << 2;
4989 if (pci_write_config_word(dev, cap + PCI_X_CMD, cmd))
4990 return -EIO;
4991 }
4992 return 0;
4993}
4994EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcix_set_mmrbc);
4995
4996/**
4997 * pcie_get_readrq - get PCI Express read request size
4998 * @dev: PCI device to query
4999 *
5000 * Returns maximum memory read request in bytes
5001 * or appropriate error value.
5002 */
5003int pcie_get_readrq(struct pci_dev *dev)
5004{
5005 u16 ctl;
5006
5007 pcie_capability_read_word(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL, &ctl);
5008
5009 return 128 << ((ctl & PCI_EXP_DEVCTL_READRQ) >> 12);
5010}
5011EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcie_get_readrq);
5012
5013/**
5014 * pcie_set_readrq - set PCI Express maximum memory read request
5015 * @dev: PCI device to query
5016 * @rq: maximum memory read count in bytes
5017 * valid values are 128, 256, 512, 1024, 2048, 4096
5018 *
5019 * If possible sets maximum memory read request in bytes
5020 */
5021int pcie_set_readrq(struct pci_dev *dev, int rq)
5022{
5023 u16 v;
5024
5025 if (rq < 128 || rq > 4096 || !is_power_of_2(rq))
5026 return -EINVAL;
5027
5028 /*
5029 * If using the "performance" PCIe config, we clamp the
5030 * read rq size to the max packet size to prevent the
5031 * host bridge generating requests larger than we can
5032 * cope with
5033 */
5034 if (pcie_bus_config == PCIE_BUS_PERFORMANCE) {
5035 int mps = pcie_get_mps(dev);
5036
5037 if (mps < rq)
5038 rq = mps;
5039 }
5040
5041 v = (ffs(rq) - 8) << 12;
5042
5043 return pcie_capability_clear_and_set_word(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL,
5044 PCI_EXP_DEVCTL_READRQ, v);
5045}
5046EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcie_set_readrq);
5047
5048/**
5049 * pcie_get_mps - get PCI Express maximum payload size
5050 * @dev: PCI device to query
5051 *
5052 * Returns maximum payload size in bytes
5053 */
5054int pcie_get_mps(struct pci_dev *dev)
5055{
5056 u16 ctl;
5057
5058 pcie_capability_read_word(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL, &ctl);
5059
5060 return 128 << ((ctl & PCI_EXP_DEVCTL_PAYLOAD) >> 5);
5061}
5062EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcie_get_mps);
5063
5064/**
5065 * pcie_set_mps - set PCI Express maximum payload size
5066 * @dev: PCI device to query
5067 * @mps: maximum payload size in bytes
5068 * valid values are 128, 256, 512, 1024, 2048, 4096
5069 *
5070 * If possible sets maximum payload size
5071 */
5072int pcie_set_mps(struct pci_dev *dev, int mps)
5073{
5074 u16 v;
5075
5076 if (mps < 128 || mps > 4096 || !is_power_of_2(mps))
5077 return -EINVAL;
5078
5079 v = ffs(mps) - 8;
5080 if (v > dev->pcie_mpss)
5081 return -EINVAL;
5082 v <<= 5;
5083
5084 return pcie_capability_clear_and_set_word(dev, PCI_EXP_DEVCTL,
5085 PCI_EXP_DEVCTL_PAYLOAD, v);
5086}
5087EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcie_set_mps);
5088
5089/**
5090 * pcie_get_minimum_link - determine minimum link settings of a PCI device
5091 * @dev: PCI device to query
5092 * @speed: storage for minimum speed
5093 * @width: storage for minimum width
5094 *
5095 * This function will walk up the PCI device chain and determine the minimum
5096 * link width and speed of the device.
5097 */
5098int pcie_get_minimum_link(struct pci_dev *dev, enum pci_bus_speed *speed,
5099 enum pcie_link_width *width)
5100{
5101 int ret;
5102
5103 *speed = PCI_SPEED_UNKNOWN;
5104 *width = PCIE_LNK_WIDTH_UNKNOWN;
5105
5106 while (dev) {
5107 u16 lnksta;
5108 enum pci_bus_speed next_speed;
5109 enum pcie_link_width next_width;
5110
5111 ret = pcie_capability_read_word(dev, PCI_EXP_LNKSTA, &lnksta);
5112 if (ret)
5113 return ret;
5114
5115 next_speed = pcie_link_speed[lnksta & PCI_EXP_LNKSTA_CLS];
5116 next_width = (lnksta & PCI_EXP_LNKSTA_NLW) >>
5117 PCI_EXP_LNKSTA_NLW_SHIFT;
5118
5119 if (next_speed < *speed)
5120 *speed = next_speed;
5121
5122 if (next_width < *width)
5123 *width = next_width;
5124
5125 dev = dev->bus->self;
5126 }
5127
5128 return 0;
5129}
5130EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcie_get_minimum_link);
5131
5132/**
5133 * pcie_bandwidth_available - determine minimum link settings of a PCIe
5134 * device and its bandwidth limitation
5135 * @dev: PCI device to query
5136 * @limiting_dev: storage for device causing the bandwidth limitation
5137 * @speed: storage for speed of limiting device
5138 * @width: storage for width of limiting device
5139 *
5140 * Walk up the PCI device chain and find the point where the minimum
5141 * bandwidth is available. Return the bandwidth available there and (if
5142 * limiting_dev, speed, and width pointers are supplied) information about
5143 * that point. The bandwidth returned is in Mb/s, i.e., megabits/second of
5144 * raw bandwidth.
5145 */
5146u32 pcie_bandwidth_available(struct pci_dev *dev, struct pci_dev **limiting_dev,
5147 enum pci_bus_speed *speed,
5148 enum pcie_link_width *width)
5149{
5150 u16 lnksta;
5151 enum pci_bus_speed next_speed;
5152 enum pcie_link_width next_width;
5153 u32 bw, next_bw;
5154
5155 if (speed)
5156 *speed = PCI_SPEED_UNKNOWN;
5157 if (width)
5158 *width = PCIE_LNK_WIDTH_UNKNOWN;
5159
5160 bw = 0;
5161
5162 while (dev) {
5163 pcie_capability_read_word(dev, PCI_EXP_LNKSTA, &lnksta);
5164
5165 next_speed = pcie_link_speed[lnksta & PCI_EXP_LNKSTA_CLS];
5166 next_width = (lnksta & PCI_EXP_LNKSTA_NLW) >>
5167 PCI_EXP_LNKSTA_NLW_SHIFT;
5168
5169 next_bw = next_width * PCIE_SPEED2MBS_ENC(next_speed);
5170
5171 /* Check if current device limits the total bandwidth */
5172 if (!bw || next_bw <= bw) {
5173 bw = next_bw;
5174
5175 if (limiting_dev)
5176 *limiting_dev = dev;
5177 if (speed)
5178 *speed = next_speed;
5179 if (width)
5180 *width = next_width;
5181 }
5182
5183 dev = pci_upstream_bridge(dev);
5184 }
5185
5186 return bw;
5187}
5188EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcie_bandwidth_available);
5189
5190/**
5191 * pcie_get_speed_cap - query for the PCI device's link speed capability
5192 * @dev: PCI device to query
5193 *
5194 * Query the PCI device speed capability. Return the maximum link speed
5195 * supported by the device.
5196 */
5197enum pci_bus_speed pcie_get_speed_cap(struct pci_dev *dev)
5198{
5199 u32 lnkcap2, lnkcap;
5200
5201 /*
5202 * PCIe r4.0 sec 7.5.3.18 recommends using the Supported Link
5203 * Speeds Vector in Link Capabilities 2 when supported, falling
5204 * back to Max Link Speed in Link Capabilities otherwise.
5205 */
5206 pcie_capability_read_dword(dev, PCI_EXP_LNKCAP2, &lnkcap2);
5207 if (lnkcap2) { /* PCIe r3.0-compliant */
5208 if (lnkcap2 & PCI_EXP_LNKCAP2_SLS_16_0GB)
5209 return PCIE_SPEED_16_0GT;
5210 else if (lnkcap2 & PCI_EXP_LNKCAP2_SLS_8_0GB)
5211 return PCIE_SPEED_8_0GT;
5212 else if (lnkcap2 & PCI_EXP_LNKCAP2_SLS_5_0GB)
5213 return PCIE_SPEED_5_0GT;
5214 else if (lnkcap2 & PCI_EXP_LNKCAP2_SLS_2_5GB)
5215 return PCIE_SPEED_2_5GT;
5216 return PCI_SPEED_UNKNOWN;
5217 }
5218
5219 pcie_capability_read_dword(dev, PCI_EXP_LNKCAP, &lnkcap);
5220 if (lnkcap) {
5221 if (lnkcap & PCI_EXP_LNKCAP_SLS_16_0GB)
5222 return PCIE_SPEED_16_0GT;
5223 else if (lnkcap & PCI_EXP_LNKCAP_SLS_8_0GB)
5224 return PCIE_SPEED_8_0GT;
5225 else if (lnkcap & PCI_EXP_LNKCAP_SLS_5_0GB)
5226 return PCIE_SPEED_5_0GT;
5227 else if (lnkcap & PCI_EXP_LNKCAP_SLS_2_5GB)
5228 return PCIE_SPEED_2_5GT;
5229 }
5230
5231 return PCI_SPEED_UNKNOWN;
5232}
5233
5234/**
5235 * pcie_get_width_cap - query for the PCI device's link width capability
5236 * @dev: PCI device to query
5237 *
5238 * Query the PCI device width capability. Return the maximum link width
5239 * supported by the device.
5240 */
5241enum pcie_link_width pcie_get_width_cap(struct pci_dev *dev)
5242{
5243 u32 lnkcap;
5244
5245 pcie_capability_read_dword(dev, PCI_EXP_LNKCAP, &lnkcap);
5246 if (lnkcap)
5247 return (lnkcap & PCI_EXP_LNKCAP_MLW) >> 4;
5248
5249 return PCIE_LNK_WIDTH_UNKNOWN;
5250}
5251
5252/**
5253 * pcie_bandwidth_capable - calculate a PCI device's link bandwidth capability
5254 * @dev: PCI device
5255 * @speed: storage for link speed
5256 * @width: storage for link width
5257 *
5258 * Calculate a PCI device's link bandwidth by querying for its link speed
5259 * and width, multiplying them, and applying encoding overhead. The result
5260 * is in Mb/s, i.e., megabits/second of raw bandwidth.
5261 */
5262u32 pcie_bandwidth_capable(struct pci_dev *dev, enum pci_bus_speed *speed,
5263 enum pcie_link_width *width)
5264{
5265 *speed = pcie_get_speed_cap(dev);
5266 *width = pcie_get_width_cap(dev);
5267
5268 if (*speed == PCI_SPEED_UNKNOWN || *width == PCIE_LNK_WIDTH_UNKNOWN)
5269 return 0;
5270
5271 return *width * PCIE_SPEED2MBS_ENC(*speed);
5272}
5273
5274/**
5275 * pcie_print_link_status - Report the PCI device's link speed and width
5276 * @dev: PCI device to query
5277 *
5278 * Report the available bandwidth at the device. If this is less than the
5279 * device is capable of, report the device's maximum possible bandwidth and
5280 * the upstream link that limits its performance to less than that.
5281 */
5282void pcie_print_link_status(struct pci_dev *dev)
5283{
5284 enum pcie_link_width width, width_cap;
5285 enum pci_bus_speed speed, speed_cap;
5286 struct pci_dev *limiting_dev = NULL;
5287 u32 bw_avail, bw_cap;
5288
5289 bw_cap = pcie_bandwidth_capable(dev, &speed_cap, &width_cap);
5290 bw_avail = pcie_bandwidth_available(dev, &limiting_dev, &speed, &width);
5291
5292 if (bw_avail >= bw_cap)
5293 pci_info(dev, "%u.%03u Gb/s available PCIe bandwidth (%s x%d link)\n",
5294 bw_cap / 1000, bw_cap % 1000,
5295 PCIE_SPEED2STR(speed_cap), width_cap);
5296 else
5297 pci_info(dev, "%u.%03u Gb/s available PCIe bandwidth, limited by %s x%d link at %s (capable of %u.%03u Gb/s with %s x%d link)\n",
5298 bw_avail / 1000, bw_avail % 1000,
5299 PCIE_SPEED2STR(speed), width,
5300 limiting_dev ? pci_name(limiting_dev) : "<unknown>",
5301 bw_cap / 1000, bw_cap % 1000,
5302 PCIE_SPEED2STR(speed_cap), width_cap);
5303}
5304EXPORT_SYMBOL(pcie_print_link_status);
5305
5306/**
5307 * pci_select_bars - Make BAR mask from the type of resource
5308 * @dev: the PCI device for which BAR mask is made
5309 * @flags: resource type mask to be selected
5310 *
5311 * This helper routine makes bar mask from the type of resource.
5312 */
5313int pci_select_bars(struct pci_dev *dev, unsigned long flags)
5314{
5315 int i, bars = 0;
5316 for (i = 0; i < PCI_NUM_RESOURCES; i++)
5317 if (pci_resource_flags(dev, i) & flags)
5318 bars |= (1 << i);
5319 return bars;
5320}
5321EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_select_bars);
5322
5323/* Some architectures require additional programming to enable VGA */
5324static arch_set_vga_state_t arch_set_vga_state;
5325
5326void __init pci_register_set_vga_state(arch_set_vga_state_t func)
5327{
5328 arch_set_vga_state = func; /* NULL disables */
5329}
5330
5331static int pci_set_vga_state_arch(struct pci_dev *dev, bool decode,
5332 unsigned int command_bits, u32 flags)
5333{
5334 if (arch_set_vga_state)
5335 return arch_set_vga_state(dev, decode, command_bits,
5336 flags);
5337 return 0;
5338}
5339
5340/**
5341 * pci_set_vga_state - set VGA decode state on device and parents if requested
5342 * @dev: the PCI device
5343 * @decode: true = enable decoding, false = disable decoding
5344 * @command_bits: PCI_COMMAND_IO and/or PCI_COMMAND_MEMORY
5345 * @flags: traverse ancestors and change bridges
5346 * CHANGE_BRIDGE_ONLY / CHANGE_BRIDGE
5347 */
5348int pci_set_vga_state(struct pci_dev *dev, bool decode,
5349 unsigned int command_bits, u32 flags)
5350{
5351 struct pci_bus *bus;
5352 struct pci_dev *bridge;
5353 u16 cmd;
5354 int rc;
5355
5356 WARN_ON((flags & PCI_VGA_STATE_CHANGE_DECODES) && (command_bits & ~(PCI_COMMAND_IO|PCI_COMMAND_MEMORY)));
5357
5358 /* ARCH specific VGA enables */
5359 rc = pci_set_vga_state_arch(dev, decode, command_bits, flags);
5360 if (rc)
5361 return rc;
5362
5363 if (flags & PCI_VGA_STATE_CHANGE_DECODES) {
5364 pci_read_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, &cmd);
5365 if (decode == true)
5366 cmd |= command_bits;
5367 else
5368 cmd &= ~command_bits;
5369 pci_write_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, cmd);
5370 }
5371
5372 if (!(flags & PCI_VGA_STATE_CHANGE_BRIDGE))
5373 return 0;
5374
5375 bus = dev->bus;
5376 while (bus) {
5377 bridge = bus->self;
5378 if (bridge) {
5379 pci_read_config_word(bridge, PCI_BRIDGE_CONTROL,
5380 &cmd);
5381 if (decode == true)
5382 cmd |= PCI_BRIDGE_CTL_VGA;
5383 else
5384 cmd &= ~PCI_BRIDGE_CTL_VGA;
5385 pci_write_config_word(bridge, PCI_BRIDGE_CONTROL,
5386 cmd);
5387 }
5388 bus = bus->parent;
5389 }
5390 return 0;
5391}
5392
5393/**
5394 * pci_add_dma_alias - Add a DMA devfn alias for a device
5395 * @dev: the PCI device for which alias is added
5396 * @devfn: alias slot and function
5397 *
5398 * This helper encodes 8-bit devfn as bit number in dma_alias_mask.
5399 * It should be called early, preferably as PCI fixup header quirk.
5400 */
5401void pci_add_dma_alias(struct pci_dev *dev, u8 devfn)
5402{
5403 if (!dev->dma_alias_mask)
5404 dev->dma_alias_mask = kcalloc(BITS_TO_LONGS(U8_MAX),
5405 sizeof(long), GFP_KERNEL);
5406 if (!dev->dma_alias_mask) {
5407 pci_warn(dev, "Unable to allocate DMA alias mask\n");
5408 return;
5409 }
5410
5411 set_bit(devfn, dev->dma_alias_mask);
5412 pci_info(dev, "Enabling fixed DMA alias to %02x.%d\n",
5413 PCI_SLOT(devfn), PCI_FUNC(devfn));
5414}
5415
5416bool pci_devs_are_dma_aliases(struct pci_dev *dev1, struct pci_dev *dev2)
5417{
5418 return (dev1->dma_alias_mask &&
5419 test_bit(dev2->devfn, dev1->dma_alias_mask)) ||
5420 (dev2->dma_alias_mask &&
5421 test_bit(dev1->devfn, dev2->dma_alias_mask));
5422}
5423
5424bool pci_device_is_present(struct pci_dev *pdev)
5425{
5426 u32 v;
5427
5428 if (pci_dev_is_disconnected(pdev))
5429 return false;
5430 return pci_bus_read_dev_vendor_id(pdev->bus, pdev->devfn, &v, 0);
5431}
5432EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_device_is_present);
5433
5434void pci_ignore_hotplug(struct pci_dev *dev)
5435{
5436 struct pci_dev *bridge = dev->bus->self;
5437
5438 dev->ignore_hotplug = 1;
5439 /* Propagate the "ignore hotplug" setting to the parent bridge. */
5440 if (bridge)
5441 bridge->ignore_hotplug = 1;
5442}
5443EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(pci_ignore_hotplug);
5444
5445resource_size_t __weak pcibios_default_alignment(void)
5446{
5447 return 0;
5448}
5449
5450#define RESOURCE_ALIGNMENT_PARAM_SIZE COMMAND_LINE_SIZE
5451static char resource_alignment_param[RESOURCE_ALIGNMENT_PARAM_SIZE] = {0};
5452static DEFINE_SPINLOCK(resource_alignment_lock);
5453
5454/**
5455 * pci_specified_resource_alignment - get resource alignment specified by user.
5456 * @dev: the PCI device to get
5457 * @resize: whether or not to change resources' size when reassigning alignment
5458 *
5459 * RETURNS: Resource alignment if it is specified.
5460 * Zero if it is not specified.
5461 */
5462static resource_size_t pci_specified_resource_alignment(struct pci_dev *dev,
5463 bool *resize)
5464{
5465 int seg, bus, slot, func, align_order, count;
5466 unsigned short vendor, device, subsystem_vendor, subsystem_device;
5467 resource_size_t align = pcibios_default_alignment();
5468 char *p;
5469
5470 spin_lock(&resource_alignment_lock);
5471 p = resource_alignment_param;
5472 if (!*p && !align)
5473 goto out;
5474 if (pci_has_flag(PCI_PROBE_ONLY)) {
5475 align = 0;
5476 pr_info_once("PCI: Ignoring requested alignments (PCI_PROBE_ONLY)\n");
5477 goto out;
5478 }
5479
5480 while (*p) {
5481 count = 0;
5482 if (sscanf(p, "%d%n", &align_order, &count) == 1 &&
5483 p[count] == '@') {
5484 p += count + 1;
5485 } else {
5486 align_order = -1;
5487 }
5488 if (strncmp(p, "pci:", 4) == 0) {
5489 /* PCI vendor/device (subvendor/subdevice) ids are specified */
5490 p += 4;
5491 if (sscanf(p, "%hx:%hx:%hx:%hx%n",
5492 &vendor, &device, &subsystem_vendor, &subsystem_device, &count) != 4) {
5493 if (sscanf(p, "%hx:%hx%n", &vendor, &device, &count) != 2) {
5494 printk(KERN_ERR "PCI: Can't parse resource_alignment parameter: pci:%s\n",
5495 p);
5496 break;
5497 }
5498 subsystem_vendor = subsystem_device = 0;
5499 }
5500 p += count;
5501 if ((!vendor || (vendor == dev->vendor)) &&
5502 (!device || (device == dev->device)) &&
5503 (!subsystem_vendor || (subsystem_vendor == dev->subsystem_vendor)) &&
5504 (!subsystem_device || (subsystem_device == dev->subsystem_device))) {
5505 *resize = true;
5506 if (align_order == -1)
5507 align = PAGE_SIZE;
5508 else
5509 align = 1 << align_order;
5510 /* Found */
5511 break;
5512 }
5513 }
5514 else {
5515 if (sscanf(p, "%x:%x:%x.%x%n",
5516 &seg, &bus, &slot, &func, &count) != 4) {
5517 seg = 0;
5518 if (sscanf(p, "%x:%x.%x%n",
5519 &bus, &slot, &func, &count) != 3) {
5520 /* Invalid format */
5521 printk(KERN_ERR "PCI: Can't parse resource_alignment parameter: %s\n",
5522 p);
5523 break;
5524 }
5525 }
5526 p += count;
5527 if (seg == pci_domain_nr(dev->bus) &&
5528 bus == dev->bus->number &&
5529 slot == PCI_SLOT(dev->devfn) &&
5530 func == PCI_FUNC(dev->devfn)) {
5531 *resize = true;
5532 if (align_order == -1)
5533 align = PAGE_SIZE;
5534 else
5535 align = 1 << align_order;
5536 /* Found */
5537 break;
5538 }
5539 }
5540 if (*p != ';' && *p != ',') {
5541 /* End of param or invalid format */
5542 break;
5543 }
5544 p++;
5545 }
5546out:
5547 spin_unlock(&resource_alignment_lock);
5548 return align;
5549}
5550
5551static void pci_request_resource_alignment(struct pci_dev *dev, int bar,
5552 resource_size_t align, bool resize)
5553{
5554 struct resource *r = &dev->resource[bar];
5555 resource_size_t size;
5556
5557 if (!(r->flags & IORESOURCE_MEM))
5558 return;
5559
5560 if (r->flags & IORESOURCE_PCI_FIXED) {
5561 pci_info(dev, "BAR%d %pR: ignoring requested alignment %#llx\n",
5562 bar, r, (unsigned long long)align);
5563 return;
5564 }
5565
5566 size = resource_size(r);
5567 if (size >= align)
5568 return;
5569
5570 /*
5571 * Increase the alignment of the resource. There are two ways we
5572 * can do this:
5573 *
5574 * 1) Increase the size of the resource. BARs are aligned on their
5575 * size, so when we reallocate space for this resource, we'll
5576 * allocate it with the larger alignment. This also prevents
5577 * assignment of any other BARs inside the alignment region, so
5578 * if we're requesting page alignment, this means no other BARs
5579 * will share the page.
5580 *
5581 * The disadvantage is that this makes the resource larger than
5582 * the hardware BAR, which may break drivers that compute things
5583 * based on the resource size, e.g., to find registers at a
5584 * fixed offset before the end of the BAR.
5585 *
5586 * 2) Retain the resource size, but use IORESOURCE_STARTALIGN and
5587 * set r->start to the desired alignment. By itself this
5588 * doesn't prevent other BARs being put inside the alignment
5589 * region, but if we realign *every* resource of every device in
5590 * the system, none of them will share an alignment region.
5591 *
5592 * When the user has requested alignment for only some devices via
5593 * the "pci=resource_alignment" argument, "resize" is true and we
5594 * use the first method. Otherwise we assume we're aligning all
5595 * devices and we use the second.
5596 */
5597
5598 pci_info(dev, "BAR%d %pR: requesting alignment to %#llx\n",
5599 bar, r, (unsigned long long)align);
5600
5601 if (resize) {
5602 r->start = 0;
5603 r->end = align - 1;
5604 } else {
5605 r->flags &= ~IORESOURCE_SIZEALIGN;
5606 r->flags |= IORESOURCE_STARTALIGN;
5607 r->start = align;
5608 r->end = r->start + size - 1;
5609 }
5610 r->flags |= IORESOURCE_UNSET;
5611}
5612
5613/*
5614 * This function disables memory decoding and releases memory resources
5615 * of the device specified by kernel's boot parameter 'pci=resource_alignment='.
5616 * It also rounds up size to specified alignment.
5617 * Later on, the kernel will assign page-aligned memory resource back
5618 * to the device.
5619 */
5620void pci_reassigndev_resource_alignment(struct pci_dev *dev)
5621{
5622 int i;
5623 struct resource *r;
5624 resource_size_t align;
5625 u16 command;
5626 bool resize = false;
5627
5628 /*
5629 * VF BARs are read-only zero according to SR-IOV spec r1.1, sec
5630 * 3.4.1.11. Their resources are allocated from the space
5631 * described by the VF BARx register in the PF's SR-IOV capability.
5632 * We can't influence their alignment here.
5633 */
5634 if (dev->is_virtfn)
5635 return;
5636
5637 /* check if specified PCI is target device to reassign */
5638 align = pci_specified_resource_alignment(dev, &resize);
5639 if (!align)
5640 return;
5641
5642 if (dev->hdr_type == PCI_HEADER_TYPE_NORMAL &&
5643 (dev->class >> 8) == PCI_CLASS_BRIDGE_HOST) {
5644 pci_warn(dev, "Can't reassign resources to host bridge\n");
5645 return;
5646 }
5647
5648 pci_read_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, &command);
5649 command &= ~PCI_COMMAND_MEMORY;
5650 pci_write_config_word(dev, PCI_COMMAND, command);
5651
5652 for (i = 0; i <= PCI_ROM_RESOURCE; i++)
5653 pci_request_resource_alignment(dev, i, align, resize);
5654
5655 /*
5656 * Need to disable bridge's resource window,
5657 * to enable the kernel to reassign new resource
5658 * window later on.
5659 */
5660 if (dev->hdr_type == PCI_HEADER_TYPE_BRIDGE &&
5661 (dev->class >> 8) == PCI_CLASS_BRIDGE_PCI) {
5662 for (i = PCI_BRIDGE_RESOURCES; i < PCI_NUM_RESOURCES; i++) {
5663 r = &dev->resource[i];
5664 if (!(r->flags & IORESOURCE_MEM))
5665 continue;
5666 r->flags |= IORESOURCE_UNSET;
5667 r->end = resource_size(r) - 1;
5668 r->start = 0;
5669 }
5670 pci_disable_bridge_window(dev);
5671 }
5672}
5673
5674static ssize_t pci_set_resource_alignment_param(const char *buf, size_t count)
5675{
5676 if (count > RESOURCE_ALIGNMENT_PARAM_SIZE - 1)
5677 count = RESOURCE_ALIGNMENT_PARAM_SIZE - 1;
5678 spin_lock(&resource_alignment_lock);
5679 strncpy(resource_alignment_param, buf, count);
5680 resource_alignment_param[count] = '\0';
5681 spin_unlock(&resource_alignment_lock);
5682 return count;
5683}
5684
5685static ssize_t pci_get_resource_alignment_param(char *buf, size_t size)
5686{
5687 size_t count;
5688 spin_lock(&resource_alignment_lock);
5689 count = snprintf(buf, size, "%s", resource_alignment_param);
5690 spin_unlock(&resource_alignment_lock);
5691 return count;
5692}
5693
5694static ssize_t pci_resource_alignment_show(struct bus_type *bus, char *buf)
5695{
5696 return pci_get_resource_alignment_param(buf, PAGE_SIZE);
5697}
5698
5699static ssize_t pci_resource_alignment_store(struct bus_type *bus,
5700 const char *buf, size_t count)
5701{
5702 return pci_set_resource_alignment_param(buf, count);
5703}
5704
5705static BUS_ATTR(resource_alignment, 0644, pci_resource_alignment_show,
5706 pci_resource_alignment_store);
5707
5708static int __init pci_resource_alignment_sysfs_init(void)
5709{
5710 return bus_create_file(&pci_bus_type,
5711 &bus_attr_resource_alignment);
5712}
5713late_initcall(pci_resource_alignment_sysfs_init);
5714
5715static void pci_no_domains(void)
5716{
5717#ifdef CONFIG_PCI_DOMAINS
5718 pci_domains_supported = 0;
5719#endif
5720}
5721
5722#ifdef CONFIG_PCI_DOMAINS
5723static atomic_t __domain_nr = ATOMIC_INIT(-1);
5724
5725int pci_get_new_domain_nr(void)
5726{
5727 return atomic_inc_return(&__domain_nr);
5728}
5729
5730#ifdef CONFIG_PCI_DOMAINS_GENERIC
5731static int of_pci_bus_find_domain_nr(struct device *parent)
5732{
5733 static int use_dt_domains = -1;
5734 int domain = -1;
5735
5736 if (parent)
5737 domain = of_get_pci_domain_nr(parent->of_node);
5738 /*
5739 * Check DT domain and use_dt_domains values.
5740 *
5741 * If DT domain property is valid (domain >= 0) and
5742 * use_dt_domains != 0, the DT assignment is valid since this means
5743 * we have not previously allocated a domain number by using
5744 * pci_get_new_domain_nr(); we should also update use_dt_domains to
5745 * 1, to indicate that we have just assigned a domain number from
5746 * DT.
5747 *
5748 * If DT domain property value is not valid (ie domain < 0), and we
5749 * have not previously assigned a domain number from DT
5750 * (use_dt_domains != 1) we should assign a domain number by
5751 * using the:
5752 *
5753 * pci_get_new_domain_nr()
5754 *
5755 * API and update the use_dt_domains value to keep track of method we
5756 * are using to assign domain numbers (use_dt_domains = 0).
5757 *
5758 * All other combinations imply we have a platform that is trying
5759 * to mix domain numbers obtained from DT and pci_get_new_domain_nr(),
5760 * which is a recipe for domain mishandling and it is prevented by
5761 * invalidating the domain value (domain = -1) and printing a
5762 * corresponding error.
5763 */
5764 if (domain >= 0 && use_dt_domains) {
5765 use_dt_domains = 1;
5766 } else if (domain < 0 && use_dt_domains != 1) {
5767 use_dt_domains = 0;
5768 domain = pci_get_new_domain_nr();
5769 } else {
5770 if (parent)
5771 pr_err("Node %pOF has ", parent->of_node);
5772 pr_err("Inconsistent \"linux,pci-domain\" property in DT\n");
5773 domain = -1;
5774 }
5775
5776 return domain;
5777}
5778
5779int pci_bus_find_domain_nr(struct pci_bus *bus, struct device *parent)
5780{
5781 return acpi_disabled ? of_pci_bus_find_domain_nr(parent) :
5782 acpi_pci_bus_find_domain_nr(bus);
5783}
5784#endif
5785#endif
5786
5787/**
5788 * pci_ext_cfg_avail - can we access extended PCI config space?
5789 *
5790 * Returns 1 if we can access PCI extended config space (offsets
5791 * greater than 0xff). This is the default implementation. Architecture
5792 * implementations can override this.
5793 */
5794int __weak pci_ext_cfg_avail(void)
5795{
5796 return 1;
5797}
5798
5799void __weak pci_fixup_cardbus(struct pci_bus *bus)
5800{
5801}
5802EXPORT_SYMBOL(pci_fixup_cardbus);
5803
5804static int __init pci_setup(char *str)
5805{
5806 while (str) {
5807 char *k = strchr(str, ',');
5808 if (k)
5809 *k++ = 0;
5810 if (*str && (str = pcibios_setup(str)) && *str) {
5811 if (!strcmp(str, "nomsi")) {
5812 pci_no_msi();
5813 } else if (!strcmp(str, "noaer")) {
5814 pci_no_aer();
5815 } else if (!strncmp(str, "realloc=", 8)) {
5816 pci_realloc_get_opt(str + 8);
5817 } else if (!strncmp(str, "realloc", 7)) {
5818 pci_realloc_get_opt("on");
5819 } else if (!strcmp(str, "nodomains")) {
5820 pci_no_domains();
5821 } else if (!strncmp(str, "noari", 5)) {
5822 pcie_ari_disabled = true;
5823 } else if (!strncmp(str, "cbiosize=", 9)) {
5824 pci_cardbus_io_size = memparse(str + 9, &str);
5825 } else if (!strncmp(str, "cbmemsize=", 10)) {
5826 pci_cardbus_mem_size = memparse(str + 10, &str);
5827 } else if (!strncmp(str, "resource_alignment=", 19)) {
5828 pci_set_resource_alignment_param(str + 19,
5829 strlen(str + 19));
5830 } else if (!strncmp(str, "ecrc=", 5)) {
5831 pcie_ecrc_get_policy(str + 5);
5832 } else if (!strncmp(str, "hpiosize=", 9)) {
5833 pci_hotplug_io_size = memparse(str + 9, &str);
5834 } else if (!strncmp(str, "hpmemsize=", 10)) {
5835 pci_hotplug_mem_size = memparse(str + 10, &str);
5836 } else if (!strncmp(str, "hpbussize=", 10)) {
5837 pci_hotplug_bus_size =
5838 simple_strtoul(str + 10, &str, 0);
5839 if (pci_hotplug_bus_size > 0xff)
5840 pci_hotplug_bus_size = DEFAULT_HOTPLUG_BUS_SIZE;
5841 } else if (!strncmp(str, "pcie_bus_tune_off", 17)) {
5842 pcie_bus_config = PCIE_BUS_TUNE_OFF;
5843 } else if (!strncmp(str, "pcie_bus_safe", 13)) {
5844 pcie_bus_config = PCIE_BUS_SAFE;
5845 } else if (!strncmp(str, "pcie_bus_perf", 13)) {
5846 pcie_bus_config = PCIE_BUS_PERFORMANCE;
5847 } else if (!strncmp(str, "pcie_bus_peer2peer", 18)) {
5848 pcie_bus_config = PCIE_BUS_PEER2PEER;
5849 } else if (!strncmp(str, "pcie_scan_all", 13)) {
5850 pci_add_flags(PCI_SCAN_ALL_PCIE_DEVS);
5851 } else {
5852 printk(KERN_ERR "PCI: Unknown option `%s'\n",
5853 str);
5854 }
5855 }
5856 str = k;
5857 }
5858 return 0;
5859}
5860early_param("pci", pci_setup);